Chapter 1 EasyBuilder Pro Installation and Startup Guide


Add to my manuals
730 Pages

advertisement

Chapter 1 EasyBuilder Pro Installation and Startup Guide | Manualzz

EasyBuilder Pro User Manual

Chapter 1 EasyBuilder Pro Installation and Startup Guide .............................................................. 10

1.1 EasyBuilder Pro Installation ................................................................................................. 10

1.2 Steps to Install EasyBuilder Pro ........................................................................................... 11

Chapter 2 Utility Manager ............................................................................................................... 17

2.1 HMI IP, Password ................................................................................................................. 18

2.2 Editing Tools ......................................................................................................................... 19

2.2.1 Build Download Data for Saving in SD Card or USB Disk .......................................... 19

2.2.2 Steps to Download Project to HMI via USB or SD Card ............................................ 20

2.3 Transfer ................................................................................................................................ 21

2.3.1 Download .................................................................................................................. 21

2.3.2 Upload ....................................................................................................................... 23

2.4 Simulation ............................................................................................................................ 24

2.4.1 Off-line Simulation / On-line Simulation................................................................... 24

2.5 Pass-Through ........................................................................................................................ 26

Chapter 3 Create an EasyBuilder Pro Project .................................................................................. 27

3.1 Create a New Project ........................................................................................................... 27

3.2 Save and Compile the Project .............................................................................................. 29

3.3 Off-line and On-line Simulation ........................................................................................... 30

3.4 Download the Project to HMI .............................................................................................. 31

Chapter 4 Hardware Settings ........................................................................................................... 36

4.1 I/O Ports of HMI ................................................................................................................... 36

4.2 HMI System Settings ............................................................................................................ 37

4.2.1 System Reset ............................................................................................................. 37

4.2.2 System Toolbar ......................................................................................................... 38

4.2.3 System Information .................................................................................................. 39

4.2.4 System Setting .......................................................................................................... 39

Chapter 5 System Parameter Settings ............................................................................................. 43

5.1 Device ................................................................................................................................... 44

5.1.1 How to Control a Local PLC ....................................................................................... 45

5.1.2 How to Control a Remote PLC .................................................................................. 50

5.1.3 How to Control a Remote HMI ................................................................................. 52

5.2 Model ................................................................................................................................... 54

5.3 General ................................................................................................................................. 57

5.4 System Setting ..................................................................................................................... 60

5.5 Security ................................................................................................................................ 63

5.6 Font ...................................................................................................................................... 67

5.7 Extended Memory ............................................................................................................... 69

5.8 Printer/Backup Server .......................................................................................................... 71

1

EasyBuilder Pro User Manual

5.9 e-Mail ................................................................................................................................... 72

5.10 Recipes ............................................................................................................................... 75

Chapter 6 Window Operations ........................................................................................................ 77

6.1 Window Types ...................................................................................................................... 77

6.1.1 Base Window ............................................................................................................ 77

6.1.2 Fast Selection Window ............................................................................................. 78

6.1.3 Common Window ..................................................................................................... 79

6.1.4 System Message Window ......................................................................................... 80

6.2 Create, Set, and Delete a Window ....................................................................................... 82

6.2.1 Creating and Setting a Window ................................................................................ 82

6.2.2 Open, Close and Delete a Window ........................................................................... 85

Chapter 7 Event Log ......................................................................................................................... 86

7.1 Event Log Management ....................................................................................................... 86

7.1.1 Excel Editing .............................................................................................................. 87

7.2 Create a New Event Log ....................................................................................................... 89

7.2.1 Alarm (Event) Log General Settings .......................................................................... 89

7.2.2 Alarm (Event) Log Message Settings ......................................................................... 91

7.2.3 Event (Alarm) Log e-Mail Settings ............................................................................ 93

7.3 Event Log Relevant Registers ............................................................................................... 94

Chapter 8 Data Sampling ................................................................................................................. 95

8.1 Data Sampling Management ............................................................................................... 95

8.2 Create a New Data Sampling ............................................................................................... 96

8.3 System Registers Relevant to Data Sampling .................................................................... 100

Chapter 9 Object General Properties............................................................................................. 101

9.1 Selecting PLC ...................................................................................................................... 101

9.1.1 Setting the Reading and Writing Address ............................................................... 101

9.2 Using Shape Library and Picture Library ............................................................................ 104

9.2.1 Settings of Shape Library ........................................................................................ 105

9.2.2 Settings of Picture Library ....................................................................................... 108

9.3 Setting Text Content .......................................................................................................... 110

9.4 Adjusting Profile Size.......................................................................................................... 115

9.5 Variables of Station Number .............................................................................................. 116

9.6 Broadcast Station Number ................................................................................................. 118

Chapter 10 User Password and Object Security ............................................................................ 119

10.1 User Password and Operable Object Classes .................................................................. 119

10.1.1 General Mode ....................................................................................................... 119

10.1.2 Enhanced Security Mode ...................................................................................... 121

10.2 Enhanced Security Mode and Control Address ............................................................... 122

2

EasyBuilder Pro User Manual

10.2.1 Control Address Usage .......................................................................................... 122

10.2.2 Introduction of commands ................................................................................... 122

10.2.3 Introduction of Results Output ............................................................................. 123

10.3 Enhanced Security Mode with Function Key ................................................................... 124

10.3.1 Import User Account ............................................................................................. 124

10.3.2 USB Security Key Usage ........................................................................................ 126

10.4 Enhanced Security Mode with Option List Object ........................................................... 128

10.5 Object Security Settings ................................................................................................... 129

10.6 Setting Example ............................................................................................................... 130

Chapter 11 Index Register .............................................................................................................. 133

11.1 Introduction ..................................................................................................................... 133

11.2 Examples of Index Register .............................................................................................. 134

Chapter 12 Keyboard Design and Usage........................................................................................ 137

12.1 Steps to Design a Pop-up Keyboard ................................................................................. 138

12.2 Steps to Design a Keyboard with Direct Window ............................................................ 140

12.3 Steps to Design a Fixed Keyboard on Screen ................................................................... 141

12.4 Steps to Design a UNICODE Keyboard ............................................................................. 142

Chapter 13 Objects ........................................................................................................................ 143

13.1 Bit Lamp ........................................................................................................................... 143

13.2 Word Lamp ....................................................................................................................... 146

13.3 Set Bit ............................................................................................................................... 151

13.4 Set Word .......................................................................................................................... 155

13.5 Function Key..................................................................................................................... 164

13.6 Toggle Switch ................................................................................................................... 172

13.7 Multi-State Switch............................................................................................................ 175

13.8 Slider ................................................................................................................................ 179

13.9 Numeric Input and Numeric Display ................................................................................ 183

13.10 ASCII Input and ASCII Display ......................................................................................... 195

13.11 Indirect Window ............................................................................................................ 200

13.12 Direct Window ............................................................................................................... 205

13.13 Moving Shape ................................................................................................................ 209

13.14 Animation ....................................................................................................................... 215

13.15 Bar Graph ....................................................................................................................... 220

13.16 Meter Display ................................................................................................................. 226

13.17 Trend Display ................................................................................................................. 233

13.18 History Data Display ....................................................................................................... 243

13.19 Data Block Display .......................................................................................................... 250

13.20 XY Plot ............................................................................................................................ 262

3

EasyBuilder Pro User Manual

13.21 Alarm Bar and Alarm Display ......................................................................................... 275

13.22 Event Display .................................................................................................................. 278

13.23 Data Transfer (Trigger-based) ........................................................................................ 286

13.24 Backup ............................................................................................................................ 289

13.25 Media Player .................................................................................................................. 294

13.26 Data Transfer (Time-based) ........................................................................................... 305

13.27 PLC Control ..................................................................................................................... 308

13.28 Schedule ......................................................................................................................... 314

13.29 Option List ...................................................................................................................... 333

13.30 Timer .............................................................................................................................. 339

13.31 Video In .......................................................................................................................... 343

13.32 System Message............................................................................................................. 347

13.33 Recipe View .................................................................................................................... 349

Chapter 14 Shape Library and Picture Library ............................................................................... 353

14.1 Creating Shape Library ..................................................................................................... 353

14.2 Creating Picture Library ................................................................................................... 360

Chapter 15 Label Library and Multi-Language Usage .................................................................... 367

15.1 Introduction ..................................................................................................................... 367

15.2 Building Label Library ....................................................................................................... 368

15.3 Setting Label Font ............................................................................................................ 369

15.4 Using Label Library ........................................................................................................... 370

15.5 Settings of Multi-Language (System Register LW-9134) ................................................. 371

Chapter 16 Address Tag Library ..................................................................................................... 374

16.1 Creating Address Tag Library ............................................................................................ 374

16.2 Using Address Tag Library ................................................................................................ 376

Chapter 17 Transferring Recipe Data ............................................................................................. 377

17.1 Updating Recipe Data with Ethernet or USB cable .......................................................... 378

17.2 Updating Recipe Data with CF/SD Card or USB Disk ....................................................... 379

17.3 Transferring Recipe Data ................................................................................................. 380

17.4 Saving Recipe Data Automatically ................................................................................... 380

Chapter 18 Macro Reference ......................................................................................................... 381

18.1 Instructions to the Macro Editor ..................................................................................... 381

18.2 Macro Construction ......................................................................................................... 390

18.3 Syntax ............................................................................................................................... 391

18.3.1 Constants and Variables ....................................................................................... 391

18.3.2 Operators .............................................................................................................. 393

18.4 Statement ........................................................................................................................ 396

18.4.1 Definition Statement ............................................................................................ 396

4

EasyBuilder Pro User Manual

18.4.2 Assignment Statement .......................................................................................... 396

18.4.3 Logical Statements ................................................................................................ 396

18.4.4 Selective Statements ............................................................................................ 398

18.4.5 Reiterative Statements ......................................................................................... 400

18.5 Function Blocks ................................................................................................................ 403

18.6 Build-In Function Block .................................................................................................... 406

18.6.1 Mathematical Functions ....................................................................................... 406

18.6.2 Data Transformation ............................................................................................. 412

18.6.3 Data Manipulation ................................................................................................ 417

18.6.4 Bit Transformation ................................................................................................ 420

18.6.5 Communication ..................................................................................................... 422

18.6.6 String Operation Functions ................................................................................... 439

18.6.7 Recipe Query Function .......................................................................................... 465

18.6.8 Miscellaneous ....................................................................................................... 468

18.7 How to Create and Execute a Macro ............................................................................... 475

18.7.1 How to Create a Macro ......................................................................................... 475

18.7.2 Execute a Macro ................................................................................................... 479

18.8 User Defined Macro Function .......................................................................................... 480

18.8.1 Import Function Library File.................................................................................. 481

18.8.2 How to Use Macro Function Library ..................................................................... 482

18.8.3 Function Library Management Interface .............................................................. 484

18.9 Some Notes about Using the Macro ................................................................................ 491

18.10 Use the Free Protocol to Control a Device .................................................................... 492

18.11 Compiler Error Message ................................................................................................ 498

18.12 Sample Macro Code ....................................................................................................... 504

18.13 Macro TRACE Function .................................................................................................. 509

18.14 The Usage of String Operation Functions ...................................................................... 518

18.15 Macro Password Protection........................................................................................... 529

Chapter 19 Set HMI as a MODBUS Server ..................................................................................... 531

19.1 Setting HMI as MODBUS Device ...................................................................................... 531

19.2 Changing the Station Number of a MODBUS Server in Runtime .................................... 538

19.3 About MODBUS Address Type ......................................................................................... 539

Chapter 20 How to Connect a Barcode Device .............................................................................. 540

20.1 How to Connect a Barcode Device .................................................................................. 540

Chapter 21 Ethernet Communication and Multi-HMI Connection ............................................... 544

21.1 HMI to HMI Communication ............................................................................................ 545

21.2 PC to HMI Communication .............................................................................................. 546

21.3 Operate the PLC Connected with Other HMI .................................................................. 547

5

EasyBuilder Pro User Manual

Chapter 22 System Reserved Words / Bits .................................................................................... 548

22.1 The Address Ranges of Local HMI Memory ..................................................................... 549

22.1.1 Bits ........................................................................................................................ 549

22.1.2 Words .................................................................................................................... 550

22.2 HMI Time .......................................................................................................................... 551

22.3 User Name and Password ................................................................................................ 552

22.4 Data Sampling .................................................................................................................. 553

22.5 Event Log .......................................................................................................................... 554

22.6 HMI Hardware Operation ................................................................................................ 556

22.7 Local HMI Network Information ...................................................................................... 557

22.8 Recipe and Extended Memory ......................................................................................... 558

22.9 Storage Space Management ............................................................................................ 560

22.10 Touch Position................................................................................................................ 561

22.11 Station Number Variables .............................................................................................. 562

22.12 Index Register ................................................................................................................ 563

22.13 MTP File Information ..................................................................................................... 565

22.14 MODBUS Server Communication .................................................................................. 566

22.15 Communication Parameters Settings ............................................................................ 568

22.16 Communication Status with PLC (COM) ........................................................................ 571

22.17 Communication Status with PLC (Ethernet) .................................................................. 573

22.18 Communication Status with PLC (USB) .......................................................................... 577

22.19 Communication Status with PLC (CAN Bus) ................................................................... 578

22.20 Communication Status with Remote HMI ..................................................................... 579

22.21 Communication Status with Remote PLC ...................................................................... 585

22.22 Communication Error Messages & No. of Pending Cmd. .............................................. 588

22.23 Miscellaneous Functions ................................................................................................ 589

22.24 Remote Print/Backup Server ......................................................................................... 591

22.25 EasyAccess ..................................................................................................................... 592

22.26 Pass-Through Settings .................................................................................................... 593

22.27 Disable PLC No Response Dialog Box ............................................................................. 594

22.28 HMI and Project Key ...................................................................................................... 595

22.29 Fast Selection Window Control ..................................................................................... 596

22.30 Input Object Function .................................................................................................... 597

22.31 Local/Remote Operation Restrictions ........................................................................... 598

Chapter 23 HMI Supported Printers .............................................................................................. 599

23.1 The Supported Printer Types ........................................................................................... 599

23.2 How to Add a New Printer and Start Printing .................................................................. 602

23.2.1 Add Printer Type ................................................................................................... 602

6

EasyBuilder Pro User Manual

23.2.2 Start Printing ......................................................................................................... 603

Chapter 24 Recipe Editor ............................................................................................................... 604

24.1 Introduction ..................................................................................................................... 604

24.2 Recipe / Extended Memory Editor Setting ...................................................................... 604

24.3 Recipe Records ................................................................................................................. 607

Chapter 25 EasyConverter ............................................................................................................. 610

25.1 How to Export DTL or EVT file to Excel ............................................................................ 610

25.2 Scaling Function ............................................................................................................... 612

25.3 How to Use Multi-File Conversion ................................................................................... 614

Chapter 26 EasyPrinter .................................................................................................................. 615

26.1 Using EasyPrinter as a Printer Server............................................................................... 616

26.1.1 Setup Procedure in EasyPrinter ............................................................................ 616

26.1.2 Setup Procedure in EasyBuilder Pro ..................................................................... 617

26.2 Using EasyPrinter as a Backup Server .............................................................................. 620

26.2.1 Setup Procedure in EasyPrinter ............................................................................ 620

26.2.2 Setup Procedure in EasyBuilder Pro ..................................................................... 621

26.3 EasyPrinter Operation Guide ........................................................................................... 624

26.3.1 Appearance ........................................................................................................... 624

26.3.2 Operation Guide ................................................................................................... 625

26.4 Convert Batch File ............................................................................................................ 630

26.4.1 The Default Convert Batch File ............................................................................. 630

26.4.2 Specialized Criteria ................................................................................................ 631

26.4.3 The Format of a Convert Batch File ...................................................................... 632

26.4.4 The Order of Examining Criteria ........................................................................... 632

Chapter 27 EasySimulator .............................................................................................................. 633

27.1 Prepare Needed Files ....................................................................................................... 633

27.2 Modify the Content of “xob_pos.def” ............................................................................. 634

Chapter 28 Multi-HMI Intercommunication (Master-Slave Mode) ............................................... 635

28.1 How to Create a Project of Master HMI .......................................................................... 636

28.2 How to Create a Project of Slave HMI ............................................................................. 637

28.3 How to Connect with MT500 Project of Slave HMI ......................................................... 640

Chapter 29 Pass-Through Function ................................................................................................ 643

29.1 Ethernet Mode ................................................................................................................. 644

29.1.1 How to Change the Virtual Serial Port .................................................................. 645

29.1.2 How to Use Ethernet Mode .................................................................................. 647

29.2 COM Port Mode ............................................................................................................... 649

29.2.1 Settings of COM Port Mode .................................................................................. 649

29.2.2 HMI Work Mode ................................................................................................... 651

7

EasyBuilder Pro User Manual

29.3 Using System Reserved Addresses to Enable Pass-Through Function ............................ 654

Chapter 30 Project Protection ....................................................................................................... 655

30.1 XOB Password .................................................................................................................. 656

30.2 Decompilation is Prohibited ............................................................................................ 657

30.3 Disable HMI Upload Function [LB-9033] .......................................................................... 658

30.4 Project Key ....................................................................................................................... 659

30.5 Project Password (MTP file) ............................................................................................. 660

Chapter 31 Memory Map Communication .................................................................................... 661

Chapter 32 FTP Server Application ................................................................................................ 669

32.1 Login FTP Server ............................................................................................................... 669

32.2 Backup History Data and Update Recipe Data ................................................................ 671

Chapter 33 EasyDiagnoser ............................................................................................................. 673

33.1 Overview and Configuration ............................................................................................ 673

33.2 EasyDiagnoser Settings .................................................................................................... 676

33.3 Error Code ........................................................................................................................ 682

33.4 Save As ............................................................................................................................. 683

33.5 Window Adjustment ........................................................................................................ 684

Chapter 34 Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names ....................................................................... 685

34.1 Import User-Defined Tag CSV File to EasyBuilder Pro ..................................................... 686

34.2 Adding New Data Type .................................................................................................... 688

34.3 Paste ................................................................................................................................. 690

34.4 Miscellaneous .................................................................................................................. 693

34.5 Module-Defined ............................................................................................................... 697

Chapter 35 Easy Watch .................................................................................................................. 701

35.1 Overview .......................................................................................................................... 701

35.1.1What’s Easy Watch? .............................................................................................. 701

35.1.2 Why Design Easy Watch? ...................................................................................... 701

35.2 Basic Functions ................................................................................................................. 702

35.2.1 Basic Functions ...................................................................................................... 702

35.2.2 Quick Selection Tools ............................................................................................ 704

35.3 Monitor Settings .............................................................................................................. 705

35.3.1 Add Monitor .......................................................................................................... 705

35.3.2 Monitor Settings ................................................................................................... 705

35.3.3 Add New Device .................................................................................................... 706

35.4 Macro Settings ................................................................................................................. 709

35.4.1 Add Macro............................................................................................................. 709

35.4.2 Macro Settings ...................................................................................................... 709

35.4.3 Add New Macros to the List.................................................................................. 709

8

EasyBuilder Pro User Manual

35.5 HMI Manager ................................................................................................................... 711

35.5.1 HMI Settings .......................................................................................................... 711

35.5.2 HMI Manager ........................................................................................................ 711

35.5.3 Add New Device .................................................................................................... 711

35.6 Object List ........................................................................................................................ 713

35.6.1 Page Settings ......................................................................................................... 713

35.6.2 Columns of Object List .......................................................................................... 713

Chapter 36 Administrator Tools ..................................................................................................... 715

36.1 Overview: ......................................................................................................................... 715

36.2 User Accounts .................................................................................................................. 716

36.2.1 Introduction of User Accounts .............................................................................. 716

36.2.2 Setting User Accounts ........................................................................................... 718

36.2.3 Import accounts via EasyBuilder Pro .................................................................... 720

36.3 USB Security Key .............................................................................................................. 721

36.3.1 Introduction of USB Security Key .......................................................................... 721

36.3.2 Setting USB Security Key ....................................................................................... 722

36.3.3 EasyBuilder Pro USB Security Key Settings ........................................................... 723

36.4 e-Mail SMTP Server Settings ............................................................................................ 724

36.4.1 Introduction of e-Mail SMTP Server Settings ....................................................... 724

36.4.2 e-Mail SMTP Server Settings ................................................................................. 725

36.5 e-Mail Contacts ................................................................................................................ 726

36.5.1 Introduction of e-Mail Contacts............................................................................ 726

36.5.2 e-Mail Contacts Settings ....................................................................................... 728

36.5.3 Use EasyBuilder Pro to Import e-Mail Settings and Contacts .............................. 730

9

EasyBuilder Pro Installation and Startup Guide

Chapter 1 EasyBuilder Pro Installation and Startup Guide

1.1 EasyBuilder Pro Installation

Software:

Download EasyBuilder Pro configuration software from EasyBuilder Pro CD or visiting

Weintek Labs, Inc.’s website at http://www.weintek.com

to obtain all software versions available (including Simplified Chinese, Traditional Chinese, English, Italian, Korean,

Spanish, Russian, and French version) and latest upgraded files.

Hardware Requirements (Recommended):

CPU: INTEL Pentium II or higher

Memory: 256MB or higher

Hard Disk: 2.5GB or higher (Disc space available at least 500MB)

CD-ROM: 4X or higher

Display: 256 color SVGA with 1024 x 768 resolution or greater

Keyboard and Mouse

Ethernet: for project downloading/uploading

USB Port 2.0: for project downloading/uploading

RS-232 COM: At least one available RS-232 serial port required for on-line simulation

Printer

Operating System:

Windows XP / Windows Vista / Windows 7.

10

EasyBuilder Pro Installation and Startup Guide

1.2 Steps to Install EasyBuilder Pro

1. Installing EasyBuilder Pro:

Put the EasyBuilder Pro Installation CD into the CD drive. The computer will run the program automatically and bring up a screen showing an area to click to begin the

EasyBuilder Pro installation. If the auto-run sequence does not start, browse the CD, and find the root directory of [Autorun.exe] manually. The installation screen is shown below.

2. Click [Install], users will see the window below, select the language and click [Next] following the installation instructions.

English,Spanish,French,Italian,

Simplified Chinese,Traditional

Chinese,Korean,Russian

11

EasyBuilder Pro Installation and Startup Guide

3. Users will be asked if they would like to remove the old versions of EasyBuilder.

Please tick those should be removed and click [Next] to continue.

12

EasyBuilder Pro Installation and Startup Guide

4. Designate a new folder for EasyBuilder Pro installation or choose the folder recommended and then click [Next].

5. Users will be enquired to select a start menu folder to save the program’s shortcuts. Click

[Browse] to designate a folder or use the folder recommended then click [Next].

13

EasyBuilder Pro Installation and Startup Guide

6. Users will be enquired if there are any additional tasks to be done. For example:

[Create

a desktop icon]. Tick it if needed then click [Next] to continue.

7. At this moment all the settings are done. Please check if they are all correct. If any changes need to be made, click [Back] or click [Install] to start installing.

14

EasyBuilder Pro Installation and Startup Guide

8. Installation processing.

9. Click [Finish] to complete the installation.

15

EasyBuilder Pro Installation and Startup Guide

10. Start EasyBuilder Pro project from menu [Start] / [All Programs] / [EasyBuilder Pro].

The description of each item in EasyBuilder Pro menu:

Installed file

Administrator

Description

Save data of User Accounts, USB Security Key, e-Mail SMTP

Tool Server Setting, e-Mail Contacts to USB disk and import to HMI.

EasyBuilder Pro EasyBuilder Pro editing software.

EasyConverter Conversion tool for Data Sampling and Event Log.

EasyDiagnoser Tool for analyzing and detecting connection between HMI and PLC.

EasyPrinter

Tool for saving hardcopy or backup data is individually downloadable even without full application.

EasySimulator

EasyWatch

Recipe Editor

Release Note

Upon completion of project programming, you can execute Online

Simulation on PC by directly connect with PLC or Offline Simulation on PC without connecting PLC.

Via HMI to monitor or set HMI and PLC address value.

Tool for setting format of Recipe data. Users can open Recipe data or data in External Memory here.

Notes for EasyBuilder Pro version and latest information.

Support AB TAG mechanism and improve the flexibility of an object

Structure Editor in read/write.

Utility Manager EasyBuilder Pro project management.

■ HMI eMT Series support downloading/uploading project via USB cable.

After installing EasyBuilder Pro, Please go to [Computer Management] /

[Device Manager] to check if USB driver is also installed, if not, please refer to installation steps to manually install.

16

Utility Manager

Chapter 2 Utility Manager

0B

After installing EasyBuilder Pro software, double click on [Utility Manager] shortcut.

1B

The Utlity Manager is a software shell for launching several utilities. Some functions are duplicated in the EasyBuilder Pro project editing program. Utlity Manager can operate as a

76B2 B stand-alone program.

When operating HMI, designate Password first.

After rebooting, everything returns to the startup condition.

Connect via USB cable or Ethernet to check the HMI history files information.

Launch project editor.

Conversion tool for

Data Sampling/

Event Log.

Remote printer

/backup server.

Review the register range of device types of supported PLC.

Tool for analyzing connection between

HMI and PLC.

Memory format conversion and data editing.

Build data for downloading to HMI via SD/USB.

Allow PC applications to connect PLC via

HMI.

17

Utility Manager

2.1 HMI IP, Password

84B3 B

[Settings]

4B

When operating HMI via

Ethernet or USB cable, users need to designate the password for HMI to protect against unauthorized access.

5B

[Reset / Download] functions share a set of password while [Upload] function uses another set.

6B

Be sure to record any password change, otherwise, while resetting password to default, the project and data on HMI will be completely erased.

82B7 B

[Reboot HMI]

8B

There are certain situations that the HMI should reboot, for example, when updating the files in it. Users don’t need to cut power while rebooting. After rebooting, everything returns to the conditions of startup. Set the correct IP address when operating HMI via

Ethernet.

9B

[Data/Event Log File Information]

10B

After setting, connect with HMI to check the number of history files in HMI.

18

Utility Manager

2.2 Editing Tools

2.2.1 Build Download Data for Saving in SD Card or USB Disk

1. Insert SD/USB to PC.

2. Assign data storing path.

3. Assign files to download.

4. Build data.

The source files will be saved in the inserted device for users to download to HMI. This function is to build the required data.

77B

19

Utility Manager

2.2.2 Steps to Download Project to HMI via USB or SD Card

11B

Take downloading data in the folder named “ 123” (K:\123) in USB stick for example.

1.

2.

3.

13B

12B

Insert USB (project included.) to HMI.

On [Download / Upload] dialog box select [Download].

14B

Input Download Password.

4.

5.

6.

15B

On [Download Settings] dialog box, check [Download project files] and [Download

history files].

16B

Press [OK].

17B

On [Pick a Directory] dialog box, select directory: usbdisk/device-0/123.

7.

18B

Press [OK].

19B

Project will be automatically updated.

20B

Even if users only download historical files, it is still necessary to reboot

HMI manually to update files.

20

Utility Manager

2.3 Transfer

2.3.1 Download

21B

Download source files to HMI through Ethernet or USB cable.

{7

Firmware

22B

Check to update HMI kernel programs. The firmware must be downloaded at the first time downloading data to HMI.

Project

Select the project file in XOB format.

Recipe Data RW/RW_A

Select rcp file in recipe folder.

Data Log

Select dtl file in datalog folder.

21

Utility Manager

26B

Startup Screen

Download assigned BMP to HMI. On HMI, it will be shown after rebooting then load in project. Users may use company logos.

27B

Reboot HMI after downloading

Automatically reboot after download.

28B

[Reset recipe] [Reset event log] [Reset data log] [Reset event log] [Resect data log]

29B

Erase specified files on HMI before download.

22

Utility Manager

2.3.2 Upload

30B

Upload files from HMI to PC via Ethernet or USB cable.

31B

Users have to assign the desired path for file storage before uploading.

85B

About [Project] / [Recipe data RW/RW_A] / [Data log] refer to 2.3.1.

Event log

Upload evt file on HMI to PC.

Extended Memory (EM)

Upload emi file saved in SD card or USB disk to PC.

32B

The file will be uploaded to PC in *.XOB file format. For editing this file using EasyBuilder Pro, please decompile it into *. MTP file first.

23

Utility Manager

2.4 Simulation

2.4.1 Off-line Simulation / On-line Simulation

4

Off-line simulation-Simulate project operation on PC.

Simulate operations without connecting PLC.

OK without HMI

&PLC and save more time

80B

79B

41B

On-line simulation-Simulate project operation on PC.

Connect

PC-PLC & set correct parameters to operate.

No need to download project to HMI.

33B

When On-line simulating on PC, if the control target is a local PLC (i.e. the

PLC directly connected to PC), there is

10 minutes simulation limit.

24

Utility Manager

Before executing On-line/Off-line Simulation features, please select the source *.XOB file.

34B

When executing on-line/off-line simulation, right click to use these functions:

[Exit simulation]

Stop simulating.

35B

[Run EasyDiagnoser]

36B

To monitor current communication status.

37B

[Screenshot]

38B

Capture and save current screen image as picture file in the screenshot folder under installation directory.

25

Utility Manager

2.5 Pass-Through

This function allows the PC application to connect PLC via HMI. In this case, the HMI acts as a converter.

43B

Pass-through provides two modes: [Ethernet] and [COM port].

44B

When using [Ethernet], please install the virtual serial port driver first.

39B

For detail, please refer to “Chapter 29 Pass Through Function”.

26

Create an EasyBuilder Pro Project

Chapter 3 Create an EasyBuilder Pro Project

Click on the icons to see illustration.

Create a

Project

Save &

Compile

On-line

Off-line

Simulation

In this Chapter, we will take Mitsubishi PLC as an example.

3.1 Create a New Project

Download to HMI

1. Click on icon New.

2. Select [Model].

3. Tick [Use template].

4. Click [OK].

5. Click

[New].

6. Set correct parameters.

7. Click

[OK].

8. Device “MISUBISHI

FX0s/FX0n/FX1s/FX2” is added to the [Device List].

27

Create an EasyBuilder Pro Project

Now let’s add a new object.

1. Click on the object icon Toggle Switch Object.

2. Set correct parameters.

3. Place the object wherever you like on window.

4. A project with one object is now created.

28

Create an EasyBuilder Pro Project

3.2 Save and Compile the Project

On EasyBuilder Pro Tool Bar:

1. Click to [Save] *.MTP file.

Users are allowed to select the languages needed for the project and download to HMI, up to 8 languages can be selected.

2. Click to [Compile] to *.XOB file for downloading to HMI, this also checks if the project can run correctly.

A successfully compiled file will get this dialog box.

29

Create an EasyBuilder Pro Project

3.3 Off-line and On-line Simulation

Off-line simulation - Simulate project operation on PC

OK without HMI

&PLC and save more time.

Simulate operations without connecting PLC.

On-line simulation - Simulate project operation on PC

OK without HMI and save more time.

Connect

PC-PLC & set correct parameters.

When On-line simulating on PC, if the control target is a local PLC (i.e. the

PLC directly connected to PC), there is 10 minutes simulation limit.

Off-line

Click

On-line

Click after correctly connecting the device.

30

Create an EasyBuilder Pro Project

3.4 Download the Project to HMI

Way 1 [Ethernet] / HMI IP

Before [Download], be sure to check if all the settings are correct.

Input [Password] &

Specify [HMI IP].

Update HMI kernel programs. Must do this when first time download files to HMI.

Download the font used in project.

The selected files will be erased before downloading.

HMI will reboot after downloading.

If this is checked, system will download project to HMI according to last settings.

Please see illustration below.

31

2. Tick

Create an EasyBuilder Pro Project

The way to enable this function:

1. Click [Function Properties].

2. Tick [Automatic save and compile when download and simulate].

3. [Save] project.

4. Click [Download].

5. On dialog box, tick

[Automatically using current settings to download after

compiling].

6. Click [Download].

7. After finish setting, next time when click [Download],

EasyBuilder Pro will automatically compile and download project to the latest target HMI.

32

4

.

Create an EasyBuilder Pro Project

Way 2 [Ethernet] / HMI Name

1. On HMI set HMI name first.

2. On PC, select the set HMI name and start downloading.

Input the HMI name to search the designated HMI.

Click to search the HMIs share the same network.

33

4

.

Create an EasyBuilder Pro Project

Way 3 [USB Cable]

Select USB cable to download project to HMI.

The way of setting is same as Way 1 mentioned above. USB cable only works for i

Series HMI.

■ Before downloading via USB cable, please make sure the USB driver is correctly installed. Go to [Computer Management] / [Device Manager] to check if USB driver is installed, if not, please refer to installation steps to manually install.

34

4

.

Create an EasyBuilder Pro Project

Way 4 [USB Disk / SD Card]

1. In Utility Manager click

[Build Download

Data for CF / SD / USB

Disk] to build the data to be downloaded first. Generally divided into 2 directories, if set as the way shown:

The download data storing structure:

This directory is generated when downloading history data.

2. Insert external devices to HMI.

3. Select [Download] and input correct password.

4. Password confirmed, show directories in external device.(pccard: SD/CF Card;usbdisk: USB Disk)

5. Select a directory for storing project then click [OK] to start downloading.

Please select

the top layer directory of the target file when downloading.

For the structure above, select

download, not eMT3000 or history.

35

Hardware Settings

Chapter 4 Hardware Settings

4.1 I/O Ports of HMI

The I/O ports are different form one HMI type to another.

Download/ Upload project via SD

Card, including Recipe transfer,

Event Log, Data Log…etc and to backup or record History data.

Connects PLC or other peripheral devices.

RS-232 / RS-485 2W/4W / CAN Bus

RS-422 = RS-485 4W

Connects Ethernet devices, such as

PLC, laptop, for exchanging data via Network.

Supports USB devices, such as mouse, keyboard, USB disk, printer

Download/ Upload project including

Recipe transfer, Event Log, Data

Log…etc.

In addition, Weintek provides [FLZ232000 Multi-Connector Cable] and [FLZ485000

Multi-Connector Cable] to expand one COM port to multiple independent COM ports so that the convenience and efficiency of operation can be improved.

36

Hardware Settings

4.2 HMI System Settings

For the first time operating HMI, users have to complete the HMI system settings. After this, users can develop their own operation interface through EasyBuilder Pro editing software.

4.2.1 System Reset

Each HMI is equipped with a set of reset button and DIP switch. When using DIP switch to change modes, the corresponding functions will be triggered.

If system password is lost or forgotten, please set DIP

Switch 1 to “ON” and the rest remain “OFF”, then reboot

HMI. HMI will switch to touch screen calibration mode.

1. A “+” sign appears on the screen, touch the center of the sign, after all 5 signs are touched, “+” disappears and the touch screen parameter will be stored in HMI system.

2. After calibration, confirm to restore the system password to the default, select [YES].

3. Confirm to restore to default password again by typing [yes] and clicking [OK]. The project files and history records stored in HMI will all be removed.

(The default password is 111111. However, other passwords, including download/upload passwords have to be reset.)

37

Hardware Settings

SW1 SW2 SW3 SW4

ON

OFF

OFF OFF

OFF OFF OFF

ON

Reserved

OFF OFF OFF OFF Normal

Mode

OFF OFF OFF Touch screen calibration mode

ON

OFF OFF Hide system toolbar

ON

OFF Boot loader mode

4.2.2 System Toolbar

After rebooting HMI, users can set the system with System Toolbar at the bottom of the screen. Normally, this bar is hidden automatically. Only by touching the target at the bottom-right corner of the screen will the System Toolbar pops up.

How to hide HMI System Setting Toolbar

EasyBuilder Pro supports the function of using system tag [LB-9020] to enable/disable system setting bar, or set the [DIP Switch 2] to ON/OFF for activating this function.

When [LB-9020] is set ON, the bar is displayed, and set OFF to hide the system setting bar.

When [DIP Switch 2] is set ON, the system setting bar is disabled, and when set OFF; the system setting bar is able to control. Users have to restart HMI to enable/disable this function.

Note: [LB-9020] is available for all HMI series. [DIP Switch 2] is available for eMT Series.

Text Keyboard Number Keyboard

38

Hardware Settings

4.2.3 System Information

Network: Display network information & HMI IP. Version: Display HMI system version.

4.2.4 System Setting

Set or modify system parameters.

Confirm password for security.

Security

Password protection, default 111111.

+

Network

Download project to HMI via Ethernet.

Confirm IP address of target HMI.

[Assign IP by local DHCP] or

[Manually input IP information].

39

[Password for entering system]

[Password for uploading project]

[Password for downloading project]

[Password for uploading history data]

Password confirmation window:

Hardware Settings

Time/Date

Setting HMI local time/date.

History

Clear history data on HMI.

[Recipe] / [Eventlog] / [Datalog]

Miscellaneous

Rolling button for adjusting LCD brightness.

■ F irmware setting

Upgrade firmware / enable portrait mode.

40

Hardware Settings

HMI name

Set HMI name to download/upload project.

1. Enable HMI VNC server, set password.

2. Install Java IE or VNC Viewer on PC.

3-1 Input remote HMI IP in IE, example: http://192.168.1.28。

3-2 In VNC Viewer input remote HMI IP and password.

VNC server

Remote HMI monitoring and controlling.

41

Hardware Settings automatically.

One HMI allows only one user to log in VNC server at one time. When leaving VNC server unused for one hour, HMI system will log out

42

System Parameter Settings

Chapter 5 System Parameter Settings

Enter EasyBuilder Pro, select menu

[Edit] / [System Parameters…] and the [System

Parameter Settings] dialog appears:

System Parameter Settings are divided into several parts:

[Device], [Model], [General],

[System Setting], [Security], [Font], [Extended Memory], [Printer/Backup Server],

[e-Mail] and [Recipes].

These will be introduced respectively in this chapter.

43

5.1 Device

System Parameter Settings

Parameters in

[Device] tab determine all of the attributes of each device controlled by the

HMI they are connected with. The device can be a PLC, a remote HMI, or a PC.

After opening a new *.mtp file in EasyBuilder Pro, a default device: “Local HMI” is shown in the

[Device List]. This “Local HMI” is used to identify current HMI, which means, every

*.mtp file must at least contains one “Local HMI” in

[Device List].

Select

[Settings] under the device list, A dialogue [Device Properties] will be shown as below. From this we know that the attribute of “Local HMI” is a “HMI” and the location is

“Local”.

44

System Parameter Settings

5.1.1 How to Control a Local PLC

The so-called “local PLC” means a PLC which is connected to the local HMI directly. To control a local PLC, users need to add this type of device first. Click

[New…] under the

Device list and the

[Device Properties] dialog appears. Please correctly fill in all of the properties required.

Take a local PLC MITSUBISHI FX0s/FX0n/FX1s/FX1n/FX2 as an example:

Setting

Name

HMI or PLC

Location

Description

The name of the device set by user.

To confirm whether this connected device is a HMI or PLC. It’s [PLC] in this example.

[Local] or [Remote]. Showing whether this device is connected to

Local HMI or being remote controlled. Select [Local] in this case.

45

PLC type

PLC I/F

System Parameter Settings

Type of PLC. Select FX0s/FX0n/FX1s/FX1n/FX2 in this case.

Some PLC interfaces are available: [RS-232], [RS-485 2W], [RS-485

4W], [Ethernet], [USB].

If the interface is [RS-232], [RS-485 2W], or [RS-485 4W], click

[Settings…] and then [Com Port Settings] dialog appears. Users need to correctly set the COM port communication parameters.

[Timeout]

If the communication between PLC and HMI is disconnected over the set time limit in [Timeout] parameter, a pop out window No. 5 will be shown in HMI as an alert saying “PLC No Response”.

[Turn around delay]

While sending the next command to PLC, HMI will delay it according to the set time interval in [Turn around delay] parameter. This may influence the efficiency of the communication between HMI and PLC.

If no specific request to be made, “0” is to be set.

If the PLC used is in SIEMENS S7-200 Series, this parameter needs to be set to “5” and [Parameter 1] “30”.

If the interface is [Ethernet], click [Settings…] and then [IP Address

Settings] dialogue appears. Users need to correctly set IP address and Port no. of the PLC.

46

System Parameter Settings

PLC default station no.

If the interface is [USB], no further settings need to be done. Please check if all the settings in [Device Properties] are correct.

The default station no. of PLC address. EasyBuilder Pro will use this value as PLC station no.

In addition, station no. can be set in the read address of PLC directly.

Take address 1#20 as an example.

Default station no. use station no. variable

“1” means PLC station no, and has to be named from 0 to 255.

“20” means PLC address, the “#” sign is used to separate station no. and address.

When setting PLC properties, station no. variables can be selected and used as [PLC default station no.]. LW10000~LW10015 can be used to set station no. variables.

When using this function, if the station no. is not specified for PLC address, it will be decided by the station no. variable of default station no. In this example var3 is set for default station no. The following demonstrates how the PLC address station no. is set.

47

System Parameter Settings a. The station number of PLC is “5”. b. The PLC station no. is decided by var7 (LW-10007) c. PLC address is set to “111”, since PLC station no. is not specified, and the default station no. is using var3, the PLC station no. is decided by var3 (LW-10003).

Use broadcast command

This is for setting the station no. of broadcast command. Command for the users of this set station no. will be seen as broadcast command.

For example, if the broadcast station number is set to 255, HMI with an address such as 255#200, will send this command to all the PLC connected to it, but will ignore the replies of PLC after receiving this command. (This only works on Modbus).

Interval of block pack

(words)

If the interval between read addresses of different commands is less than this value, these commands can be combined to one. But combining function is disabled if this value is “0”.

For example, the interval value is set to “5” and users would like to read out 1 word from LW3 and 2 words from LW6 respectively.

(Means to read from LW6 to LW7) . Since the interval of addresses between LW3 and LW6 is less than 5, these two commands can be combined to one. The contents of combination therefore become 5 consecutive words from LW3 (read from LW3~LW7).

Note: Maximum command combination data size must be less than

[Max. read-command size].

The Max. data size to be read out from device at one time. Unit: word

Max. read-command size (words)

Max. write-command size (words)

The Max. data size to be written to device at one time. Unit: word.

48

System Parameter Settings

After all settings are completed, a new device named “Local PLC 1” is added to the

[Device

list].

49

System Parameter Settings

5.1.2 How to Control a Remote PLC

The so -called “remote PLC” means a PLC connected to a remote HMI. To control a remote

PLC, users need to add this type of device. Click

[New…] under [Device list] and the

[Device Properties] dialog appears. Users need to set all the required properties correctly.

Here take a remote PLC, SIEMENS S7-200, as an example:

Setting

HMI or PLC

Description

This is to confirm whether this device is a HMI or PLC.

It is [PLC] in this case.

50

Location

System Parameter Settings

Users can select [Local] or [Remote]. Select [Remote] in this case and set the IP address of the remote HMI which is connected to

SIEMENS S7-200 PLC. Click [Settings…] of [Location] to set this IP address.

PLC Type

PLC I/F

Type of PLC. Select SIEMENS S7-200 in this case.

This setting defines which interface the remote PLC uses. If the remote PLC uses a COM port, interface used should be selected from

[RS-232], [RS-485 2W], and [RS485 4W].

This setting defines which default station no. is used by remote PLC.

PLC default

station no.

COM

This setting defines which COM port the remote PLC uses to connect with remote HMI. The settings should be correct.

After all settings are completed, a new device named “Remote PLC” is added to the

[Device list].

51

System Parameter Settings

5.1.3 How to Control a Remote HMI

The so-called “remote HMI” means through network, this HMI is controlled by a local HMI or a PC running on-line simulation. To control a remote HMI, users need to add this type of device. Click

[New…] under [Device list] and the [Device Properties] dialog appears.

Users need to set all the required properties correctly.

Setting

HMI or PLC

Description

This is to confirm whether this device is a HMI or PLC.

It is [HMI] in this case.

52

Location

System Parameter Settings

Users can select [Local] or [Remote]. Select [Remote] in this case and set the [IP address] and [Port no.] of the remote HMI. Click

[Settings…] of [Location] to set these, the dialogue is shown below.

The [Port no.] of remote HMI can be seen in [Model] in [System

parameters] once the* .mtp file of remote HMI is opened. The port no. of remote HMI and local HMI must be the same.

After all settings are completed, a new device named “Remote HMI” is added to the

[Device list].

53

System Parameter Settings

5.2 Model

Parameters in

[Model] tab determine the HMI model, [Timer] and [Printer] settings.

Setting

HMI model

Description

Select current HMI model as shown below.

When changing HMI model and press [OK], users will be inquired if they would like to [Resize pop-up windows or objects].

54

HMI station no.

Port no.

Timer

System Parameter Settings

Set the [HMI station no.] used by current HMI. If no specific request is to be made, just use the default number.

Set the [Port no.] used by current HMI. It is used as port no. of

MODBUS server. If no specific request is to be made, just use the default number.

[Clock source]

To set up the signal for timer object. The time information of timer is used by [Data Sampling], [Event Log] ….etc. which are objects that need the time records. a. [HMI RTC] means the time signal comes from internal clock of the

HMI. b. [External device] means the time signal comes from external device. To correctly set source address of time signal is necessary.

Take the illustration below as an example: It indicates the source of time signal is from “TV” of the “Local PLC”. The source address “TV” starts from address 0 contains 6 consecutive words and each of them contains the following information:

TV 0 → Second (the limited range: 0~59)

TV 1 → Minute (the limited range: 0~59)

TV 2 → Hour (the limited range: 0~23)

TV 3 → Day (the limited range: 1~31)

TV 4 → Month (the limited range: 1~12)

TV 5 → Year (the limit range: 1970~2037)

55

System Parameter Settings

Printer

[Type]

Display printers supported. For HP PCL Series, it has to be connected through USB interface while other printers through COM port. For more information, please refer to “Chapter 23 HMI Supported Printers”.

Using [COM] port to connect printer, users should set accurate parameters. When the type of printer is [SP-M, D, E, F], the [pixels of

width] has to be set accurately, i.e. the set pixel(s) can not exceed printer’s default setting. Otherwise this printing won’t succeed.

56

System Parameter Settings

5.3 General

Parameters in

[General] tab determine all properties related to screen display.

57

Setting

Fast selection button

System Parameter Settings

Description

Setting all the attributes for fast selection button that is designated as window number 3.

a. [Attribute]

Screen

saver

Option

Enable or disable fast selection window. Select [Enable] and click

[Settings…] to set the attributes, including color and text.

b. [Position]

Select the position on the screen of HMI where this button appears. If

[Left] is chosen, the button will show up on screen bottom-left; if [Right] is chosen, the button will show up on screen bottom-right.

a. [Back light saver]

If the screen is left untouched and reaches the time limit set here, back light will be off. The setting unit is minute. Back light will be on again once the screen is touched. If [none] is set, the back light will always be on while using.

b. [Screen saver]

If the screen is left untouched and reaches the time limit set here. The current screen will automatically switch to a window assigned in

[Saver

window no.].The setting unit is minute. If [none] is set, this function is disabled.

c. [Saver window no.]

To assign a window for screen saver.

a. [Startup window no.]

Designate the window shown when start up HMI.

b. [Common window]

The objects in the common window (window 4) will be shown in each base window. This selection determines the layers these objects are placed above or below the objects in the base window.

58

System Parameter Settings

c. [Keyboard caret color]

Set the color of caret that appears when inputting in [Numeric Input] and

[Word Input] objects.

d. [Object layout]

Event

If [Control] mode is selected, when operating HMI, [Animation] and

[Moving Shape] objects will be displayed above other kinds of objects neglecting the sequence that the objects are created. If [Nature] mode is selected, the display will follow the sequence that the objects are created, first created be displayed first.

e. [RW_A enabled]

Enable or disable recipe data RW_A. Enable this, the objects can then control the content of RW_A .The size of RW_A is 64K.

[Extra no. of events]

The default number of the event in the system is 1000. If users would like to add more records, the setting value can be modified up to 10000.

Keyboard

Users can select to use different types of keyboards for [Numeric Input] and [Word Input]. Up to 32 keyboards can be added. If users want to design their own keyboard, a window should be designated for creating it. Press [add] after creating, and add the window to the list. For more information, please see “Chapter 12 Key Pad Design and Usage” where also shows how to fix this keyboard in screen instead of adding it to the list.

Project protection (i series only)

User’s project can be restrained and executed on specific HMI. Please refer to “Chapter 30 Project protection” for more information.

59

System Parameter Settings

5.4 System Setting

Parameters in

[System Setting] tab are for setting up miscellaneous functions of

EasyBuilder Pro.

Some functions are duplicated from system tag, such as, [Hide system setting bar

(LB-9020)], [Hide mouse cursor (LB-9018)], [Disable buzzer (LB-9019)], [Prohibit remote

HMI connecting this machine (LB-9044)], and. It means that user can also operate these

60

System Parameter Settings functions via system tag. To select a system tag, users can tick

[system tag] of the

[address] while adding new object. To check all the system tags, users can visit [Library] in EasyBuilder Pro, select [Tag] then [System].

[Startup language after redownloading the project]

Set the language to use when start up HMI after redownloading the project.

[Execute init. Macro when power on]

Designate the macro to be executed when HMI power on.

[Auto logout]

If HMI is left unused for longer than the time set here, HMI will logout automatically.

[Hide System Setting Bar]

Hide the system setting bar on the lower-right corner of the HMI screen.

[Hide Mouse Cursor]

Hide the mouse cursor on HMI screen.

[Disable Buzzer]

Mute HMI.

[Prohibit remote HMI connecting to this machine]

Prohibit the function of connecting remote HMI.

[Disable upload function (effective after rebooting HMI) (or set LB9033 ON)]

Disable HMI to upload project, after downloading, HMI must be rebooted to disable uploading project.

[Prohibit password remote-read operation (or set LB9053 ON)]

Prohibit remote HMI to read local HMI password.

[Prohibit password remote-write operation (or set LB9054 ON)]

Prohibit remote HMI to write local HMI password.

[Use a disconnection icon on relative objects when PLC communication fails]

Decide whether or not to display a disconnection icon on relevant objects when failing to communicate with PLC.

When using this function and fail to communicate with PLC, this icon will be shown in the lower right corner of the object as shown:

61

System Parameter Settings

[VNC Server]

Set the login password for VNC server.

[LW protection], [RW protection]

If users check [Disable LW/RW remote-write] and set the protect range in [LW/RW

range], values of this protected range can’t be adjusted via remote HMI.

[Easy Access server]

Through this technology, users can easily access to any HMI connected to the internet and operate them on PC just like holding touch screen in hand.

Unlike most server used in HMI, Easy Access don’t need to transmit updated graphic image but real time data only. This makes transmission really quick and efficient.

For further information, please refer to “EasyAccess”.

62

System Parameter Settings

5.5 Security

Parameters in

[Security] tab determine the classes accessible for each user to adjust the objects, and users’ password. The security classes of objects are classified from

[A~F], and

[none] for not ticking any class. Up to twelve passwords can be set. Only numeral setting is acceptable for password and the range is 0~999999999.

5.5.1 General mode

According to the security setting, EasyBuilder Pro will control the classes accessible for each user to adjust the objects once they input their passwords.

In EasyBuilder Pro, while constructing a project, the security classes of objects are classified from

[A~F], and [None] and can be set as shown below.

If

[None] is set, every user can access to adjust this object.

For example, when the security class of User1 is set as below, only objects with class A, B,

C and “none” can the user adjust. For more information, please see “Chapter 10 Security”.

63

System Parameter Settings

[Project password (MTP file)]

Users can set password to protect the MTP file in

[System parameter] / [Security tab].

Users have to input the password set here when they want to edit the MTP file.

(MTP password range: 1~4294967295)

Tick

[Enable] then click [Setting], and the window is as shown below.

Before editing project, a pop-up window will ask for password to access the project.

64

System Parameter Settings

5.5.2

Enhanced security mode

[Select operatable classes for each user]

When ticking [Use existing user accounts on HMI, the operable objects for each user will be decided according to HMI setting.

If not ticking, set user account and password as shown below.

65

System Parameter Settings

[Administrator]

Select secret users.

[Control address]

Designate the control address of setting user password.

[Project password (MTP file)]

Please refer to 5.5.1

66

System Parameter Settings

5.6 Font

Parameters in

[Font] tab determine the font of non-ASCII which is used in EasyBuilder Pro

.

67

System Parameter Settings

[Fonts for non- strings]

Fonts for non-ASCII strings are listed above. When users use non-ASCII character set or double byte character set ( including simplified or traditional Chinese character, Japanese, or Korean) which is not listed in

[Fonts for non-ASCII strings] table, EasyBuilder Pro will select a font from the list to substitute for it automatically.

Users can also test which non-ASCII strings of Windows can be used in EasyBuilder Pro and add them to

[Fonts for non-ASCII strings] table.

[Line spacing]

Decide the interval between lines in the text.

68

System Parameter Settings

5.7 Extended Memory

Parameters in

[Extended Memory] tab determine the path of the extended memory.

Extended Memory is numbered from EM0 to EM9. Method to use extended memory is similar to that of other device type (i.e. LW or RW address). Users can simply select from

[Device type] list while adding a new object. Size of each extended memory is up to 2G word.

69

System Parameter Settings

Data in extended memory is stored in

[SD card], [USB disk],in a form of a file. The files in extended memory

[EM0] ~ [EM9] are entitled as em0.emi~em9.emi. Users can use

RecipeEditor.exe to open the file and edit the data in the extended memory.

Data in extended memory will not be erased when power is cut, which means next time when user start HMI again, data in extended memory remains just the same before power off. This is similar to Recipe data (EW, RW_A). What is different is that users can select where they want to save the data (SD card, USB disk)

To read data in extended memory from a removed device, the content of data will be viewed as “0”; if users would like to write data to a removed device, the "PLC no response" message will appear in HMI.

EasyBuilder Pro supports "hot swapping" function for SD card and USB devices. Users can insert or remove the device for extended memory without cutting the power. With this function, users can update or take data in extended memory.

70

System Parameter Settings

5.8 Printer/Backup Server

Parameters in

[Printer/Backup Server] tab are for setting up MT remote printer.

Setting Description

Output settings [Orientation]

Set how will words or pictures be printed out, [horizontal] or

[vertical].

[Printer size]

Set to print out in original size or to fit the set printer margins.

[Margin]

Set the top, bottom, right and left margin width.

Communication settings

[IP address]

Assign the IP address of a remote printer via network.

[Port], [User name], [Password]

Assign the access information.

Port can be set from 1 to 65535.

Maximum length of user name or password is 12 characters.

Please refer “Chapter 26 Easy Printer” for more information.

71

System Parameter Settings

5.9 e-Mail

Parameters in

[e-Mail] tab are for setting up e-Mail function.

[Enable e-Mail function]

72

System Parameter Settings

Settings

SMTP settings

Sender

Information

Open

Contact

Settings

Description

[Server]

Set SMTP Server.

[Port]

Set communication port.

[User name]

Set e-mail address.

[Password]

Set e-mail password.

[Confirm Password]

Confirm e-mail password.

[Log on using Secure Password Authentication (SPA)]

Decide whether SPA is needed when login e-mail.

[Use the following type of encrypted connection]

Decide whether the encrypted connections (TLS, SSL) are needed when sending e-mail.

[Name]

Specify a name or use HMI name.

[Mail Address]

Setting e-mail address.

[Contact List]

Add or remove contacts from the list.

[Group Information]

Group up contacts.

[No. of groups]

Set no. of contact groups, according to the number, the groups are named form A~P and up to 16 groups can be set.

73

System Parameter Settings

[Current group]

Current group.

[Description]

Description of the group.

For further information please refer to “Chapter 7 Event Log”.

[Use existing contact settings on HMI]

When checking this, the system will use the contact settings on HMI.

74

System Parameter Settings

5.10 Recipes

Parameters in

[Recipes] tab are for setting up recipe relevant data.

Settings

Recipes

List

New

Description

[New(Insert)]

Add a new recipe item.

[Delete]

Delete an existing recipe item.

[Item name]

Enter recipe item name.

[Data type]

Setting item data type.

[Size]

Setting the size of the item.

[Display width]

Setting the width to display the item.

[Decimal Pt.]

Setting the decimal place.

[Alignment]

Setting the alignment.

75

System Parameter Settings

Settings

All the item information can be user-defined and modified.

Delete

Delete the selected items.

For further information please refer to “Chapter 24 Recipe Database Editor”.

76

Window Operations

Chapter 6 Window Operations

A window is a basic element in a project. With a window, all kinds of information like objects, pictures, and text can be shown on HMI screen. 1997 windows numbered from 3~1999 in

EasyBuilder Pro can be built and edited.

6.1 Window Types

There are 4 types of windows, each with different functions and usages:

(1) Base Window (2) Fast Selection Window (3) Common Window

(4) System Message Window

6.1.1 Base Window

The most frequently used window, used as:

■ main screen

■ background for other windows

■ keyboard window

■ pop-up window for [function key] object.

■ pop-up window for [direct window] and

[indirect window] objects.

■ screen saver

The screen simulation shown on the right is a Base Window.

■ Base window should be in the same size as the HMI screen. Therefore, the resolution of base window and HMI should be identical.

77

Window Operations

6.1.2 Fast Selection Window

Window no. 3 is defined as the Fast Selection Window. This window can coexist with base window. Generally speaking, it is used to place the frequently-used operation buttons on the lower-left side or the lower-right side on the screen:

Fast Selection Button setting dialog: [System Parameter Settings / General]

Or use system registers to control:

[LB-9013] FS window control [hide(ON)/show(OFF)]

[LB-9014] FS button control [hide(ON)/show(OFF)]

[LB-9015] FS window/button control [hide(ON)/show(OFF)]

78

Window Operations

6.1.3 Common Window

Window no. 4 is the default Common Window. Objects on this window will be displayed on other base windows, but it does not include popup windows. Therefore, objects on different windows, whether shared or same, will be placed on common window, for example, the product logo, or a common button.

When operating HMI, select

[Function

Key] / [Change

common window] to change the source of common window.

For example, change the common window from window

4 to window 20.

In manu

[Option]/[Function

Properties] select whether or not to

[Display Common

Window objects on

Base Windows] when editing project.

This can avoid overlapping objects on base window with objects on common window.

79

Window Operations

6.1.4 System Message Window

Windows No. 5,6,7,8 are the default System Message Windows:

[Window No. 5: PLC Response]

When the communication between PLC and HMI is disconnected, this message window will pop up automatically right on the base window opened previously.

■“PLC no response” window can be set not to pop-up using system reserved registers. Please refer to “Chapter 22 System Reserved Words & Bits”.

[Window No. 6: HMI Connection]

When failing to connect HMI with remote

HMI, this message window will pop up automatically.

[Window No. 7: Password Restriction]

If user attempts to control an object without authorization, this window may pop up as a warning or not depending on how this object is set originally.

[Window No.8: Storage Space Insufficient]

When HMI built-in memory, USB disk or SD card run out of storage space, this message window will pop up automatically. (When system detects that memory space left is under 4MB)

80

Window Operations

Users can use system address tags to view the free memory space in HMI, USB disk, or SD card device.

[LW-9072] HMI current free space (K bytes)

[LW-9074] SD current free space (K bytes)

[LW-9076] USB current free space (K bytes)

For checking which device is insufficient in space while the insufficiency occurs, the following system address tags can be used.

[LB-9035] HMI free space insufficiency alarm (when ON)

[LB-9036] SD card free space insufficiency alarm (when ON)

[LB-9037] USB free space insufficiency alarm (when ON)

The text shown on windows no. 5~8 can be adjusted by users to fit what is needed, making the message easier to be understood by the operators.

20B

■A screen can display 16 pop-up windows simultaneously in maximum including System Message Window, Direct Window and Indirect Window.

■A window can only be displayed once simultaneously. That is, users cannot use 2 Direct /

Indirect windows to open the same window on one base window at the same time.

■ Windows 3~9 are for system use only while windows 10~1999 are for users to define.

81

Window Operations

6.2 Create, Set, and Delete a Window

Go to EasyBuilder Pro / [View] / [Window Tree] to check the built windows.

[Object List] displays window number and defined window names. The currently opened and edited window will contain a (*) mark, press the (+) beside the window number to see the objects, object ID, addresses and descriptions this window contains.

[Window Preview] displays windows in small pictures.

6.2.1 Creating and Setting a Window

■ Way 1

On window tree right click on a window number then select [New].

82

Window Operations

[Name] The name will appear on the title bar and also in window tree.

[Window no.]

3 ~ 1999

Set base window size identically to

HMI resolution.

[Popup window]

Base window can also be used as pop-up window.

Use [X] and [Y] to set the coordinates indicate where on the screen will this

[Underlay window]

Refer to the description below. base window pop up. The origin of the coordinates is the upper-left corner of the screen.

[Monopoly]

If the option is checked, when a base window used as a pop-up window appears, users are not allowed to operate other windows before this base window is closed. If a base window is used as a keyboard window,

“Monopoly" is automatically enabled.

[Underlay window]

The often used object can be placed on different windows (but not all windows). Underlay

Window can be seen as an extra Common Window. The objects are placed on the Base

Window where they are built. Up to three Underlay Windows can be defined by users.

Underlay Window is a base window which can be displayed simultaneously with the base window which calls it up. Up to three base windows can be specified as underlay windows for each base window, from [Bottom] to [Top]. The objects (but not the backgrounds) on underlay windows are displayed in this order on base window.

■Objects in the background can’t be edited on the base window they are shown, to edit objects on underlay windows, open the window they are built on using

EasyBuilder Pro editing software.

83

Window Operations

■ Way 2

EasyBuilder Pro / [Window] / [Open Window]

Click [New] to select the window style to be built and click [OK].

There are three ways to call up [Window Settings] dialog:

■ Way 1

Right click on the window number in the window tree and select [Settings].

■ Way 2

EasyBuilder Pro / [Window] / [Open Window] click on the window to be set and then click

[Settings].

■ Way 3

On the window, right click when no object is selected, and click

[Attribute].

84

Window Operations

6

.

2.2 Open, Close and Delete a Window

Open an existing window:

■ Double click on the window number in window tree.

■ In window tree select the window to be opened -> right click -> click [Open].

Close or delete an existing window:

Nearly the same procedure as the above, please note that to delete a window, it has to be closed first.

85

Event Log

Chapter 7 Event Log

7.1 Event Log Management

Alarm Bar / Alarm Display / Event Display

Using these objects to view the process of the whole event from triggering→waiting for processing→until alarm stops. Define event content first.

86

Event Log

Category

EasyBuilder Pro classifies events by dividing them into 0 ~ 255 categories. Select one category to add or view event log. In [ ] it shows how many events are in this category.

History files

Specify the storage device of an event log. However, when simulating the project on PC, the files will be saved under the installation directory.

[Preservation limit]

This setting determines how many days the data to be preserved. For example, the

[Days

of preservation] is set to two days, which means HMI memory will keep the data of yesterday and the day before yesterday. Data that is not built in this period will be deleted automatically to prevent the storage space from running out.

Print

To enable this setting, please finish the settings of printer in

[System Parameter Settings]/

[Model].

7.1.1 Excel Editing

Use Excel to edit [Event Log].

Click on the Excel icon on Event Log setting dialog to open the Excel template for editing.

This template is under installation directory - EventLogExample.xls and includes ready made dropdown lists and validation mechanism.

1.

[System tag] and [User-defined tag] can not be set to true simultaneously, otherwise, the system will view [System tag] to be true, and [User-defined tag] to be false. If setting [User-defined tag] as [Device type], please set

[System Tag] to be false.

2.

[Color] format is R:G:B, each should be an integer form 0 ~ 255.

3.

When setting [User-defined tag] to be true, if the system compares the

87

Event Log

[Device type] with the user-defined tag in system, and no suitable tag is found, the system will set the user-defined tag in event log to be false.

4.

Before importing Library (Label Library / Sound Library), please make sure library names exist in the system, otherwise the system will simply use the file name of the imported Excel file.

88

Event Log

7.2 Create a New Event Log

7.2.1 Alarm (Event) Log General Settings

Click [New], appears the [Alarm (Event) Log] dialog which includes three tabs, go to

[General] tab.

[Category]

Select event category, 0 ~ 255.

[Priority level]

When the number of Event Log equals to the max number available in the system (default

1000), the lower priority events will be deleted and new events will be added in.

[Read address]

System reads data from this address to check if the event matches the trigger condition.

[Notification]

When enabled, system will set the specified register to ON or OFF when the event is triggered.

[Condition]

When [Bit] is selected, Event Log will detect the ON or OFF state of a Bit address.

89

Event Log

When [Word] is selected, Event Log will detect the value of a Word address to check if it equals to, greater than, or less than a specified value.

The setting above indicates:

When [Read address] value is greater than or equals to 29 (= 30 - 1) and less than or equals to 31(= 30 + 1), the event will be triggered. The trigger condition:

29 <= [Read address] value <= 31

After the event is triggered, when [Read address] value is greater than 32(= 30 + 2) or less then 28(= 30 - 2) the system will return to normal condition:

[Read address] value < 28 or [Read address] value > 32

The setting above indicates:

When [Read address] value is less than 29 (= 30 - 1) or greater than 31(= 30 + 1), the event will be triggered. The trigger condition:

[Read address] value < 29 or [Read address] value > 31

After the event is triggered, when [Read address] value is greater than or equals to 28(=

30 - 2) and less than or equals to 32(= 30 + 2) the system will return to normal condition:

28 <= [Read address] value <= 32

90

Event Log

7.2.2 Alarm (Event) Log Message Settings

Alarm (Event) Log [Message] tab:

[Content]

The text content of Event Log shown in [Alarm Bar], [Alarm Display] and [Event Display]

Please see the examples next page.

[Font] / [Color]

The font and color can be set differently for each event. The font and color shown in [Alarm

Bar], [Alarm Display] or [Event Display] come from this setting.

[Write value for Event/Alarm Display object]

When an event in [Event Display] or [Alarm Display] is acknowledged, the value is written to the assigned address.

91

Event Log

[Sound]

When enabled, a designated sound will be played when an event is triggered. Continuous beep can be set which will only stop when the event is acknowledged or recovered.

When using continuous beep for Event Log, a delay period can be set between triggering the alarm and the start of beeping.

An illustration of how the beep is related to the event:

The data of LW address of the triggered event can be included in the content:

Format: %#d (% = initial sign # = address d = end sign)

When an event is triggered, if LW-20 = 13:

Setting:“High Temperature = %20d”→ Display:“High Temperature = 13”

When an event is triggered, data in certain device type can also be shown in the content.

This device type should be the same as that of the [Read address] of Event Log, take MW address as example:

Format: $#d ($ = initial sign # = address d = end sign)

When an event is triggered, if MW-15 = 42:

Setting:“High Temperature = $15d” → Display:“High Temperature = 42”

[Address of Watch]

Click [Syntax] to edit and display the value in watch address when the event is triggered. Up to four watch addresses can be set.

92

Event Log

7.2.3 Event (Alarm) Log e-Mail Settings

Alarm (Event) Log [e-Mail] tab:

[Recipients]

Select the [To], [Cc], and [Bcc] recipients

[Subject]

Enter the subject line of the e-mail.

[Message]

Enter the content of [Opening] and [Ending] of the e-mail.

[Attach]

If checked, the selected window will be sent as an attachment.

93

Event Log

7.3 Event Log Relevant Registers

EasyBuilder Pro provides the following system tags to manage the Event Log:

Address Description

LB-9021

LB-9022

LB-9023

LB-9024

LB-9034 reset current event log (set ON) delete the earliest event log file on HMI memory (set ON) delete all event log files on HMI memory (set ON) refresh event log information on HMI memory (set ON) save event/data sampling to HMI, USB disk, SD card (set ON)

LB-9042

LB-9043 acknowledge all alarm events (set ON) unacknowledged events exist (when ON)

LB-11940 delete the earliest event log file on SD card (set ON)

LB-11941 delete all event log files on SD card (set ON)

LB-11942 refresh event log information on SD card (set ON)

LB-11943 delete the earliest event log file on USB (set ON)

LB-11944 delete all event log files on USB (set ON)

LB-11945 refresh event log information on USB (set ON)

LW-9060

LW-9061

LW-9450

LW-9451

LW-9452

LW-9453

(16bit) : no. of event log files on HMI memory

(32bit) : size of event log files on HMI memory

(16bit) : time tag of event log - second

(16bit) : time tag of event log - minute

(16bit) : time tag of event log - hour

(16bit) : time tag of event log - day

LW-9454

LW-9455

(16bit) : time tag of event log - month

(16bit) : time tag of event log - year

LW-10480 (16bit) : no. of event log files on SD card

LW-10481 (32bit) : size of event log files on SD card

LW-10483 (16bit) : no. of event log files on USB

LW-10484 (32bit) : size of event log files on USB

94

Data Sampling

Chapter 8 Data Sampling

“Data Sampling” defines how the data is sampled, sampling date, address and data length.

EasyBuilder Pro will save the sampled data to user assigned location, such as

HMI, SD, USB.

8.1 Data Sampling Management

“Trend Display” and

“History Data Display” objects can be used to view the content of data sampling records.

Please define how the data is sampled before using Trend Display or History

Data Display to review the content of Data Sampling.

1. Click on the object icon

Data Sampling

2. Click

[New]

to specify relevant settings.

95

Data Sampling

8.2 Create a New Data Sampling

The functions of this object are introduced in the following:

[Sampling mode]

[Time-based] mode samples data in a fixed frequency. The [Sampling time interval] can be defined from every “0.1 second(s)” to every “120 mins”.

[Trigger-based] mode uses the status of specific address to trigger Data Sampling.

[Mode]

Conditions to trigger Data Sampling:

[OFF -> ON] Trigger when the status of assigned address changes from OFF to ON.

[ON -> OFF] Trigger when the status of assigned address changes from ON to OFF.

[OFF <-> ON] Trigger when the status of assigned address is changed.

96

Data Sampling

[Read address]

Select a device type to be the source of Data

Sampling.

[Data Record]

Max. number of data records can be saved by one Data Sampling in one day is 86400. (1 record per second for 24hours) If

[sampling

time interval] is set to “0.1 second” then the max number of data records is 86400 only.

Condition

Trend Display Real Time

[Max. data records]: “10”

& don’t tick [Auto. stop]

Delete earlier sampled data and display the latest 10 records on “Trend Display”.

[Max. data records]: “10”

& tick

[Auto. stop]

Stops after reaching 10 data records.

Trend Display Historical

History Data Display

Data Sampling

Keep on sampling data and display all history data on

“Trend Display”.

Keep on sampling data and display all history data on

“History Data Display.

Keep on sampling new data.

Stops after reaching 10 data records.

Stops after reaching 10 data records.

Stops sampling after reaching 10 data records.

A Data Sampling may include more than one type of records. Data

Sampling in EasyBuilder Pro is able to retrieve different types of records at the same time. Users can define the content of Data Sampling.

As shown, user defines three types of data with data length 4 words in total.

In this way, EasyBuilder Pro retrieves a 4-words-lengthed data each time from the assigned address to be the content in one Data Sampling.

97

Data Sampling

If you have run the simulation and the sampling data is saved in the record, then you want to change the format of sampling date, be sure to delete previous data record in EasyBuilder Pro installation directory to avoid the system misinterpret the old data record.

[Clear address]

If the status of the assigned address is set

ON, the data obtained by “Trend Display”

[real-time] mode will be cleared and the number of data sampling returns zero. This won’t affect the sampled data that is already saved in file.

[Hold address]

If the status of the assigned address is set

ON, sampling will be paused until the status of assigned address returns to OFF.

[History files]

[Save to HMI]

Save Data Sampling to

HMI only when its size reaches “4kb”, or, use

[LB-9034] to force storing data.

[Save to SD card / USB disk]

Save Data Sampling to the specified external device.

[Folder name]

Specify Data Sampling file name which

must be in ASCII characters.

The folder name will be written as:

[Storage Location] \ [Folder Name] \ yyyymmdd.dtl

98

Data Sampling

This determines how many days the data to be preserved. “2” days means the data of yesterday and the day before yesterday will be kept. Data not built in this period will be deleted to prevent the storage space from running out. EX: if today were July 1st, data of

June 30th and June 29th will be preserved and data of June 28th be deleted.

When running simulation on PC, all data sampling will be saved to the

datalog folder which is under the directory of [Storage location].

99

Data Sampling

8.3 System Registers Relevant to Data Sampling

EasyBuilder Pro provides the following system registers for data sampling management:

Address Description

LB-9025 delete the earliest data sampling file on HMI memory (set ON)

LB-9026 delete all data sampling files on HMI memory (set ON)

LB-9027 refresh data sampling information on HMI memory (set ON)

LB-9034 save event/data sampling to HMI, USB disk, SD card (set ON)

LB-11949 delete the earliest data sampling file on SD card (set ON)

LB-11950 delete all data sampling files on SD card (set ON)

LB-11951 refresh data sampling information on SD card (set ON)

LB-11952 delete the earliest data sampling file on USB (set ON)

LB-11953 delete all data sampling files on USB (set ON)

LB-11954 refresh data sampling information on USB (set ON)

LW-9063

(16bit) : no. of data sampling files on HMI memory

LW-9064

(32bit) : size of data sampling files on HMI memory

LW-10489 (16bit) : no. of data sampling files on SD card

LW-10490 (32bit) : size of data sampling files on SD card

LW-10492 (16bit) : no. of data sampling files on USB

LW-10493 (32bit) : size of data sampling files on USB

100

Object General Properties

Chapter 9 Object General Properties

The contents of [general] properties settings of an object include:

1. Selecting the connected PLC.

2. Setting reading and writing address

3. Using shape library and picture library

4. Setting text content

5. Adjusting profile size

9.1 Selecting PLC

It is required to designate which PLC to operate while using some objects as shown below.

[PLC name] represents the controlled PLC. In this example there are 2 PLC: “Local HMI” and “Mitsubishi FX0s/FX0n/FX1s/FX1n/FX2.” These listed available PLC devices are sourced from [Device List] in [System Parameters Settings].

9.1.1 Setting the Reading and Writing Address

The picture above shows a reading address or writing address contains:

101

Object General Properties

[PLC name]

This is for selecting device type. Different PLC are with different selections of

[Device

type].

[Address]

Set the reading and writing address.

[System tag]

Address tag includes “system tag” and “user-defined tag.” Click [Setting…] beside [PLC

name] and tick [system tag]. This allows users to use the preserved addresses by system for particular purpose.

These address tags are divided into bit or word (LB or LW).

After selecting [System tag] not only will the [Device type] displays the content of the chosen tag, [Address] will also display the register chosen as shown below.

The illustration below shows a part of system tags. For further information, please refer

“Chapter 16 Address Tag Library” and “Chapter 22 System Reserved Words and Bits”.

102

Object General Properties

[Index register]

Deciding to use Index register or not, please refer to “Chapter 11 Index Register” for more information.

Selecting Data Type

EasyBuilder Pro supports data types that are listed below. Selecting correct data type is necessary especially while using address tag.

103

Object General Properties

9.2 Using Shape Library and Picture Library

[Shape Library] and [Picture Library] are used for enhancing the visual effect of an object.

For setting these, please go to [Shape] tab in the dialog for adding new object to set up

[Shape Library] and [Picture Library].

104

Object General Properties

9.2.1 Settings of Shape Library

[Shape Library…]

Users can tick [Use shape] to enable this setting and select the shape from the library.

[Inner]

Tick [Inner] to enable this setting and select a color for inner part of the shape. Click drop down button to open the [Color] dialogue to choose a color from the list or [customize] their own color and click [Add to Custom Colors] for system to remember this color.

[Frame]

Tick [Frame] to enable this setting and select a [color] for the frame of the shape. The way of setting is same as above.

[Interior Pattern]

Click to select the style of the interior pattern of the shape. The color of this pattern can also be set.

[Pattern Style]

Click [Pattern Style] button to open the dialog.

105

Object General Properties

[Duplicate these attributes to every state]

Duplicate all attributes of the current state to other states.

How to set [Shape Library…]

Click [Shape Library…] button, the following dialog appears. The currently selected shape is marked by a red frame.

106

Object General Properties

The illustration above provides information of one of the Shapes in the Shape Library as follows:

2: Green The number and the name of the shape in the library.

States: 3

Frame

The number of the states of the shape. In this case, it shows the

Shape possesses three states.

Indicates that the Shape is set with “frame” only.

The illustration below shows that the Shape is set with “inner” and “frame.”

Note: About all the settings in [Shape Library], please refer to the illustrations in “Chapter

14 Shape Library and Picture Library” for details.

Click [OK] and preview the design of the shape after the setting is completed.

107

Object General Properties

9.2.2 Settings of Picture Library

[Picture Library]

Users can click [Use picture] to enable selecting a picture from the library.

How to set [Picture Library…]

Click [Picture Library…] button and [Picture library] dialog appears. The currently selected picture is marked by a red frame.

108

Object General Properties

The illustration above provides information of one of the Pictures in the Picture Library as follows:

Picture name

0 : PB Red The number and name of the Picture

Total states 2

Image size 30054 bytes

The number of the states of the Picture

The size of the Picture

Image format

BMP

(100x100)

The format and resolution of the Picture; BMP means bitmap picture and its format can also be JPG, PNG, DPD, or GIF. Picture Length: 100 pixels and height: 100 pixels in this case.

Note: About all the settings in

[Picture Library], please refer to the illustrations in “Chapter

14 Shape Library and Picture Library” for details.

Click

[OK] and preview the design of the picture after the setting is completed.

109

Object General Properties

9.3 Setting Text Content

Go to [Label] tab while adding new object to set the text content as shown below.

[Use label]

Check [Use label] and click [Label Library] button to add and edit the text. EasyBuilder Pro supports Windows true-font.

110

Object General Properties

[Use label library]

Check [Use label library] to choose a label tag that exists in Label Library as shown below.

[Label Library…]

Note: About all the settings in [Label Library], please refer to the illustrations in “Chapter

15 Label Library and Multi-Language Usage” for details.

[Font]

Select font style from font list. EasyBuilder Pro supports Windows true-font as shown below.

[Color]

Select the text color.

[Size]

Select the text size. The text sizes supported by EasyBuilder Pro are listed below.

111

Object General Properties

[Align]

Select how users would like to align the text in multiple lines

.

The text aligned [Left].

The text aligned [Center].

The text aligned [Right].

112

Object General Properties

[Blink]

To decide how will the text blink:

Choose [None] to disable this feature or set blinking interval as [1 second] or [0.5

seconds].

[Italic]

Use Italic font.

[Underline]

Use Underline font.

[Movement] setting

[Direction]

Set the direction of the marquee effect.

[Continuous]

Whether this selection is tick or not influences how the marquee effect is displayed:

If not checking [Continuous], the next text appears only when the previous text disappears completely. See the picture below.

If checking [Continuous], the text will be displayed continuously.

113

Object General Properties

[Speed]

Adjust the speed of the text movement.

[Content]

Set the content of the text. If using [Label Library], the content will be sourced from Label

Library.

[Tracking]

When [Tracking] is selected, moving the text of one state will also move the text of other states.

[Duplicate this label to other states]

This function is used to duplicate the current text content to the other states.

114

Object General Properties

9.4 Adjusting Profile Size

When an object is created, double click it and go to the [Profile] tab to adjust the position and size of the object.

a. Position

Set if the position and size of the object is [Pinned]. When it is checked, the position and size of the object cannot be changed. X and Y mean the [X] and [Y] coordinate of the left-top corner of the object.

b. Size

Adjust the [width] and [height] of the object.

115

Object General Properties

9.5 Variables of Station Number

EasyBuilder Pro allows users to set variables of station number in PLC address. As shown below, “var2” is one of 16 station number variables.

The syntax of variable of station number: varN#address

The range of N is integer from 0~15; address means PLC address.

16 variables are availble:var0 ~ var15. These variables of station number read values from address LW-10000~LW-10015. The list below shows variables and its corresponding system reserved address LW: var0 LW-10000 var1 LW-10001 var2 LW-10002 var3 LW-10003 var4 LW-10004 var5 LW-10005 var6 LW-10006 var7 LW-10007 var8 LW-10008 var9 LW-10009 var10 LW-10010 var11 LW-10011 var12 LW-10012

116

Object General Properties var13 LW-10013 var14 LW-10014 var15 LW-10015

For example, “var0” reads value from LW-10000, when value in LW-10000 is “32”, var0#234 = 32#234 (the station number is 32); similarly, “var13” reads value from

LW-10013, when value in LW10013 is” 5”, var13#234 = 5#234.

117

Object General Properties

9.6 Broadcast Station Number

HMI provides two ways for users to enable using broadcast command. First is to set it directly in [system parameter settings] [Device] tab:

Second way is to use system tag to enable or disable broadcast station number or to change it.

Corresponding system tags are listed as below:

LB-9065 disable/enable COM 1 broadcast station no.

LB-9066 disable/enable COM 2 broadcast station no.

LB-9067 disable/enable COM 3 broadcast station no.

LW-9565 COM 1 broadcast station no.

LW-9566 COM 2 broadcast station no.

LW-9567 COM 3 broadcast station no.

118

User Password and Object Security

Chapter 10 User Password and Object Security

Two modes of setting user passwords in EasyBuilder Pro

1. General Mode

2. Enhanced Security Mode

Object security includes:

1. User password and corresponding operable object classes.

2. Security settings of each object.

10.1 User Password and Operable Object Classes

[System Parameter Settings] / [Security]: The Security Mechanism in EasyBuilder Pro includes two modes: General Mode and Enhanced Security Mode

10.1.1 General Mode

Password should be digits from 0 to 9 and up to 12 sets of user password are available.

There are seven security levels, classified from A to F and includes none.

Once password is entered, the objects that the user can operate are classified. For example below, “User 1” can only operate objects with classes “A, C,” and “none”.

119

User Password and Object Security

120

User Password and Object Security

10.1.2 Enhanced Security Mode

11 users can be set in EasyBuilder Pro, plus a default Administrator. User passwords can be in alphanumeric format and each user can operate objects classified into 13 classes:

A

to L and none.

Once password is entered, the objects that the user can operate are classified.

In addition, Enhanced Security Mode provides a control address for users to manage the accounts directly on HMI.

121

User Password and Object Security

10.2 Enhanced Security Mode and Control Address

The Control Address is sourced from Local HMI LW register, and 20 continuous registers are used for User Account Management.

10.2.1 Control Address Usage

Example: When control address is set to LW-n.

LW-n (1 word) -> [Command], controls the commands such as: Login, Logout,

Add/Setting/Delete Accounts, etc.)

LW-n+1 (1 word) -> [Result], Display the result of executing commands.

LW-n+2 (1 word) -> [Index], the index of accounts (usually used with Option List Object).

LW-n+3 (1 word) -> [Privilege], value (Level A = bit0, Level B = bit1…etc.)

LW-n+4 (8 words) -> [Name], account name (alphanumeric, plus “-“or “_”, case sensitive.

LW-n+12 (8 words) -> [Password], account password (alphanumeric, plus “-“or “_”, case sensitive.

10.2.2 Introduction of commands

Input different values in [Command] -> LW-n, the corresponding functions: a.

Log in using account name -> [value 1], with [Name] and [Password]. b. Log in using index -> [value 2], with [Index] and [Password]. c. Log out -> [value 3]. d. Change the password of current account -> [value 4], with [Name] and [Password].

[Name] must be paired with the original password, and fill in the new password in

[Password]. e. Add an account -> [value 5], with [Name], [Password] and [Privilege]. f. Add a temporary account -> [value 6], with [Name], [Password], [Privilege], and

[Index]. [Index] is for specifying an effective time period (minutes). 0 represents permanently effective. g. Delete current account -> [value 7], with [Name]. h. Delete current account -> [value 8], with [Index]. i. Setting the privilege of current account -> [value 9], with [Name] and [Privilege]. j. Setting the privilege of current account -> [value 10], with [Index] and [Privilege]. k. Setting the password of current account -> [value 11], with [Name] and [Password].

122

User Password and Object Security l. Setting the password of current account -> [value 12], with [Index] and [Password]. m. Read the privilege of current account -> [value 13], with [Name]. If succeeded, write to

[Privilege]. n. Read the privilege of current account -> [value 14], with [Index], if succeeded, write to

[Privilege].

Add a temporary account: The difference from general account is that the temporary account won’t be stored in Flash, therefore it will be invalid after power cut. This account will be deleted by system when passing the effective time period.

Delete current account: The currently logged in account can’t be deleted.

Offline/Online Simulation: Simulate using the set account in program. The modifications during simulation won’t be reserved for next simulation.

admin: Default administrator account, can’t be deleted, opens to all classes of privilege, and its privilege level can’t be modified.

System Register LW-10754: Display current user name.

10.2.3 Introduction of Results Output

When commands are executed, the system will automatically send the result codes to control address LW-n+1. The listed result codes below are hexadecimal values.

Result Codes: Result Messages:

(0x001):

Command successfully executed.

(0x002):

Command error.

(0x004):

Account already exists (when adding new account).

(0x008):

Account does not exist.

(0x010):

Password error.

(0x020):

Current command can’t be executed.

(0x040):

Invalid account name.

(0x080):

Invalid account password.

(0x100):

The imported data is invalid.

(0x200):

Not within the effective time limit. (when using USB Security Key to log in)

■ Users can predefine the result codes on Event Log Object, and then display the result messages on Event Display Object.

123

User Password and Object Security

10.3 Enhanced Security Mode with Function Key

10.3.1 Import User Account

Apart form [System Parameter Settings] / [Security] tab, users can also set user accounts by launching Administrator Tools in EasyBuilder Pro installation directory and tick

[User Accounts]. A maximum of 127 accounts can be added as shown below:

About Administrator Tools, please refer to the relevant chapters in this manual.

The added accounts can be stored in USB and SD card, and create a Function Key for importing user accounts as shown below:

124

User Password and Object Security

Upon completion of the settings, insert the external device to HMI, and use Function Key to import accounts. If [Overwrite] is selected, the existing accounts in the system will be deleted before importing and log out after importing. If tick [Delete file after importing user accounts], the system will delete the account data saved in the external device after importing. The effective time limit for importing data can only be specified in Administrator

Tools.

125

User Password and Object Security

10.3.2 USB Security Key Usage

Instead of entering account and password manually for login, a key can be used to do so. In

EasyBuilder Pro installation directory, launch Administrator Tools, check

[USB Security

Key], set the relevant login information, the USB Security Key can be used to directly login as shown:

Please note that the user accounts set for USB Security Key must already exist on HMI.

About Administrator Tools, please refer to the relevant chapters in this manual.

The set USB Security Key can be stored in USB and SD card, and create a Function Key for using USB Security Key to log in as shown below:

126

User Password and Object Security

Upon completion of the settings, insert the external device to HMI, and use Function Key to login using USB Security Key. The effective time limit for login with the key can only be specified in Administrator Tools, the system will logout automatically when passing the time limit.

127

User Password and Object Security

10.4 Enhanced Security Mode with Option List Object

Enhanced Security Mode use control address LW-n=2 as account index. With Option List

Object, account name and privileges can be displayed. If set control address to LW-0, the monitor address will be LW-2. Users can select whether or not to display the account privileges and secret users on Option List. Secret Users means in

[System Parameter

Settings] / [Security] / [Enhanced Security Mode], this user account name is set to be hidden so that other users won’t be able to see the relevant data via Option List.

Wish to know more about Enhanced Security Mode?

Please confirm your Internet connection before downloading the demo project.

128

User Password and Object Security

10.5 Object Security Settings

[Safety control]

To prevent miss-operation.

[Min. press time (sec)]

Continuously press the object longer than the time set here to activate the object.

[Display confirmation request] After pressing the object, a dialog appears for operation confirmation. If response to this dialog comes later than the set

[Max.

waiting time (sec)], this dialog disappears automatically and the operation will be canceled.

[Interlock]

When ticked, whether this object can be operated depends on the state of the specified Bit address.

As shown, if LB-0 is ON, the object can be operated.

[Hide when disabled] When the specified Bit is OFF, hide the object.

[Grayed label when disabled] When the specified Bit is OFF, the label of the object turns gray.

[User restriction]

Only when user’s permitted class matches the object’s can it be operated.

[Object class]

“none“ means any user can operate this object. Only account “admin” can operate

“Administrator” object class.

[Disable protection permanently after initial activation] Once the permitted class of the user matches that of the object, the system will stop checking the security class permanently; even a different user can operate freely.

[Display warning message if access denied] When the classes of user and object do not match, a warning dialog (Window 7) appears. The content of the message can be modified.

[Make invisible while protected] When the classes of user and object do not match, hide the object.

129

User Password and Object Security

10.6 Setting Example

1. Create a project, go to [System Parameter Settings] / [Security] to enable 3 users:

User 1 =

Operable class: A

User 2 =

Operable class: A, B

User 3 =

Operable class: A, B, C

2. Design Window 10:

[Numeric Input] object

[LW-9219] user no. (1~12)

Length = 1word

(16-bit Unsigned)

[LW-9220] password

Length = 2 words

(32-bit Unsigned)

[Numeric Display] object

[LW-9222] current user operable classes

(16-bit Binary)

[Set Bit] object

[LB-9050] user logout

Three [Set Bit] objects, each set to different classes but all select [Made invisible while protected].

After designing and setting the objects, please save, compile the project and do off-line simulation. Below shows how it works when simulating.

130

User Password and Object Security

3. When no password is entered yet, it displays “00000000000000”, meaning user operable object class ”none”. [SB_0] ~ [SB_2] objects are classified “A” ~ “C” and selected

[Made

invisible while protected], therefore they are hidden at this moment.

4. Input User 1 password “111”.

Since User 1 is only allowed to operate class A objects, [SB_0] object will appear for operating. [LW-9222] bit

0 turns "1”, meaning user operable class: A.

5. Input User 3 password “333”.

Since User 3 is allowed to operate class A, B, C objects, [LW-9222] bit 0

~bit 2 turns "1”, meaning user operable class: A ~ C.

6. Click [LB9050] user logout, the system will return to initial state, current user can only operate class ”none” objects.

131

User Password and Object Security

Password input If the password is incorrect, [LB-9060] will be set to ON; if the password is correct, [LB-9060] will return OFF.

User 1~12 password can be read from system registers [LW-9500] ~ [LW- 9522], 24 words in total.

Change password when HMI is in operation When [LB-9061] turns from OFF to ON, data in [LW-9500] ~ [LW-9522] can be used to update user password, and use the new password in the future. The user operable object classes will not change due to the change of password.

132

Index Register

Chapter 11 Index Register

11.1 Introduction

EasyBuilder Pro provides 32 Index Registers for users to change addresses flexibly. With Index Register, users can update object’s read/write address without changing its content while HMI is running the project.

Address

Address

There are 32 Index Registers listed below:

16-bit Index Register:

Index 0 [LW-9200] (16-bit)~

Index 15 [LW-9215] (16-bit)

Max. range: 65536 words

32-bit Index Register:

Index 16 [LW-9230] (32-bit)~

Index 31 [LW-9260] (32-bit)

Max. range: 4294967296 words

Index 0 ~ Index 31: Descriptions of Index Registers.

[LW-9200] ~ [LW-9260]: Index Registers word addresses.

While using [Index register], the address of the [Device type] will be decided by the value of “constant in set address + value in chosen Index Register”.

Index Register works in all [Device lists] built in [System

Parameter Settings], no matter addresses in bit or word format.

133

Index Register

11.2 Examples of Index Register

The following examples show how to use Index Registers.

[Index register] not checked:

Read address is set to [LW-10] and won’t change while running project.

[Index register] is checked and index register [INDEX 0] is selected: read address is set to

[LW-0 + INDEX 0]

INDEX 0: Index Register 0 or data of address

[LW-9200].

If data of address [LW-9200] is

“5”, read address is set to

[LW(0+5)] = [LW-5].

Here’s a demo project shown as an example:

134

Index Register

Index Function of Word

Index 0 is “0”

= data in address

[LW-9200] = “0”

Read [LW-0 + Index 0]

= Read [LW-0] content

[LW-10] is set to ”3” [LW-20] is set to ”6”

Index 0 [LW-9200] is set to “10”

Read [LW-0 + Index 0]

= Read [LW-10] = ”3”

Index Function of Bit

In the same way, Index Register can be used for Bit address.

1 Word = 16 Bit, adding 1 Word in value of index register = adding 16 Bits

Index 6 [LW-9206] is set to “1”

The switch [LB-0 + Index 6] reads LB-16 address = ON

Index 6 is set to “2” The switch [LB-0 + Index 6] reads LB-32 address = OFF

135

Index Register

Conclusion: Index Register is used to change addresses. Through changing the data in Index Register, we can make an object to read and write different addresses without changing its own address of the device. Therefore we can transmit or exchange data among different addresses.

Please confirm your internet connection before downloading the demo project.

136

Keyboard Design and Usage

Chapter 12 Keyboard Design and Usage

“Numeric Input” and “ASCII Input” objects need to use keyboard as input tool.

Both numeric keyboard and ASCII keyboard are created with “Function

Key” object. The types of keyboards are:

Fixed keyboard on the window

Popup keyboard with title bar

Popup keyboard

UNICODE keyboard

137

Popup keyboard without title bar

Keyboard Design and Usage

12.1 Steps to Design a Pop-up Keyboard

Step 1 Create and open a window for a keyboard to be added. For example, set to

“WINDOW 200”.

Step 2 Adjust the height and width of

“WINDOW 200” and create a variety of ”Function Key” objects in

[ASCII/UNICODE mode].

For example:

[FK_11] is used as the [Esc] key.

[FK_14] is used as the

[Enter] key.

The rest are mostly used to input number or text.

For example, [FK_0] is used for inputting number

“1”.

Step 3 Select a suitable picture for each ”Function Key” object. [GP_0] is a picture object which is placed at the bottom layer as the background.

Step 4 Select

[System Parameter Settings]

/ [General] / [Keyboard] /

[Add] [Window 200]. Up to 32 keyboard windows cab be added.

138

Keyboard Design and Usage

Step 5 After the keyboard window is added, when creating “Numerical

Input“ and “ASCII Input“ objects, “200 Keyboard“ can be found in

[Data Entry] / [Keyboard] /

[Window no.].

The [Popup position] is used to decide the display position of the keyboard on screen. The system divides the screen into

9 areas.

Step 6 Select “200.Keyboard“.

When users press “Numerical

Input“ or “ASCII Input“ objects,

WINDOW 200 will pop up on HMI screen. Users can press keys on keyboard to input data.

139

Keyboard Design and Usage

12.2 Steps to Design a Keyboard with Direct Window

Step 1 Create a ”Direct Window” and set a read address to activate it.

In [General]/[Attribute] select [No title bar] and correct [Window No.].

Step 2

Set the [Profile] of “Direct

Window” to the same size as the created keyboard window.

Step 3 Create a

”Numeric Input” object, and

don’t tick [Use a popup

keypad].

Step 4

Create a ”Set Bit” object,

[LB-0], [Set ON] and overlay it on the ”Numeric Input” object.

Step 5 Add ”Set Bit” objects on [Enter] and [ESC] function keys respectively.

[LB-0], [Set OFF], in this way when users press either [Enter] or [ESC] will close the keyboard.

140

Keyboard Design and Usage

12.3 Steps to Design a Fixed Keyboard on Screen

Users can also place a fixed keyboard on the window instead of popup keyboard or direct window.

The keyboard can’t be moved or canceled this way.

Step 1

Create a ”Numeric Input” object, in [Data Entry] / [Keyboard] don’t tick

[Use a popup keypad].

Step 2

Use ”Function Keys” to design the keyboard and place them on screen.

Step 3

Press ”Numeric Input”

object, users can input value with function keys directly.

141

Keyboard Design and Usage

12.4 Steps to Design a UNICODE Keyboard

Place an ”ASCII Input” object on screen, tick [Use UNICODE].

Create

[γ] [δ] as shown, and an [Enter] key, a simple UNICODE keyboard is built.

”Function Keys”

[α] [β]

Users can “Group“ the self defined keyboard and “Save to

Group Library” for future use.

142

Objects

Chapter 13 Objects

This chapter is to illustrate the ways of using and setting all kinds of objects. For those settings general for all the objects, such as index register, label, shape, and so on, please refer to “Chapter 9 Object’s General Properties”.

13.1 Bit Lamp

Overview

Bit Lamp object displays the ON and OFF state of a bit address. If the bit state is OFF, the State 0 shape will be displayed. If the bit state is ON, the State 1 shape will be displayed.

Configuration

Click the [Bit Lamp] icon in the toolbar and the [Bit Lamp Object’s

Properties] dialog box will appear, fill in the content of and press [OK], a new bit lamp object will be created.

143

Objects

Description

A reference name that’s assigned by user for the object. The system does not make use of this reference name since it is for user’s document only.

Read address

Click [Setting…] to select the [PLC name], [Address], [Device type], [System tag],

[Index register] of the bit device that controls the bit lamp object. Users can also set address in [General] tab while adding a new object.

144

Objects

[Invert signal]

Display shape with inverse state; for example, the present state is “OFF”, but it displays the shape of “ON” state.

Blinking

Set blinking attribute of bit lamp.

[Blinking mode] a. None

No blinking.

b. Alternating image on state 0

Alternatively display the shape of state 0 and state 1 when the bit value is OFF (state 0).

c. Alternating image on state 1

Alternatively display the shape of state 0 and state 1 when the bit value is ON (state 1).

d. Blinking on state 0

Display the shape of state 0 in blinking when the bit value is OFF (state 0).

e. Blinking on state 1

Display the shape of state 1 in blinking when the bit value is ON (state 1).

145

Objects

13.2 Word Lamp

Overview

A Word Lamp object displays the corresponding shape according to the value in the designated word address. (up to maximum of 256 states)

Configuration

Click the [Word Lamp] icon in the toolbar and the[Word Lamp Object’s

Properties]dialog box will appear, fill in each items and press [OK] button, a new word lamp object will be created.

146

Objects

[Mode] / [Offset]

Word lamp object offers the following three modes for selection:

a. Value

Calculate result of word value to subtract [Offset] and display its corresponding shape.

147

Objects

In the above setting, if the value of [LW200] is “5”, the shape of state “2” is displayed.

See the picture below.

b.

LSB

Transfer the read address value to binary, the lowest 8 bits other than value 0 decides the state. Please refer to the following table.

Binary value Displayed state Read address value

0

1

0000

0001

All bits are 0, display the shape of state 0

The lowest bit other than 0 is bit 0, display the shape of state 1

2 0010

3

4

0011

0100

The lowest bit other than 0 is bit 1, display the shape of state 2

The lowest bit other than 0 is bit 0, display the shape of state 1

The lowest bit other than 0 is bit 2, display the shape of state 3

7

8

0111

1000

The lowest bit other than 0 is bit 0, display the shape of state 1

The lowest bit other than 0 is bit 3, display the shape of state 4

148

Objects

c. Change state by time

The states of the object have nothing to do with the word value. The system displays different shape of states according to time frequency.

Read address

Click [Setting…] to Select the [PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the word device that controls the word lamp object. Users can also set address in [General] tab while adding a new object.

Attribute

[No. of states]

The number states one object possesses. State 0 is also counted as one state..

Suppose the number of the states is 8, the valid states will be 0, 1~7. In this case if the word value is 8 or higher, the system will display the shape of last state.

Restrictions

In label dialog, Language 1 is able to change attribute settings, and for Language 2~8, only font size can be changed and other settings follows language 1.

149

Objects

150

Objects

13.3 Set Bit

Overview

The [Set Bit] object provides two operation modes: the “manual operation” mode defines a touch area, users can activate the touch area to set the state of the bit device to be ON or OFF. When users select the “automatic operation” mode, the operation will be automatically activated in pre-configured conditions, the touch area has no action in any circumstance.

Configuration

Click the [Set Bit] icon in the toolbar and the [New Set Bit Object] dialog box will appear, fill in each items and press [OK] button, a new Set Bit object will be created.

151

Objects

Write address

Click [Setting…] to select the [PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the bit device that system set value to. Users can also set address in [General] tab while adding a new object.

152

Objects

[Write after button is released]

If this function is selected, the operation is activated after button is touched and released, otherwise, if not selected, operation will be activated once the button is touched. If the “Momentary” switch is selected as the operation mode, the [Write after button is released] function will be ignored.

Attribute

[Set Style] Please refer to the following description for different types of operation mode.

Set style

Set ON

Set OFF

Description

When the operation is activated, the bit device will be set to

ON.

When the operation is activated, the bit device will be set to

OFF.

Toggle

Momentary

Periodical toggle

When the operation is activated, the bit device will be set from

ON to OFF or from OFF to ON.

When touch and hold the area, the bit device will be set to

ON, and the bit device will be set to OFF once the finger removes from area.

The state of the bit device will be switched between ON and

OFF periodically. Operation’s time interval can be selected in the combo box showed in the picture below:

錯誤

! 物件無法用編輯功能變數代碼來建立。

153

Objects

Set style

Set ON when window opens

Description

When the window containing the Set Bit object is opened, the bit device will be automatically set to ON.

Set OFF when window opens

Set ON when window closes

Set OFF when window closes

When the window containing the Set Bit object is opened, the bit device will be automatically set to OFF.

When the window containing the Set Bit object is closed, the bit device will be automatically set to ON.

When the window containing the Set Bit object is closed, the bit device will be automatically set to OFF.

When the backlight is turned on, the bit device is automatically set ON.

Set ON when backlight on

Set OFF when backlight on

Set ON when backlight off

Set OFF when backlight off

When the backlight is turned on, the bit device is automatically set OFF.

When the backlight is turned off, the bit device is automatically set ON.

When the backlight is turned off, the bit device is automatically set OFF.

Macro

Users can use [set bit] object to activate macro commands. Macro commands have to be built before configure this function. Please refer to Chapter 18 – Macro Reference for more information.

Set style

When [Set style] is selected as [Toggle], there are three different modes to trigger macro command, i.e. OFF->ON, ON->OFF, or ON<->OFF.

154

Objects

13.4 Set Word

Overview

The [Set Word] object provides two operation modes: the “manual operation” mode and the “automatic operation” mode. The “manual operation” mode defines a touch area, and users can activate the area to set the value of the word device. When users select the “automatic operation” mode, the operation will be automatically activated in pre-configured conditions, the touch area has no action in any circumstance.

Configuration

Click the [Set Word] icon in the toolbar and the [New Set Word Object] dialog box will appear, fill in each items and press [OK] button, a new Set

Word object will be created. See the pictures below.

155

Objects

Write address

Click [Setting…] to Select the [PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the word device that system set value to. Users can also set address in [General] tab while adding a new object.

156

Objects

[Write after button is released]

If this function is selected, the operation is activated after button is touched and released, otherwise, if not selected, operation will be activated once the button is touched.

Notification

When this function is selected, in the “manual operation” mode, the state of the designated bit device will be set to [ON] or [OFF] after/before the operation is completed.

[Before writing] / [After writing]

Set the state of the designated bit device before or after writing to word device.

Click [Setting…] to Select the [PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the Notification bit that system set value to.

Users can also set the address in the Notification area.

Attribute

[Set style] Set the operation mode. The available modes for selection are listed as follows:

157

Objects

Write constant value

Set constant function. When the operation is activated, the [Set value] will be written into the word device. The constant’s format (16-bit BCD, 32-bit BCD, …) depends on the format of [Write address].

Increment value (JOG+)

Increase value function. When the operation is activated, the [Inc. value] will be added to the value of the word device, and the result won’t exceed the value [Upper limit].

Decrement Value (JOG-)

Decrease value function. When the operation is activated, the [Dec. value] will be subtracted from the value of the word device, and the result won’t go less than the value [Bottom limit].

Press and hold increment (JOG++)

Press and hold increment function. When the touch and hold gets longer than the time set in [JOG delay], the value of the word device will be added by the value set in [Inc. value] at the speed set in [JOG speed], and the result won’t exceed the value in [Upper limit].

Press and hold increment (JOG--)

Press and hold decrement function. When the touch and hold gets longer than the time set in [JOG delay], the value of the word device will be subtracted by the value set in

[Dec. value] at the speed set in [JOG speed], and the result won’t go less than the value in [Bottom limit].

158

Objects

Periodical JOG++

Periodically increment function. A set word object can use the interval set in

[Time

interval] and the value set in [Inc. value] to automatically increase the value of the word device, and the result won’t exceed the value in [Upper limit].

Automatic JOG++

Periodically increment function. A set word object can use the interval set in

[Time

interval] and the value set in [Inc. value] to automatically increase the value of the word device, and the result won’t exceed the value in

[Upper limit].

Automatic JOG--

Periodically decrement function. A set word object can use the interval set in

[Time

interval] and the value set in [Dec. value] to automatically decrease the value of the word device, and the result won’t go less than the value in [Bottom limit].

159

Objects

Periodical bounce

Periodically bouncing function. A Set word object will add the value set in [Inc. value] to the value of the word device with the regulated interval set in [Time interval] until the result value reaches the value in [Upper limit], and then subtract the value set in [Inc.

value] from the value of the word device with the regulated interval set until the result value reaches the value in the [Bottom limit]. For example, the value in the word device will change periodically from 0~10 then from 10~0.

Periodical step up

Stepping up function. A Set word object will add the value set in [Inc. value] to the value of the word device with the regulated interval set in [Time interval] until the result value reaches the value in the [High limit], and the value of the word device will return to the value of the [Low limit] and then repeat the action to keep the value in an active state. In the example shown below, the value of the word device will change periodically in order of 0, 1, 2,…, 9, 10, 0, 1, 2, ……

Periodical step down

Stepping down function. A Set word object will subtract the value set in [Dec. value] from the value of the word device with the regulated interval set in [Time interval] until the result value reaches the value of the [Low limit], and the value of the word device will return to the value of the [High limit] and then repeat the action to keep the value in an active state. In the example shown below, the value of the word device will change periodically in order of 10, 9, 8,…, 1, 0, 10, 9, 8, ……

160

Objects

Set when window opens

When the window containing the object is opened, the value of [Set value] will be automatically written into the word device.

Set when window closes

When the window containing the object is closed, the value of [Set value] will be automatically written into the word device.

Set when backlight on

When the backlight is turned from off to on, the value of [Set value] will be automatically written into the word device.

Set when backlight off

When the backlight is turned from on to off, the value of [Set value] will be automatically written into the word device.

161

Objects

Cyclic JOG+

Increase value function. When the operation is activated, the [Inc. value] will be added to the value of the word device until it exceeds the

[Upper

limit]. After that, it will return to [Bottom limit] and re-increase the value.

Cyclic JOG-

Decrease value function. When the operation is activated, the value of the word device will be decreased by

[Dec. value] until it goes less than the

[Bottom limit]. After that, it will return to [Upper limit] and re-decrease the value.

Cyclic JOG++

Periodically cyclic increment function.

When the time of holding this button is longer than [JOG delay], it will increase the value of the word address automatically according to the setting of [JOG speed] until it exceeds to the [Upper limit]. After that, it will return to [Bottom limit] and re-increase the value.

Cyclic JOG- -

Periodically cyclic decrement function.

When the time of holding this button is longer than [JOG delay], it will decrease the value of the word address automatically according to the setting of [JOG speed] until it goes less than the [Bottom limit]. After that, it will return to [Upper limit] and re-decrease the value.

162

Objects

[Dynamic limits]

Set the [Bottom limit] and [Upper limit] of the input data to be derived from the designated register.

Content

Write Address

Dynamic Address

Bottom limit

Upper limit

16-bit

LW-0

LW-100

LW-100

LW-101

32-bit

LW-0

LW-100

LW-100

LW-102

163

Objects

13.5 Function Key

Overview

Function key object is used to change base window, pop-up window and close window.

It can also be used to design the keypad buttons.

Configuration

Click the [Function Key] icon in the toolbar and the [Function Key Object’s

Properties] dialog box will appear, fill in each items and press the [OK] button, a new function key object will be created.

164

Objects

Function Key object provides the following operation modes:

[Active after button is released]

If this function is selected, the operation is activated when touched and released. If the function is not selected, the operation is activated once being touched.

[Change full-screen window]

Change base window.

165

Objects

NOTE: Do not use this function to pop up the window which has been opened by direct

/ indirect window object.

[Change common window]

Change common window; refer to the “windows” chapter for related information.

[Display popup window]

Pop up window. The pop up window must be on the top of the base window. There is a

[Close this popup window when parent window is closed] option with this function, see the picture below; when the function is selected, the pop up window will be closed when executing change base window. Otherwise, users have to set a “Close” button on the pop-up window to close the window.

[Window no.]

This is used to select the window no. when performing [change base window], [change common window], and [pop up the window]

[Return to previous window]

This is used to return to the previous base window. Fox example, when changing window 10 to window 20, users can use this function to return to window 10. This function is only available for base window change.

[Close window] Close the pop-up windows on the top of the base window.

Items in ASCII/UNICODE mode

[ASCII/UNICODE mode] is used as elements to configure a keypad, the keypad is used where numbers or texts are needed to be input to the [numeric input] object or

[ ASCII input] object. Refer to the “Designing and Using Keypad” chapter for detailed information.

[Enter]

Same as the keyboard’s “enter” function.

[Backspace]

Same as the keyboard’s “backspace” function.

[Clear]

To clear the temperate input alphanumeric strings stored in the buffer.

166

Objects

[Esc]

Same as the [Close window] function, it is used to close the keyboard window.

[ASCII/UNICODE]

To set the characters that are input in the numeric input object and the ASCII input object. Digital characters such as 0, 1, 2… or ASCII characters like a, b, c,…etc. are available selection.

[Execute Macro]

Macro commands are executed with this selection. Macro commands have to be built before users choose this function. Please refer to related chapter on how to edit

Macros.

[Window title bar]

A [function Key] which is defined as Window Title Bar can move the popup window position on the screen. Firstly users can select the popup window that has the title bar, and then click another position to move the window.

Note: this function is only available on indirect/direct window when [no title bar] is selected.

[Screen hard copy]

Hardcopy current display screen to the printer connected with HMI. Before using this function, please choose printer model in [System Parameter] / [Model] / [printer]. If printer does not support color print, user can select grayscale to have a better printout effect. Black and white is for improving text printing quality.

167

Objects

Import user data/ Use [USB Security Key]

Users can import contact information by external device, please refer to

Chapter 36 – Administrator Tools for more information.

[Settings…]

Function mode: Import e-mail settings and contacts.

[Data Position]

Available for SD card or USB disk.

[Account import mode]

HMI internal memory would only store account information imported by external device if Overwrite is chosen. However, if choose Append,

HMI will append more account information while the original accounts still exist.

[Delete file after importing user accounts]

Delete account information in external device after importing successfully. It can make sure account information would not be leaked out.

Notification

When the function is selected, HMI will set the state of the designated bit device to [ON] or [OFF] after the action is completed.

Click [Setting…] to Select the [PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the Notification bit that system set value to.

Users can also set the address in the Notification area.

168

Objects

Design Non-ASCII character keyboard

Below we illustrate the method to input non-ascii character such as Traditional Chinese,

Simplified Chinese, Japanese, Greece and so on.

Step1: Setting non-ascii fonts

Go to System parameter/Font and add non-ascii fonts in the “Fonts for non-ascii strings” list. For example, use “AR MinchoL JIS” for Japanese, ” AR MingtiM GB” for

Simplified Chinese, ” AR MingtiM KSC” for Korean, ” Arial” for Greek, please refer illustration below.

Step2: Design non-ascii input keypad

Create “window11” for non-ascii input keypad, keypad design is shown below.

Those objects on the window are function keys with input code in accord with the label.

For example, to input ” 简 ” function key, create a function key object/General/[ASCII]/[UNICODE] mode, type in ” 简 ” in the column as below illustration.

169

Objects

Go to Function key/Label and then select “Use label”, type ”简” in the content and in the

Attribute/Font select ” AR MingtiM GB”, it must be the same as setp1’s setting, as illustrated below.

The label of non-ascii function key must use the same Font. For example, in Simplified

Chinese keypad, the fonts all use ” AR MingtiM GB”.

After complete the keypad configuration, add window11 into System Parameters /

General / keyboard as illustration below.

170

Objects

171

Objects

13.6 Toggle Switch

Overview

Toggle Switch object is a combination of bit lamp object and set bit object. The object can be used not only to display the state of a bit device but also to define a touch area, when activated, the state of the bit device will be set to “ON” or “OFF”.

Configuration

Click the “Toggle Switch” icon on the toolbar and the “New Toggle Switch

Object” dialog box will appear, fill in each item and press OK button, a new toggle switch object will be created.

172

Objects

Read address

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the bit device that control the display of toggle switch state. Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

[Invert signal]

Display shape with inverse state; for example, the present state is “OFF”, but it displays the shape of “ON” state.

Write address

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the bit device that system set value to. The write address can be the same as or different from the read address.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

173

Objects

[Write when button is released]

If this function is selected, the operation is activated at touch up. If the function is not selected, the operation is activated at touch down.

Attribute

This is used to select the operation mode. The available operation modes for selection include “Set ON”, “Set OFF”, ”Toggle”, and ”Momentary”. Refer to the illustrations in the

“Set Bit Object” section of this chapter for related information.

Macro

Users can execute macro command by trigging toggle switch This function is the same as that of set bit object. Please refer to the manual of Chapter 18 – Macro Reference of how to create a macro.

174

Objects

13.7 Multi-State Switch

Overview

Multi-State Switch object is a combination of word lamp object and set word object. The object can be used not only to display the state of a word device but also to define a touch area, when activated, the value of the word device can be set.

Configuration

Click the “Multi-State Switch” icon on the toolbar and the “New Multi-State

Switch Object” dialog box will appear, fill in each items, and click OK button, a new Multi-State Switch object will be created.

175

Objects

[Mode] / [Offset]

There are “Value” and “LSB” display mode. Refer to the “Word Lamp Object” section of this chapter for related information.

Read address

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the word device that controls the display of multi-state switch.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

176

Objects

Write address

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the word device that system set value to. The write address can be the same as or different from the read address.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

[Write when button is released]

If this function is selected, the operation is activated at touch up. If the function is not selected, the operation is activated at touch down.

Attribute

Select the object’s operation mode.

[Switch style]

There are “JOG+” and “JOG-” for selection. When the read address is the same as the write address, the minimum value of the word value is [Offset] (state 0), and the maximum value is “[no. of state] -1 + [Offset]”. See the picture below.

a. “JOG+”

When the Multi-State Switch object is activated, the value of the write address will be added by 1. In the “Value” display mode, if the resulting value is equal to or larger than the value of [No. of States] + [Offset] and “Enable” in [Cyclic] is selected, the value of the write address will return to [Offset] and show the state 0; otherwise the value of the write address will maintain as ([No. of states] – 1) + [Offset] and shows the state ([No. of states no.] – 1).

NOTE: Like the word lamp object, the state shown by Multi-State Switch object is the value of the word device subtracts [Offset].

b. “JOG-”

When the Multi-State Switch object is activated, the value of the write address will be subtracted by 1. In the “Value” display mode, if the resulting value is smaller than the

177

Objects value of [Offset] and “Enable” in [Cyclic] is selected, the value of the register will change to ([No. of states] – 1) + [Offset] and shows the state ([No. of states] – 1); otherwise the value of the word device will remain in [Offset] and shows the state 0.

[User-defined mapping]

Users can modify the value of state, illegal input and error notification.

Remain current state: if input an illegal value, multi-state switch will remain current state.

Jump to error state: if input an illegal value, multi-state switch will jump to error state.

178

13.8 Slider

Objects

Overview

The slide object can be used to create a slot area that changes the word's value by dragging the pointer.

Configuration

Click the “Slide object” icon on the toolbar and the dialog box will appear, fill in each items and click OK button, a new slide object will be created.

Write address

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the word device that system set value to.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

Notification

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the Notification bit that system set value to.

Users can also set the address in the Notification area.

179

Objects

When this function is selected, the state of the designated bit device can be set before/after the operation is completed. There are [ON] and [OFF] selection to set the state.

[Before writing] / [After writing]

Set the state of the designated register before or after write to the word device.

Watch address

When sliding, the current value can be displayed in real-time fashion.

180

Objects

Attribute

[Direction]

The bar on the slide direction, i.e. left, right, up and down.

[Resolution]

To specify the scale value of the slider, if N is the specified minimum scale value, when

N=10, the numerical display shows only multiples of 10.

N=5, the numerical display shows only multiples of 5.

N=1, the numerical display shows only multiples of 1.

181

Objects

[Low limit & High limit]

a. Constant

The low limit and high limit of the word device is set as constant value. i.e. [Input low] and [Input high].

b. Address

The low / high limit of the word device is controlled by a designated address.

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of designated address or users can also set address in Attribute.

Control address Low Limit

16-bit format Address+0

32-bit format Address+0

High Limit

Address+1

Address+2

[Coarse increment:]

If this option is selected, the word value will increase/decrease one [increment] value for every touch activation. If not, the word value will be set the value in accord with the touch activated point.

Slider button type

There are four slider button types for selection. You also can adjust the width of moving piece.

Color

This is used to select slide object frame, background and slot’s color.

182

Objects

13.9 Numeric Input and Numeric Display

Overview

Both of the Numeric Input object and the Numeric Display object can be used to display the value of the word devices. The difference is the numeric input object can be used to input data from the keypad, the input value is written to the designated word devices.

Configuration

Click the “Numeric Input” or “Numeric Display” icon on the toolbar and the “New Numeric Input Object” or “New Numeric Display

Object” dialog box will appear, fill in each item, click OK button and a new “Numeric Input Object” or “Numeric Display Object” will be created.

The difference between the “New Numeric Display Object” and “New Numeric Input

Object” dialog boxes is that the latter has the settings for ”Notification” and keypad input while the former doesn’t have. The picture below shows the [General] tab in “New

Numeric Input Object”.

183

Objects

Read/Write use different address

Numeric Input object is provided with [Read/Write use different addresses] selection, users can set different addresses for Read and for Write data.

Read address

Select the [PLC name], [Device type], [Address] of the word device that system display its value and write new data to it.

Write address

Select the [PLC name], [Device type], [Address] of the word device that system writes to.

184

Objects

Notification

When this function is selected, the state of the designated bit device will be set to [ON] or [OFF] after/before the value of the register is changed successfully.

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the Notification bit that system set value to.

Users can also set the address in the Notification area.

[Before writing] / [After writing]

Set the state of the designated bit device before or after update the word device.

Notification on valid input

When inputting invalid values, it can now automatically set the status of designated address.

185

Objects

[Mode]

[Touch]

The object enters input state when a user touches it.

[Bit control]

The object enters input state when turning ON the designated bit register, and ends input state when turning OFF. Notice that if there is another input object already in input state, turning ON the designated bit register won’t make this input object enters input state until the previous one ends inputting data.

HMI system will disable the popup keypad when Mode is set to Bit Control.

Users need to use an external keypad for typing.

186

Objects

Allow input bit address

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the bit register that controls the object enters and ends input state.

Users can also set address in Data Entry tab.

187

Objects

Input order

By setting Input Order and Input Order Group, users can continuously input data between multiple input objects. The system will automatically transfer input state to the next input object after users complete inputting data, i.e. press ENT.

Enable

Select [Enable] and set Input Order to enable this feature. Furthermore, users can also select [Group] to set Input Order Group. a. The range of Input Order: 1 ~ 511.

 b. The range of Input Order Group: 1 ~ 15. c. The Input Order Group of an input object with [Group] unselected is 0.

Criterion of searching the next input object

a. The system only searches it among the input objects with the same Input Order

Group. b. The system picks the input object with smaller Input Order to enter input state before another one with bigger Input Order. c. If two input objects have the same Input Order Group and Input Order, the system picks the one at bottom layer to enter input state first.

When selecting [Touch] as Mode

Refer to the following illustration, when users complete inputting data on “AE_2”, the system transfers input state to “AE_0”. The reason why not transferring to “NE_0” is because the Input Order Group of “NE_0” is different from that of “AE2”.

188

Objects

[Stop sequential input function after input]

If the objects in one group are not set with this function, the input order would be:

[Order 1] -> [Order 2] -> [Order 3] -> [Order 4] -> [Order 1] -> [Order 2] ->….

And the loop goes on until the ESC button is pressed.

If one of the objects in the group is set to [Stop sequential input function after input]

(Take Order 4 Object as shown below), the input order would be:

[Order 1] -> [Order 2] -> [Order 3] -> [Order 4] -> fin

Upon the completion of input of Order 4 Object (press ENTER), the input will stop at this point.

When selecting [Bit control] as Mode

a. Users have to specify an Input Order for the object. b. No need to set Input Order Group because all the input objects with [Bit control] as Mode have the same Input Order Group that is different from any input object with [Touch] as Mode.

Keyboard

Select [Use a popup keypad]

Specify the pop-up position for the keyboard window. The system displays the

 keyboard window on inputting data and closes it on end.

Unselect [Use a popup keypad]

The system does not automatically display keyboard window. Users have to complete the input process via following methods: a. Design a custom keypad and place it in the same window with the input object.

 b. Use an external keyboard.

Hide title bar

Keypads without title bar can be selected for Numeric Input / ASCII Input object.

Restart the keypad if input value is out of range

For Input Value object, re-input can be automatically requested when input error occurs.

189

Objects

When selecting [Bit control] as Mode, the system will automatically unselect [Use a popup keypad] in [Keyboard].

The picture below shows the [Numeric Format] tab, included in both of the numeric input object and the numeric display object, which is to set the data display format.

190

Objects

Display

[Data format]

To select the data format of the word device designated by the “Read address”. The selection list is shown as follows:

Format

16-bit BCD

32-bit BCD

16-bit Hex

32-bit Hex

16-bit Binary

32-bit Binary

16-bit Unsigned

16-bit Signed

32-bit Unsigned

32-bit Signed

32-bit Float

[Mask]

When the data is displayed, “*” will be used to replace all digitals and the color warning function will be cancelled.

Number of digits

[Left of decimal Pt.]

The number of digits before the decimal point.

[Right of decimal Pt.]

The number of digits after the decimal point.

Scaling option

[Do conversion]

The data displayed on the screen is the result of processing the raw data from the word address designated by the “Read address.” When the function is selected, it is required to set [Engineering low], [Engineering high], and [Input low] and [Input high] in the

“Limitation”. Supposed that “A” represents the raw data and “B” represents the result data, the converting formula is as follows:

B = [Engineering low] + (A - [Input low]) × ratio

191

Objects where, the ratio = ([Engineering high] - [Engineering low]) / ([Input high] - [Input low])

See the example in the picture below, the raw data is 15, after being converted by the above formula as 10 + (15 – 0) × (50 – 10) / (20 - 0) = 40, and the result “40” will be displayed on the numeric input object.

[Dynamic scales]

Set the [Bottom limit] and [Upper limit] of the input data to be derived from the designated register.

Content 16-bit 32-bit

Write Address

Dynamic Address

Bottom limit

Upper limit

LW-0

LW-100

LW-100

LW-101

LW-0

LW-100

LW-100

LW-102

Limits

To set the source of the range for the input data and to set the warning color effect.

[Direct]

The low limit and high limit of the input data can be set in [Input low] and [Input high] respectively. If the input data is out of the defined range, the input value will be ignored.

[Dynamic limits]

192

Objects

Set the low limit and high limit of the input data to be derived from the designated register. The data length of the designated register is the same as the input object itself.

In the above example, the low limit and high limit are derived from [LW100] and the following explains the usage of the low limit and high limit from designated address.

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] for designated register.

Users can also set address in Numeric Format tab.

Designated address Input Low Limit Input High Limit

16-bit format LW100 LW101 (Address+1)

32-bit format LW100 LW102 (Address+2)

[Low limit]

When the value of the PLC’s register is smaller than [Low limit], the value is displayed with pre-defined color.

[High limit]

When the value of the PLC’s register is larger than [High limit], the value is displayed with pre-defined color.

[Blink]

When the value of the PLC’s register is smaller than [Low limit] or larger than [High limit], the object will display data with Blinking. The picture below shows the [Font] tab, available in both of the numeric input object and the numeric display object to set font, font size, color, and aligning mode.

193

Objects

Attribute

[Color]

When the data is within high and low limit, it will be displayed with this color.

[Align]

There are three aligning modes: “Left”, “Leading zero”, and “Right”. The picture below shows the style of each mode.

[Size] Set font size.

194

Objects

13.10 ASCII Input and ASCII Display

Overview

Both of the ASCII Input object and the ASCII Display object can display the value of the designated word devices in ASCII format. The ASCII input object can also accept the data input from the keypad and change the value of the word devices.

Configuration

Click the “ASCII Input” or “ASCII Display” icon on the toolbar and the “New ASCII Input Object” or “New ASCII Display Object” dialog box will appear, fill in each item, press OK button, a new “ASCII

Input Object” or “ASCII Display Object” will be created.

The difference between the “New ASCII Display Object” and “New ASCII Input Object” dialog boxes is that the latter has the settings for “Notification” and keypad input while the former doesn’t have. The picture below shows the [General] tab of the “New ASCII

Input Object”.

195

Objects

[Mask]

When the data is displayed, “*” will be used to replace all texts.

[Use UNICODE]

Click “Use UNICODE” to display data in UNICODE format. Otherwise the system displays the character in ASCII format. This feature can be used with function key

[UNICODE]. Not every Unicode has corresponding font stored in the system. The font of UNICODE is only available for those Unicode character that registered function key.

[Reverse high/low byte]

In normal condition, the ASCII code is displayed in “low byte”, “high byte” order. The reverse selection makes the system display ASCII characters in “high byte”, “low byte” order.

196

Objects

Read address

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the word device that system display its value and write new data to it.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

[No. of words]

To set the length of ASCII data in the unit of words. Each ASCII character take one byte, each word contains two ASCII characters.

In the example shown below, the object will display 3 * 2 = 6 characters.

Notification

When this function is selected, the state of the designated bit device will be set to [ON] or [OFF] after/before the value of the register is changed successfully.

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the Notification bit that system set value to.

Users can also set the address in the Notification area.

[Before writing] / [After writing]

Set the state of the designated bit device before or after update the word device.

About the Data Entry tab, please refer to “Numeric Input and Numeric Display” section.

197

Objects

Attribute

The picture shows the [Font] tab of the ASCII Input object and the ASCII display object.

Users can set the font, font size, font color, and aligning mode.

[Align]

There are two aligning modes: “Left” and “Right”. The picture below shows how each mode performs.

198

[Size]

Set font size.

Objects

199

Objects

13.11 Indirect Window

Overview

“Indirect Window” object is to define a popup window location (position / size) and a word device. When the content of the word device is written a valid window number, the window will be popup in the predefined location. The popup window will be closed when the value of the word device is reset (0). The system will only take action when the content of word device is changed. (0 → valid window number, nonzero → 0, A → B valid window number).

Configuration

Click the “Indirect Window” icon on the toolbar and the “New Indirect

Window Object” dialog box will appear, fill in each items, click OK button, a new “Indirect Window Object” will be created.

200

Objects

Read address

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the word device that control the window popup.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

Attribute

[Style]

To set the display style of the popup window. There are two styles, “No title bar” and

“With title bar”.

a. “No title bar”

The popup window does not have title bar, and its position is fix as predefined in configuration.

201

Objects

b. “With title bar”

The popup window contains title bar, and its position can be dragged at online operation.

Example to use indirect window

Here is a simple example to illustrate indirect window object. The pictures show how to configure an indirect window and use the word device [LW100] to change the popup window.

202

Objects

Use the set word object SW_0 to set the value of [LW100] as 35, and the location of indirect window will display window 35.

Use the set word object SW_1 to set the value of [LW100] as 36, and the location of indirect window will display window 36.

.

No matter window 35 or 36 is displayed on the indirect window location, press SW_2 to set the value of [LW100] to 0 will close the popup window. The other way to close the popup window from indirect window object is to configure a function key with [close window]. Once you press the function key, the popup window will be closed.

203

Objects

NOTE: Only 16 windows maximum can be displayed simultaneously at run time, and do not use this function to open the window when the same window has been opened by function key or direct window.

204

Objects

13.12 Direct Window

Overview

“Direct window” object is to define a popup window location (position / size), a bit device and a predefined valid window number. When the content of the bit device is set

ON/OFF, the window will be popup in the predefined location. The popup window will be closed when the content of the bit device is reset. The system will only take action when the content of bit device is changed (OFF → ON, ON → OFF).

The difference between the “Direct window” and the “Indirect window” is that the direct window object sets the popup window in configuration. When system is in operation, users can use the state of the designated register to control popup or close the window.

Configuration

Click the “Direct Window” icon on the toolbar and the “New Direct

Window Object” dialog box will appear, fill in each items, press OK button, and a new “Direct Window Object” will be created.

205

Objects

Read address

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the bit device that control the window popup.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

Attribute

[Style]

Refer to the “Indirect Window Object” for related information.

[Window no.]

Set the popup window number.

Example to use direct window

Here is an example to explain how to use the direct window object. The picture below shows the settings of the direct window object. In the example, use [LB10] to call up the window 35.

206

Objects

When the state of LB10 is set to ON, the window 35 will be popup; when the state of

LB10 is OFF, the window 35 will be closed. See the picture below.

207

Objects

NOTE: Only 16 windows maximum can be displayed simultaneously at run time, and do not use this function to open the window when the same window has been opened by function key or direct window.

208

Objects

13.13 Moving Shape

Overview

Moving Shape object is used to define the object’s state and moving distance. The

Moving Shape object is used to place an object in a window at a location specified by the PLC. The state and the absolute location of the shape in the window depend on the current values of three continuous PLC registers. Typically, the first register controls the state of the object, the second register controls the horizontal position (X), and the third register controls the vertical position (Y).

Configuration

Click the “Moving Shape” icon on the toolbar and “New Moving Shape

Object” dialog box will appear, fill in each items, press OK button, and a new

“Moving Shape Object” will be created.

209

Objects

Read address

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the word devices that control the display of object’s state and moving distance.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

The table below shows the address to control object’s state and moving distance in each different data format.

210

Objects

Data format

Address to control object

state

16-bit format Address

32-bit format Address

Address to control Moving

Distance on the

X-axis

Address + 1

Address + 2

Address to control Moving distance on the

Y-axis

Address + 2

Address + 4

For example, if the object’s read address is [LW100] and the data format is “16-bit

Unsigned”, [LW100] is to control the object’s state, [LW101] is to control the object’s moving distance on the X-axis, and [LW102] is to control the object’s moving distance on the Y-axis.

The picture below shows that the object’s read address is [LW100] and initial position is

(100, 50). Supposed you want the object moved to the position (160, 180) and be displayed in the shape of State 2, the value of [LW100] must be set to 2, [LW101] =

160–100 = 60, [LW102] = 180–50 = 130.

211

Objects

Attribute

To select the object’s movement mode and range.

a. X axis only

The object is only allowed to move along the X-axis. The moving range is defined by

[Min. X] and [Max. X].

Data format

Address to control object

state

16-bit format Address

32-bit format Address

Address to control Moving

Distance on the

X-axis

Address + 1

Address + 2

b. Y axis only

The object is only allowed to move along the Y-axis. The moving range is defined by

[Min. Y] and [Max. Y].

Data format

Address to control object

state

16-bit format Address

32-bit format Address

Address to control Moving

Distance on the

Y-axis

Address + 1

Address + 2

c. X & Y axis

The object is allowed to move along the X-axis and Y-axis. The moving range in XY direction is defined by [Min. X], [Max. X] and [Min. Y], [Max. Y] respectively.

212

Objects

Data format

Address to control object

state

16-bit format Address

32-bit format Address

Address to control Moving

Distance on the

X-axis

Address + 1

Address + 2

Address to control Moving distance on the

Y-axis

Address + 2

Address + 4

d. X axis w/ scaling

The object is for X axis movement with scale. Supposed that the value of the designated register is DATA, the system uses the following formula to calculate the moving distance on the X-axis.

X axis move distance =

(DATA – [Input low]) * ([Scaling high – Scaling low]) / ([Input high] – [input low])

For example, the object is only allowed to move within 0~600, but the range of the register’s value is 300~1000, set [Input low] to 300 and [Input high] to 1000, and set

[Scaling low] to 0 and [Scaling high] to 600, and the object will move within the range.

Data format

Address to control object

state

Address to control Moving

Distance on the

X-axis

16-bit format Address

32-bit format Address

Address + 1

Address + 2

213

Objects

e. Y axis w/ scaling

The object is for Y axis movement with scale, and the formula to calculate the moving distance on the Y-axis is the same as the one in “X axis w/ scaling.”

Data format

Address to control object

state

Address to control Moving

Distance on the

Y-axis

16-bit format Address

32-bit format Address

Address + 1

Address + 2

f. X axis w/ reverse scaling

This function is the same as “X axis w/ scaling”, but the moving direction is in reverse.

g. Y axis w/ reverse scaling

This function is the same as “Y axis w/ scaling”, but the moving direction is in reverse.

Display ratio

The size of shape in different states can be set individually as shown in the picture below.

Limit address

The object’s moving range can be set not only by [Min. X], [Max. X] and [Min. Y] [Max.

Y], but also by the designated registers. Supposed that the object’s moving range is set by the value of the designated register “Address”, then the address of [Min. X], [Max. X] and [Min. Y] [Max. Y] are listed in the following table.

Data format [Min. X] address

16-bit format Address

32-bit format Address

[Max. X] address

[Min. Y] address

[Max. Y] address

Address + 1 Address + 2 Address + 3

Address + 2 Address + 4 Address + 6

214

Objects

13.14 Animation

Overview

The Animation object is used to place an object on the screen at a specified location determined by a predefined path and data in the PLC. The state and the absolute location of the shape on the screen depend on current reading value of two continuous

PLC registers. Typically, the first register controls the state of the object and the second register controls the position along the predefined path. As the PLC position register changes value, the shape or picture jumps to the next position along the path.

Configuration

Click the “Animation” icon on the toolbar, move the mouse to each moving position and click the left button to define all moving positions one by one.

When settings of all moving positions are completed, click the right button of the mouse, a new animation object will be created.

To change the object’s attributes, you can double click the left button of the mouse on the object, and the “Animation Object’s Properties” dialog box, as shown in the picture below, will appear.

215

Objects

Attribute

[Total no. of states]

To set the number of the states for this object.

a. Controlled by register

When select “Controlled by register”, the designated register controls the object’s state and position.

Read address

If select “Controlled by register” option, it is necessary to set the read address.

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] for the read address.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

216

Objects

In the table below, it describes the address that control shape’s state and position in different data format.

Data Format Address to control object’s state

16-bit format

32-bit format

Address

Address

Address to control object’s position

Address + 1

Address + 2

For example, if the designated register is [LW100] and the data format is ”16-bit

Unsigned”, then [LW100] represents object’s state, [LW101] represents position. In the picture below, [LW100] = 2, [LW101] = 3, so the object’s state is 2 and position is 3.

b. Based upon time interval

If “Based upon time interval” is chosen, the object automatically changes status and display location. “Time interval attributes” is to set the time interval for states and positions.

[Position speed]

Position changes speed, the unit is 0.1 second. Supposed that [Speed] is set to 10, the object will change its position every 1 second.

[Backward cycle]

If the object has four positions: position 0, position 1, position 2, and position 3, and

[Backward cycle] is not selected. In this case when the object moves to the last position

(position 3), next position will be back to the initial position 0, and repeat the action over again. The moving path is shown as follows:

217

Objects position 0 → position 1 → position 2 → position 3 → position 0 → position 1 → position

2…

If [Backward cycle] is selected, when the object moves to the last position (position 3), it will move backwards to the initial position 0, and repeat the moving mode over again.

The moving path is shown as follows. position 0 → position 1 → position 2 → position 3 → position 2 → position 1 → position

0…

[Image state change]

State change mode. There are “Position dependant” and “Time-based” options. When

“Position dependant” is selected, it means that following the change of position, the state will change too. When “Time-based” is selected, it means that the position will change based on “Position speed” and shape state will change based on “Image update time”

218

Objects

The following dialog shows size setup of animation object. Call up the animation object dialog box by double clicking.

Shape rectangle size

To set the size of the shape.

Trajectory

To set the position of each point on the moving path.

219

Objects

13.15 Bar Graph

Overview

Bar graph object displays PLC register data as a bar graph in proportion to its value.

Configuration

Click the “Bar Graph” icon on the toolbar, the “Bar Graph” dialog box will be shown up, fill in each items of settings, click OK button, a new “Bar Graph

Object” will be created.

The following picture shows the “General” tab of the bar graph object.

220

Objects

Read address

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of the word devices that controls the bar graph display.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

221

Objects

The following picture shows the “Outline” tab of the bar graph object.

Attribute

[Type]

There are “Normal” and “Offset” for selection. When select “Offset”, there must be a original value for reference. Please refer the illustration below.

[Direction]

To select the bar graph direction, and there are ”Up”, “Down”, “Right”, and “Left” for selection.

222

Objects

[Zero][Span]

The filled bar percentage can be calculated with the following formula:

The filled bar percentage = (Register value – Zero) / [Span] – [Zero]) * 100%

When select “Offset”, if (Register value – Zero) > 0, the bar will fill up from origin setting; if (Register value – Zero) < 0, the bar will fill up but down side from origin setting.

For example,

Origin =5, Span=10, Zero=0 and use different value in read address, it will display as illustration below.

When read address value is 4,

When read address value is 8,

[Bar width ratio(%)]

To display the ratio between bar and object width. Below illustration displays two ratio,

50% and 100%.

223

Objects

Bar color/style

To set the bar’s Frame, Background color, Bar style, and Bar color. See the picture below.

Target Indicator

When the register value meets the following condition, the color of filled area will change to the “Target color”

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of dynamic address.

Users can also set address in Outline tab while adding a dynamic address.

[Target Value] - [Tolerance]<=Register value<=[Target Value] + [Tolerance]

See the picture below, in here [Target Value] = 5, [Tolerance] = 1, if the register value is equal to or larger than 5-1=4 and equal to or less than 5+1=6, the filled area’s color of the bar will change to the “Target color”

Alarm Indicator

When register’s value is larger than [High limit], the color of filled area will change to

[High color], when register’s value is smaller than [Low limit], the color of filled area will change to [Low color].

Target/Alarm Dynamic Address

When select [Enable], the [Low limit] and [High limit] of “Alarm indicator” and the [Target

Value] of “Target indicator” all come from designated register. See the picture below.

224

Objects

The following table shows the read address of low limit, high limit, and target. The

“Address” means the device address, for example, if the device address is [LW20] and data format is 16-bit,

The Alarm Low limit is LW 20 / The Alarm High limit is LW21

The Target indicator is LW22 / The Zero is LW23 / The Span is LW24

Data

Format

16-bit format

32-bit format

Alarm

Low

Alarm

High limit limit

Address Address +

1

Address Address +

2

Target indicator

Zero

Address

+ 2

Address

+ 4

Address

+ 3

Address

+ 6

Span

Address

+ 4

Address

+ 8

225

Objects

13.16 Meter Display

Overview

The meter display object can display the value of word device with meter.

Configuration

Click the “Meter Display” icon on the toolbar and the “Meter Display Object’s

Properties” dialog box will appear, fill in each items, press OK button, and a new “Meter Display Object” will be created.

The picture below shows the “General” tab in the “Meter Display Object’s Properties” dialog box.

226

Objects

Read address

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register of the word devices that controls the display of meter.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

In the above dialog box, users can set the meter display object’s outline. Refer to the picture below for the names of each part of the meter.

227

Objects

Degree

Set the object’s “start degree” and “end degree”, the angle range is 0-360 degrees. The following pictures show several results of different settings.

[Start degree] = 290, [End degree] = 70

[Start degree] = 120, [End degree] = 240

[Start degree] = 40, [End degree] = 140

228

Objects

[Start degree] = 225, [End degree] = 315

Background

Set the object’s background color and profile color.

[Full circle]

When the “Full circle” is selected, the object will display the whole circle, otherwise the object will display the defined degree range. See the picture below.

[Transparent]

When the “Transparent” is selected, the object will not display the background and profile color. See the picture below.

Tick marks

To set the tick mark’s number and color.

Pointer To set Pointer’s style, length, width, and color.

Pin point To set pin point’s style, radius, and color

229

Objects

The following pictures show the “Limit” tab and the sign of low and high limit set in the

“Limit” tab.

Value

To set object’s display range. Meter display object will use the value of [Zero] and [Span] and the value of register to calculate the pointer’s indication position. For example, supposed that [Zero] = 0, [Span] = 100, when the value of register is 30 and [Start degree] = 0, [End degree] = 360, then the degree indicated by pointer is:

{(30 – [Zero])/([Span] – [Zero])} * ([[End degree] - [Start degree]] =

{(30 – 0) / (100 - 0)} * (360 – 0) = 108

230

Objects

Pointer will indicate the position of 108 degrees. See the picture below.

Range limit

To set the value of low and high limit, the display color, width of the sign of low, high limit.

Below illustration use above setting to display the range mark.

[user-defined radius]

231

Objects

[Dynamic Limits] / uncheck

When “Dynamic limits” is not selected, the low limit and high limit are fixed value, which directly comes from the settings. See the example below, the low limit is 30 and high limit is 60.

[Dynamic Limits] / checked

When Dynamic limits is selected, the low limit and high limit are decided by the register.

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] for Dynamic limits.

Users can also set address in Limits tab while adding a new object.

Please refer to the following dialog.

There following table shows the read address of low limit and high limit. The “Address” means the register’s address. If the register is [LW100], the “Address” is 100.

Data format

16-bit format

32-bit format

Low limit’s read address

Address

Address

High limit’s read address

Address + 1

Address + 2

Scale label

To select the attribute of scale label on meter display.

232

Objects

13.17 Trend Display

Overview

Trend display object can use the curve to represent the data recorded by data sampling object. The sampling operation is conducted by data sampling objects. The trend display object display the result of sampling. The following picture shows an example of trend display object.

Configuration

Click the “Trend Display” icon on the toolbar and the “Trend Display Object’s

Properties” dialog box will appear, fill in each items, press the OK button and a new “Trend Display Object” will be created.

The following picture shows the “General” tab in the “Trend Display Object’s Properties” dialog box.

233

Objects

[Data Sampling Object index]

To select data sampling object as the source of data. Refer to the “data sampling” section for related information.

[Trend mode]

To select the mode of data source. There are “Real-time” and “History” for selection.

a. Real-time

In this mode, it can display the sampling data from the beginning of the HMI operation to the present time. If previous data are required, you must select the “History” mode to read the data from historical record.

You can use the “Hold control” object to pause the update of trend display, but it is only pause the update of the trend display, and it will not stop the operation of data sampling

234

Objects object. The picture below shows the “Hold control” setting page. Set the state of the designated register to ON, it will pause the updating of the trend display.

b. History

In this mode, the data come from the historical record of the designated data sampling object in [Data sampling object index]. Data sampling object will use the sampling data which was sorted in according to dates. The system use “History control” to select the historical records that are created by the same data sampling object. The picture below shows the “History control” setting page.

The system sorts the historical records of sampling data by date; the latest file is record

0 (In normal condition it is sampling data today), the second latest file is record 1, and so on.

If the value of designated register in “History control” is n, the trend display object will display data record n.

Here is an example to explain usage of “History control.” In the above picture, the designated register is [LW200], if the sampling data available in the files are pressure_20061120.dtl, pressure_20061123.dtl, pressure_20061127.dtl, and pressure_20061203.dtl and it is 2006/12/3 today. Based on the value of [LW200], the sampling data files selected by the trend display object is shown as follows:

1

2

Value of [LW200] The files of the sampling data from the historical record

0 pressure_20061203.dtl pressure_20061127.dtl pressure_20061123.dtl

235

Objects

3 pressure_20061120.dtl

[Distance between data samples] / Pixel

Select [Pixel], the [Distance] can be used to set the distance between two sampling points. See the picture below.

[X axis time range] / Time

Select [Time], the [Distance] is used to set the X-axis in unit of time elapsed. See the picture below.

236

Objects

Otherwise, select Time for X axis time range and go to Trend/Grid for enable “Time scale” function. Please refer “Time scale” on the following.

Watch line

Using the “Watch line” function, when user touches the trend display object, it will display a “watch line”, and export the sampling data at the position of watch line to the designated word device. You may register a numeric display object to display the result.

Please refer to the following picture

“Watch line” function also can export sampling data of multiple channels, The address registered in “watch line” is the start address and those sampling data will be exported to the word devices starting from “start address” The data format of each channel may be different, the corresponding address of each channel is arranged from the first to the last in sequence.

For example:

[LW300] Ch. 0 : 16-bit Unsigned (1 word)

[LW301] Ch. 1 : 32-bit Unsigned (2 words)

237

Objects

[LW303] Ch. 2 : 32-bit Unsigned (2 words)

[LW305] Ch. 3 : 16-bit Signed (1 word)

The picture below shows the attribute of “trend display”.

[Frame] The color of frame.

[Background] The color of background.

[Show scroll controls]

To enable / disable scroll control on the bottom of trend display object.

Grid

238

Objects

Set the distance and the color of grid.

[Horiz.]

Set the number of horizontal line.

[Verti. interval] a. Pixel

When select [pixel] to set the display interval (see note on the above graph and

“General” tab), the [Verti. interval] is used to select how many sampling point will be included between two vertical grid line. See the picture below.

b. Time

When select [Time] to set the time range of display data, the [Verti. interval] is used to select the time range between two vertical grid lines. See the picture below.

According to these settings, the system will calculate the number of vertical grid line automatically.

Time Scale

To enable the time scale on the bottom of trend display

[Format]

To select time scale as HH:MM or HH:MM:SS

[Font]

To select font style

[Size]

To select font size. Recommend use font size: 8.

239

Objects

Time / Date

The time of latest sampling data will be marked on the top left corner of the object. It is used to set the time display format and color.

The picture below shows the attribute of “channel tab”.

[Channel]

Set each sampling line’s format and color, and the display data’s low limit and high limit. The max. channel can up to 64 channels.

Limit / uncheck “Dynamic limits”

[Zero][Span]

[Zero] and [Span] are used to set the low limit and high limit of sampling data, So if the low limit is 50 and high limit is 100 for one sampling line, then [Zero] and [Span] must be set as [50] and [100], so all the sampling data can be displayed in the trend display object.

240

Objects

Limit / check “Dynamic limits”

When Dynamic Limits is selected, the low limit and high limit are derived from the designated word device. The data length of the word device for limits is related to the data format of object. In the example below,

Data Format Low limit

16-bit format Address

32-bit format Address

High limit

Address + 1

Address + 2

An extended function is zoom in and zoom out function.

Example of zoom in/out function

For zoom in / out the trend graph, user has to check the Limit/Dynamic limits as picture below.

For example, the LW0 and LW1 are to control low limit and high limit, you may change the value of LW1 to zoom in / out.

This following picture is in original size. The range of trend is between 0~30. The arrow on the right side are set word (LW1, increment (JOG+) and LW1, decrement (JOG-)) for control the zoom in and zoom out function.

Decrease LW1’s value to exhibit zoom in function as shown below:

The value of LW1 decreased to 11.

241

Objects

Increase LW1’s value to exhibit zoom out function as shown below:

The value of LW1 increased to 41.

242

Objects

13.18 History Data Display

Overview

“History Data Display” object displays data stored by data sampling object. It displays history data in numeric format. Please note that the history data display will not refresh automatically, it only retrieve the data from the designated record and display at the time window popup. If the content of the designated record is updated, the history data display will not change accordingly.

Configuration

Click the “History Data Display” icon on the toolbar, the “History Data

Display” dialog box show up on the screen. Fill in each items and click OK button, a new object will be created.

243

Objects

[Data Sampling object index]

Select the corresponding “Data sampling object” where the history data comes from.

Grid

Set grid enable or disable.

244

Objects

[Color] Set color of grid.

[Column interval] Set space of column.

Profile color

Set color of frame and background. If it is set as transparent, the frame and background will be ignored.

Time and Date

Enable or disable the time and date of data sampling and format.

[Time ascending]

“Time ascending” means to put the earlier data in the top and the latest data in the bottom.

[Time descending]

“Time descending” means to put the latest data in the top and the earlier data in the bottom.

245

Objects

History Control

The history files are named with date code. The history control is used to select the designated history data files for display. In case the value of history control is 0, the latest file is selected. If it is 1, the second latest file is selected, and so on.

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of History control.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

246

Objects

Each history data display object can display up to 64 channels. You can select the channels which you want to watch on the screen.

In the example below, there are four channels in the data sampling object, Ch.0 and

Ch.3 are selected for display only. The data format of each channel is decided by the related data sampling objects.

When display [String] format in history data display object, users may choose: a. Display in [UNICODE] mode b. Reverse high byte and low byte data then display.

247

Objects

[Use title]

To enable or disable title.

Title background

[Transparent]

To enable or disable transparent.

[Background color]

Set the background color of title.

248

Objects

[Setting]

This dialog window defines the title.

You can use label tag library for title with multi-language. Go to [setting] and select one from label library.

Note:

If you have run the off-line simulation and the sampling data is saved in the record, then you want to change the format of sampling data, be sure to delete previous data record in C:\EasyBuilder Pro\HMI_memory\datalog to avoid the system misinterpret the old data record.

249

Objects

13.19 Data Block Display

Overview

Data Block is a combination of several word devices with continuous address, for example LW12, LW13, LW14, LW15 and so on. Use Data Block Display object to display multiple data blocks in trend curve, for example, it can display two data blocks

LW12~LW15 and RW12~RW15 in trend curve simultaneously. It is very useful to observe and compare the difference of trend curves.

Snapshot of Data Block Display

250

Objects

Configuration

[New object]

Click the “Data Block Display” icon, “Data Block Display’s properties” dialog box appears as follows:

[No. of channel]

Set the no of channel for this object. Each channel represents one data block. The max. no. of channel is 12.

Cursor Line

Using the “Cursor line” function, when user touches the Data Block display object, it will display a cursor line on the data block display object, and transfer the position of cursor and the data at the cursor position to the designated registers.

Please refer 19.3 On line operation for further information.

[Channel] Select each channel and set the attributes.

251

Objects

Control address

[PLC name]

Select the PLC where the target data block located.

Click [Setting…] to Select the [PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of Control address.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

[Device type]

Select the device type where the target data block located.

[Control word address]

“Control word” is used to control and clear trend curve display.

0 = No action (default)

1 = Plot trend curve

2 = Clear trend curve

3 = Redraw trend curve

After executing the operation above, the system will reset the control word to zero.

[No. of data address]

“No. of data address” is default as “Control word address +1”.

“No. of data” is to store the number of word device in each data block, i.e. the number of data to plot in trend curve. The maximum value is 1024.

[Data storage start address]

Click [Setting…] to Select the [PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of Data storage start address.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

[Offset value storage address]

If “offset to start address” is enabled, the “Offset value storage address” is default as

“Control word address” + 2.

[Format]

If you select 16-bit data format, the address of each data will be start address, start address + 1, start address + 2 and so on.

If you select 32-bit data format, the address of each data will be start address, start address + 2, start address + 4 and so on.

252

Objects

Limit

Set the minimum and maximum limit of trend curve, the trend curve is limited by the minimum and maximum limit.

[Data samples]

Set the data samples, samples to scroll, frame and color of background.

253

Objects

Grid

254

Objects

Channel

Set the color and width of each trend curve.

255

Objects

On line operation

How to show a trend curve

a. Write the number of data to [No. of data address], i.e. “control word address+1” b. Have the content of data block ready for display.

NOTE: data block start from “control word address + 2”. c. Write “1” to [Control word address], the previous trend curve remains and the new content in data block will be plot on the screen. d. The system will write “0” to [Control word address] after the trend curve displayed.

__________________________________________________________________

______

NOTE : During the period between c and d, do not change the content of [Control],

[No. of Data] and [Data], it might cause error for trend curve plot.

How to clear a trend curve

a. Write “2” to [Control word address], all the trend curves will be cleared. b. The system will write “0” to [Control word address] after the trend curve is cleared.

256

Objects

How to clear the previous trend curve and display new one

a. Write the number of data to [No. of data address], i.e. “control word address+1” b. Have the content of data block ready for display.

Note: data block start from “control word address + 2”. c. Write “3” to [Control word address], the previous trend curves will be cleared and the new content in data block will be plot on the screen. d. The system will write “0” to [Control word address] after the trend curve displayed.

257

Objects

How to use offset mode

If “offset to start address” is selected, the “Data storage start address” will be calculated from “control word address + [Offset value storage address]”. “Offset value storage address” is “control word address +2”.

In the following example, the content of “Offset value storage address” is “m”, therefore the data block is started from the address “control word address + m”.

__________________________________________________________________

______

NOTE If the control register is 32 bits device, only bit 0-15 will be used as control purpose, bit 16-31 will be ignored. (as illustration below)

If you do not use “offset to start address”, the system will continuously read [Control] and [No. of Data]. At the time [Control] is changed to non-zero, the system will then read the data block. If you use “offset to start address”, the system will continuously read

[Control], [No. of Data] and [Offset].

It is recommended to use “offset to start address” for data block display with multiple channels and the same device type. You can register [Control], [No. of Data] and [Offset] in continuous address for

258

Objects each channel. The system will read the control words of all the channels in one read command and it shall speed up the response time.

Please refer to the following picture. The control words of channel 1 is located from address 0, the control words of channel 2 is located from address 3, there are continuous address and the system will read all the control words in one read command.

How to use watch (Cursor Line) feature

You may use the “Watch” function to check the value of any point in trend curve.

When operator touches the data block object, it will display a “Cursor line”, the system will write the index and value of that data in cursor line to the designated address. The user shall register NI objects with the designated address. The operator shall be able to observe the numeric value in across with the cursor line.

259

Objects

In the following example, the data block display contains two data blocks. The data format of channel 1 is 16 bit BCD and that of channel 2 is 32 bit unsigned. The cursor is positioned in data index 3 which is corresponding to the fourth data in data block. The system writes “data index” and the content of watched data to the watch address as shown in the following picture.

__________________________________________________________________

______

NOTE 1. [Data Index] is a 16 bit unsigned integer; when the designated register of cursor line is 32 bit device, it will be stored in the bit 0-15.

2. The watch function can only inspect current value in the data block. If there are multiple trend curves of the same channel on the screen, the data of previous trend curves is not exist, only the latest value is available for watch.

3. If the trend curve is cleared, when position the cursor line, the “0” will be displayed as shown below.

4. If there are only three data in Channel 1, when position the cursor in Data

260

Objects

4, the “0” will be displayed as shown below.

Limitation:

1. The maximum number of channels is 12.

2. The system can draw up to 32 trend curves.

3. The system can draw up to 1024 points for each channel.

261

Objects

13.20 XY Plot

Overview

XY Plot object displays two dimension data. Each data contains X and Y values and each curve is composed of a stream of XY data. The maximum number of trend curves in a XY plot is 16 channels.

Configuration

[New object]

Click the “XY plot” icon, and “XY Plot Object” dialog box appears.

262

Objects

General

a. Direction: There are four selections, right, left, up or down.

Right: Left:

Up: Down: b. No. of channel.

Set the no. of channels of the XY plot. Each channel may conduct the draw operation alone.

Control address

[PLC name]

Select the PLC where the control address coming from

Click [Setting…] to Select the [PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of Control address.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

[Device type]

Select the device type where the control address coming from.

[Control address]

“Control address” is used to control the display of XY curve for each channel.

1= Plot XY curve

Write ”1” to control address, the system will plot the XY curve, the previous XY curve if exists would not be clear. The system will reset the control address after operation complete.

263

Objects

2= Clear XY trend curve

Write ”2” to control address, the system will clear all the previous XY curves and reset the control address after operation complete.

3= Refresh XY trend curve

Write ”3” to control address, the system will clear the previous XY curve and plot the new XY curve and reset the control address after operation complete.

[No. of data address]

This address store the number of XY data. Each channel can have up to 1023 XY data.

Channel

Setting the channels detail for graph display.

Read Address

[PLC name]

Select the PLC where the control address coming from.

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of Read address.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

[PLC address]

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], , [Index

register], for read address.

The usage of each address as follows, (Dynamic limits is not enabled.)

For example:

The Read address is LW100.

X data 0 reads value from reading address LW100.

X data 1 reads value from reading address LW101.

X data 2 reads value from reading address LW102.

X data 3 reads value from reading address LW103.

264

Objects

X data 4 reads value from reading address LW104.

X data 5 reads value from reading address LW105 and so on…

The usage of each address as follows, (Dynamic limits is enabled.)

For example:

The Read address is LW100.

X low limit reads value from reading address LW100.

X high limit reads value from reading address LW101.

Y low limit reads value from reading address LW102.

Y high limit reads value from reading address LW103.

X data 0 reads value from reading address LW104.

Y data 0 reads value from reading address LW105.

X data 1 reads value from reading address LW106.

Y data 1 reads value from reading address LW107.

If you check “Separated address for X and Y data”, it allows you to set different address for X and Y axis respectively.

The usage of each address as follows, (Dynamic limits is not enabled.)

For example:

The Read address is LW100 and LW200.

X data

X low limit reads value from reading address LW100.

X high limit reads value from reading address LW101.

X data 0 reads value from reading address LW102.

X data 1 reads value from reading address LW103.

X data 2 reads value from reading address LW104.

X data 3 reads value from reading address LW105 and so on…

Ydata

Y low limit reads value from reading address LW200.

Y high limit reads value from reading address LW201.

265

Objects

Y data 0 reads value from reading address LW202.

Y data 1 reads value from reading address LW203.

Y data 2 reads value from reading address LW204.

Y data 3 reads value from reading address LW205 and so on…

Limits

The above settings are based on dynamic limits, you can also have dynamic limits disable and set the fix high and low limits.

The high and low limits is used as scale to calculate the percentage of X and Y axis. i.e.

X or Y % = ( X or Y reading value – low limit ) /

( high limit – low limit )

Based on your settings, the memory allocation for limit and XY data will be as follows.

The following setting is for 16-bit signed data format and dynamic limits.

X low limit reads value from reading address LW0.(n+0)

X high limit reads value from reading address LW1. (n+1)

Y low limit reads value from reading address LW2. (n+2)

Y high limit reads value from reading address LW3. (n+3)

X data 0 reads value from reading address LW4. (n+4)

Y data 0 reads value from reading address LW5. (n+5)

266

Objects

The following setting is for 32-bit float data format and dynamic limits.

X low limit reads value from reading address LW100.(n+0)

X high limit reads value from reading address LW102. (n+2)

Y low limit reads value from reading address LW104. (n+4)

Y high limit reads value from reading address LW106. (n+6)

X data 0 reads value from reading address LW108. (n+8)

Y data 0 reads value from reading address LW110. (n+10)

NOTE

There are four different type of selection to designate memory location for high/low limits and XY data. Please refer to the following settings.

267

Objects

If dynamic limit is checked, you may change the high and low limits to realize zoom in and zoom out function. (Please refer trend display object’s dynamic limit.)

In the following example, the dynamic limit is selected, where XL=X low limit, XH=X high limit, YL=Y low limit, YH=Y high limit, and XY, XY1, XY2 are three XY data. Now we change the high limit of X and Y respectively and you may observe the effect of zoom in and zoom out.

268

Objects

1. Change Y high limit to 25 for zoom in effect.

2. Change Y high limit to 100 for zoom out effect.

269

Objects

[Display Area tab]

Profile color

Enable Transparent: It will not display the background color.

Disable Transparent: It will display the background color

Curve

Set the attribute of XY curve (color and width) for each channel.

270

Objects

Maker

There are four different type of XY plot, i.e. Line, Point, X-axis projection and Y-axis projection, check one of them.

For Line and Point selection, set appropriate point width (unit in pixels).

Line & Point:

X-axis projection is shown as the following:

271

Objects

Remarks:

Please refer to the figure below, there is a curve containing 7 points from P0 to P6. The system carries out X-axis projection with following steps: a. Automatically calculate two projected points in X-axis – (X

0

, 0) and (X

6

, 0). b. Link all these points in the order of (X

0

, 0), P0, P1… P6, (X

6

, 0) and returns to (X

0

, 0) at last. c. Fill out all enclosed areas formed.

X-axis projection :

Similarly for Y-axis projection:

272

Objects

Reference line

In order to make the XY plot more readable, you can configure up to 4 horizontal reference lines on the graph. Fill in high, low limit and Y axis coordinate for each reference line.

You may also use PLC address to define high and low limit.

273

Objects

Note:

XY Plot can be drawn repeatedly up to 32 times:

1 channel32 times

2 channels16 times

The way to calculate: 32 divided by the number of channels

274

Objects

13.21 Alarm Bar and Alarm Display

Overview

Alarm bar and Alarm display objects are used to display alarm messages. Alarm messages are those events registered in the “Event log” and meet trigger conditions.

Alarm bar and Alarm display objects display these alarms in order of priority and triggering time.

Alarm bar object scroll all alarm messages in one line, alarm display object displays alarm messages in multi-line and each line represents one alarm message. The following pictures show that the alarm message are displayed in alarm display and alarm bar objects. Refer to the “Event Log” chapter for related information.

Alarm bar object

Alarm display object

Configuration

Click the “Alarm bar” icon on the toolbar, the “Alarm bar” dialog box appears; similarly, click the “Alarm display” icon on the toolbar, the

“Alarm display” dialog box appears, fill in the setting in the “General tab” and press the OK button, a new object will be created.

275

Objects

[Include categories]

Select category of events that belongs to the alarm display or alarm bar object.

(category of an event is set in event log)

For example, if the category of an alarm bar is set to 2~4, it will display all the alarm messages with “category” equal to 2, 3, or 4.

Please refer to “Category” statement in “Event Log” chapter.

[Scroll Speed] Set the scroll speed of alarm bar.

[Color] Set frame and background color of alarm bar.

276

Objects

[Format] a. Sort

Set the order to display alarm message.

[Time ascending]

Put the latest trigger alarm message in the bottom.

[Time descending]

Put the latest trigger alarm message in the top.

b.

Order & Characters

Users can decide the display item, and how the item display order.

c.

Date (Event trigger date)

Display the date tag with alarm message. There are four formats of date tag.

1. MM/DD/YY / 2. DD/MM/YY / 3. DD.MM.YY / 4. YY/MM/DD

d.

Time (Event trigger time)

Display the time tag with alarm message. There are three formats of time tag.

1. HH:MM:SS / 2. HH:MM / 3. DD:HH:MM / 4. HH

Set font and color of alarm message in the “Font” tab. See the picture below.

277

Objects

13.22 Event Display

Overview

Event display object displays active and finished events. The events are registered in

“Event log” object. The active events are the events which are in trigger condition, or have been triggered and unacknowledged.

The event display object displays those active events in the order of trigger time. See the picture below. Event display object can also display the time of the events been triggered, acknowledged and recovered.

Configuration

Click the “Event Display” icon on the toolbar, the “Event Display” dialog box appears, set each items in the “General” tab, press OK button and a new

“Event Display Object” will be created.

278

Objects

[Mode]

Select the event source format, there are “Real-time” and “History” for selection.

a. Real-time

Write address

This displays the events in the log triggered from HMI starts up till present. When the events are acknowledged, the value in [Alarm (Event) Log]/ [Message]/ [Write value for

Event Display object] will be exported to the [write address] of [event display] object.

279

Objects

b. History Control

[Enable reading multiple histories] not selected.

In this mode it displays event log from history record. The system save the event history in daily basis. The event history of each date is saved in separated files with date tags attached. The “History control” is used to select one history record file.

The picture below shows the “History control” setting, which designates a word device for “History control”.

The system selects history record by an index. Index 0 refers to the latest history record

(normally it is history record today). Index 1 refers to the history record one day before the latest, and so on.

The current value in “History control” register is used as the index to select corresponding history record.

Here is an example to explain how to use “History control”. The “history control” register is [LW100], supposed that the history records saved in system are

EL_20061120.evt,

EL_20061123.evt,

EL_20061127.evt

EL_20061203.evt,

Where 2006xxxx is the date of system saved history record. The following table shows the corresponding historical record displayed be event display object according to the value of [LW100].

Value of [LW100] Corresponding Historical Record

0 EL_20061203.evt

1

2

EL_20061127.evt

EL_20061123.evt

3 EL_20061120.evt

[Enable reading multiple histories] selected.

Definition: Displays a list of events triggered in multiple days.

280

Objects

Illustration: Take LW0 to be the [History Control] [Address] as an example, the range of data to be displayed will be formed by LW0 and LW1 while value in LW0 represents the first history data to start with.

Example: As illustrated below, for showing it clearer, the history data is numbered according to the date they are established, (No.0、No.1、No.2…). If the value in LW0 is “3”, the first data to be displayed will be data No. 3.

As for LW1, 2 modes can be selected. a. Number of days

The range of History Data to be displayed will start from number in LW0. The value in

LW1 represents how many days to be included from the start to days before.

Example: As illustrated below, if value of LW0 is “1”, LW1 is “3”, then the range of data will start form 20100609, and include data of 2 days before (while 20100609 itself is counted). We can see that in this example, since data of 20100607 does not exist, the data displayed will only include 20100609 and 20100608.

281

Objects b. Index of the last history

Range of data to be displayed will take value in LW0 as a start point and value in LW1 as an end.

Example: if value in LW0 is “1”, and LW1 “3”, the displayed data will start from No. 1, and include 3 history data (No.1, No.2, No.3).

The maximum size of data that can be displayed by system is 4MB; the exceeding part will be ignored.

The following shows how data will be stored while the data size is too big.

Example: a. 5 history data, each with a size of 0.5MB  The size of data to be displayed will be 5 x 0.5MB b. 5 history data, each with a size of 1MB  The size of data to be displayed will be 4 x

1MB c. 5 history data, each with a size of 1.5MB  The size of data to be displayed will be 2 x 1.5MB+1 x 1MB (partial)

Definition:

1. To select confirmed or recovered events to be displayed or hidden.

2. In [Real- time] mode, select events to be deleted.

Illustration:

282

Objects

If the address of History control is set LW100:

1. When the value in [LW100+0] is “0”  All events will be displayed.

2. When the value in [LW100+0] is “1” The confirmed events will be hidden.

3. When the value in [LW100+0] is “2” The recovered events will be hidden.

4. When the value in [LW100+0] is “3” The confirmed and recovered events will be hidden.

When the value in [LW100+1] is “1”  Users can delete the selected events under

[real-time] mode.

283

Objects

[Include categories]

Select category of events that belongs to the event display object. (category of an event is set in event log)

For example, if the category of an event log display is set to 2~4, it will display all the active event messages with “category” equal to 2, 3, or 4.

Please refer to “Category” statement in “Event Log” chapter.

[Acknowledge style]

You may select “Click” or “Double click” to acknowledge a new event. When a new event comes up, the operator can “Click” or “Double click” to acknowledge the new event, the system will change the text color of that event and export the “write value” registered with the event to the designated register.

Take use of this feature, the user can register a popup window and put the warning message in the window, then configure an indirect window object, when the event is acknowledged, the “write value” is written into the read address of the indirect window and call up the popup window.

[Max. event no.]

The maximum number of events to be displayed in the event display object. When the number of events is larger than the maximum, the oldest event will be removed from the event display object.

[Color]

Set the color of events in different states.

a. Acknowledge

b. Return to normal

c. Select box – The system draw a highlight box around the latest acknowledged event.

284

Objects

Format

Sort

Set the order to display alarm message.

[Time ascending]

Put the latest trigger alarm message in the bottom.

[Time descending]

Put the latest trigger alarm message in the top.

Order & Characters

Users can decide the display item, and how the item display order.

Date [Event trigger date]

Display the date tag with alarm message. There are four formats of date tag.

1. MM/DD/YY / 2. DD/MM/YY / 3. DD.MM.YY / 4. YY/MM/DD

Time [Event trigger time]

Display the time tag with alarm message. There are three formats of time tag.

1. HH:MM:SS / 2. HH:MM / 3. DD:HH:MM / 4. HH

The font tab sets the font size and italic attribute. The font of event message is set with the event log object.

285

Objects

13.23 Data Transfer (Trigger-based)

Overview

Data Transfer (Trigger-based) object can transfer values from the source registers to the destination registers. The data transfer operation can be activated by pressing the object or setting a trigger bit.

Configuration

Click “Data Transfer (Trigger-based) object” icon on the toolbar, “Data

Transfer (Trigger-based) object” dialog box will show up, set each item in the

“General” tab, press OK button, a new Trigger Data Transfer object will be created.

286

Objects

Source address

Set source address of data transfer.

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of Source address.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object

Destination address

Set the destination address of data transfer.

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of Destination address.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object

287

Objects

Attribute

[No. of words]

The number of words to be transferred from source to destination.

Set the trigger mode of data transfer.

[Mode] a. Touch trigger

Press the object to activate data transfer operation.

b. External trigger

Register a bit device to trigger the data transfer operation.

[ON → OFF]

Bit device change from ON to OFF to activate data transfer operation.

[OFF → ON]

Bit device change from OFF to ON to activate data transfer operation.

[ON ←→ OFF]

Bit device change state to activate data transfer operation.

288

Objects

13.24 Backup

Overview

The backup function can store the recipe data (RW, RW_A), event log and sampling data to USB device or Remote backup server. The [LB-9039] represents the backup status, when backup operation is in progress, the status of [LB-9039] is ON.

Configuration

Click “Backup Object” icon on the toolbar, the “Backup Object” dialog box will show up.

289

Objects

Source

[RW], [RW_A], [Historical event log], [Historical data sampling]

Select one from the above for the source. There may be several data sampling objects registered in the project. If you select [Historical data log], use “

Data Sampling object

index:” to select the right one as shown below.

Backup Position

Select the destination where the source files will be copied to.

a. SD card or USB Disk

The external device connected to HMI.

b. Remote printer/backup server

To select this, users have to enable MT remote printer/backup server from:

Menu  Edit  System Parameters  Printer/Backup Server

Save format

User can select the desired format to back up the file.

a. HMI Event Log File (*.evt) / HMI Data Log File (*.dtl)

b. Comma Separated Values (*.csv)

Event Log saved as csv file

Data Log saved as csv file

When back up event log in csv format, users can find data fields in EXCEL as below.

290

Objects

0 -> event is triggered

1 -> event is acknowledged

2 -> event returns to normal

Range

[Start] from [Today] or

[Yesterday]

[Within]

Select the range of time period, for example, Select [Yesterday] in [Start], and select “2 day(s)”. It means to save the files yesterday and the day before yesterday. Select “All” to save all the files available in the system.

Attribute

There are two ways to activate Backup function.

a. Touch trigger

Touch the object to activate backup operation.

b. External trigger (bit)

Register a bit device to trigger the backup operation.

[ON → OFF]

Bit device change from ON to OFF to activate backup operation.

[OFF → ON]

Bit device change from OFF to ON to activate backup operation.

[ON ←→ OFF]

Bit device change state to activate backup operation.

291

Objects

Trigger address

When use “External trigger”, assign an appropriate bit device as shown below.

292

Objects

c. External trigger (word)

When selecting [External trigger (word)], users can specify the number of days to backup data using [Trigger address].

[Trigger address] usage (suppose the current Trigger Address is set to LW-0):

LW-0: When the value of this address changes from 0 to 1, trigger backup.

LW-1: The data in this address is for specifying the start date of backup.

LW-2: The data in this address is for specifying the number of days for backup.

The Syntax is shown below:

293

Objects

13.25 Media Player

(Note: This object is not available for EasyBuilder Pro V1.00 and hardware firmware

20120130 or before. )

For the first time using Media Player object, it’s necessary to download the project to the HMI via Ethernet. EasyBuilder Pro will install Media Player drivers during the download.

Overview

The Media Player function is not only used to play video files but also to provide uses of additional controls such as seeking, zooming, volume adjusting and so on. With the

Media Player, users can provide operation and maintenance instructions or standard procedures on video, which can help to create an environment that enables any on-site operators to perform tasks efficiently from clear, comprehensible instructions. (Note:

The Media Player function is only available on the HMI.)

Configuration

Click “Media Player object” icon on the toolbar, “Media Player object” dialog box show up, set each item in the “General” tab, press OK button, a new Media Player object will be created. (Note: The instruction of this section is an example to play a video file located in the “/example” directory.)

294

Objects

General tab

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address],

[System tag], [Index register] of Control address.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object. a. In [Control address], select [Enable] and register a word device to control the operation of media player object (example:LW0)

295

Objects b. In [Control address], unselect the [Update video playing time] c. In [Ext. device], select [USB disk] and input “ example” as [Folder name]. d. In [Attribute], unselect [Auto. repeat] and choose black as the background color.

Preview tab

Users can examine whether the HMI supports the video format via preview function.

296

Objects a. Click [Load…] and select the file to be examined. (Users should put the file in the

/example directory of an USB disk) b. If the media player starts playing the video, it means the HMI supports this video format. Use [<<] and [>>] to navigate video by 1 minute each time. c. To play another video, click [Stop] to close the video file and repeat from step a.

Prepare the video file:

a. Remove all external devices (SD/USB disk) connected to the

HMI. b. Plug the USB disk, which has the video file in it, into the HMI.

__________________________________________________________________

Note

The first step is there for ensuring the USB disk (in step b) will be recognized.

__________________________________________________________________

Start/Stop playing video

1. Start playing video

a. Set [Parameter 1] to 0. b. Set [Command] to 1, the system will open the video file and start playing. c. After the system start operation, it will reset the [Command] to ”0”.

297

Objects

__________________________________________________________________

Note

During the period between step b and c, don’t change the content of [Command],

[Parameter 1], and [Parameter 2], it may cause unpredictable result.

__________________________________________________________________

2. Stop playing video

a. Set [Command] to 5, the system will stop playing and close the video file. b. After the system complete step a, it will reset the [Command] to ”0”.

__________________________________________________________________

Note

During the period between step a and b, don’t change the content of [Command],

[Parameter 1], and [Parameter 2], it may cause unpredictable result.

__________________________________________________________________

298

Objects

Media player setting guide

General tab

Setting

Enable control address

Control address

Description

Enable a. You can use “Control address” to control the operation of media player b. Register a device address for “Control address”.

Disable

There is no manual control of video play operation. The system will start to play the first video at designated folder when the window is popup.

299

Video file store location

Objects

Command

Users set this address to control the operation of media player.

Command (control address + 0)

Parameter 1

Parameter 2

Parameter 1 for control operation.

Parameter 1 (control address + 1)

Parameter 2 for control operation

Parameter 2 (control address + 2)

Status

File index

Start time

The system will turn bits ON when state changes or malfunctions.

Status (control address + 3)

The system will write file index when starting to play a video.

File index (control address + 4)

The system will write video start time when starting to play a video. (unit = sec) (Always 0)

Start time (control address + 5)

End time

Video playing time

SD

Update video playing time

Update period

Playing time

The system will write video end time when starting to play a video. (unit = sec)

End time (control address + 6)

Enable

The system will write video elapsed time into

[playing time] register in every [update period] seconds.

Update period of [playing time], range between 1 to

60 sec.

Update the video elapsed time periodically. (unit = sec)

Playing time (control address + 7)

Play video files in SD card.

USB

Folder name

Play video files in USB disk.

The name of the folder storing video files. Users must put video files in a folder (e.g. “/example”) instead of root directory.

Note

1. [Folder name] couldn’t be empty.

2. [Folder name] couldn’t include /\:*?”<>|.

3. A folder name must be composed entirely of

300

Objects

ASCII characters.

Attribute

Auto. repeat

When finish playing a video file, the system will automatically play next video. e.g. [video 1]  [video 2]  … [video n]  [video

1]

Background

Select the background color of the object.

Normally the format of the above registers is 16-unsigned integer. If a 32-bit word device is chosen as the control address, only 0-15 bits are effective. Users should zero the

16-31 bits.

Control command

a. Play index file

[Command] = 1

[Parameter 1] = file index

[Parameter 2] = ignore (set 0)

Note 1. The files are sorted with file name in ascending order, the “file index=0” is for to the first file, and son on.

2. If it is unable to scan file, it will set [status] bit 8 to ON.

3. If check [Auto. repeat], it will automatically play the next file after finish.

b. Play previous file

[Command] = 2

[Parameter 1] = ignore (set 0)

[Parameter 2] = ignore (set 0)

Note 1. If the [file index] is previously 0, it will re-play the same video from the start.

2. If it is unable to search the right file, it will set [status] bit 8 to ON.

3. If check [Auto. repeat], it will automatically play the next file after finish.

c. Play next file

[Command] = 3

[Parameter 1] = ignore (set 0)

[parameter 2] = ignore (set 0)

301

Objects

Note 1. If there is no next video file, it will play the first (index 0) file.

2. If it is unable to search the right file, it will set [status] bit 8 to ON.

3. If check [Auto. repeat], it will automatically play the next file after finish.

d. Pause / Play Switch

[Command] = 4

[Parameter 1] = ignore (set 0)

[Parameter 2] = ignore (set 0)

e. Stop playing and close file

[Command] = 5

[Parameter 1] = ignore (set 0)

[Parameter 2] = ignore (set 0)

f. Start playing at designated target location

[Command] = 6

[Parameter 1] = target location (sec)

[Parameter 2] = ignore (set 0)

Note Parameter 1 (target location) should less than end time. If it is over end time, the system play video from last second.

g. Forward

[Command] = 7

[Parameter 1] = target location (sec)

[Parameter 2] = ignore (set 0)

Note 1. Increase playing time by [Parameter 1] seconds. If the system is previously playing video, it continues to play after the operation. If previously paused, it keeps paused.

2. If the playing time is over end time, the system play video from last second.

h. Backward

[Command] = 8

[Parameter 1] = target location (sec)

302

Objects

[Parameter 2] = ignore (set 0)

Note 1. Decrease playing time by [Parameter 1] seconds. If the system is previously playing video, it continues to play after the operation. If previously paused, it keeps paused.

2. If the playing time is less than start time, the system play video from the beginning.

i. Adjust volume

[Command] = 9

[Parameter 1] = volume (0 ~ 128)

[Parameter 2] = ignore (set 0)

Note Default volume is 128.

j. Set video display size

[Command] = 10

[Parameter 1] = display size (0 ~ 16)

[Parameter 2] = ignore (set 0)

Note 1. [0]:Fit video image to object size.

2. [1 ~ 16]:Magnification from 25% ~ 400%. Set 1 for 25%, 2 for 50%, 3 for 75% and so on.

k. Status (control address + 3)

15

Reserved (all 0)

09 08

0 0

02 01

0

00 bit

0

Bit 00: open file bit (0: file closed;1: file opened)

Bit 01: play file bit (0: not playing video;1: playing video)

Bit 08: command error bit (0: command accepted;

1: incorrect command or parameters)

Bit 09: file error bit (0: file format accepted;

1: unknown file format or reading file error)

303

Objects

When playing a video, the system will turn ON [open file bit] and [play file bit]. If the file is unable to be scanned or the command is incorrect, the [command error bit] will be set ON (01).

Note 1. If file format is unsupported or disk I/O error happens during playing (e.g. user unplugs the USB disk), the [file error bit] will be set ON (01).

2. Refer to the following figure, the value of [status] at each state would be:

“Stop” [status] = 0

“Pause” [status] = 1 ([open file bit])

“Playing” [status] = 3 ([open file bit] + [play file bit])

Playing

play command

(1, 2, 3)

(5)

Finish playing

Stop

stop command (5) switch pause command

(4)

Pause

Users should only set values to [Command], [Parameter 1] and [Parameter 2], and regard the other registers as read-only.

Restrictions

The system can only play one video file each time.

If [Auto. repeat] is unselected, the system will stop playing video and close the file after complete a video play operation.

If [control address] is unselected, the system will find the first file in the designated directory and start playing it.

304

Objects

13.26 Data Transfer (Time-based)

Overview

Data transfer (Time-based) object is the same as Data transfer (Trigger-based) object, it also transfers the data from source to destination register. The difference is the way to activate data transfer operation. The Data transfer (time-based) object conducts data transfer operation based on time schedule, it can also transfer data in the unit of bits.

Configuration

Click “Data Transfer (Time-based) Object” icon on the toolbar, the summary of data transfer objects is shown as follows:

Press the “New…” button in the above dialog box, the Data Transfer (Time-based)

Object dialog box appear as shown in the picture below, set item and press OK button, the object will be created.

305

Objects

Attribute

[Address type]

Select the bit or word device.

[No. of words] or [No. of bits]

When select “Word type”, the unit of data transfer is word, set the number of data to transfer. See the picture below.

When select “Bit type”, the unit of data transfer is bit, set the number of data to transfer.

See the picture below.

306

Objects

[Interval]

Select the wait interval for each data transfer, for example, select 3 seconds, the system will conduct data transfer operation every 3 seconds.

Note

1. Specifying a small interval or a big number of data to transfer may cause an overall performance decrease due to the time consuming in transferring data.

Therefore, users should always try to choose a longer interval and a smaller amount of data to transfer.

2. When a short interval is inevitable, be aware of the interval must be longer than the data transfer operation. For example, if the data transfer operation take 2 seconds, you must set the interval longer than 2 seconds.

Source address

Set source address.

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of source address.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

Destination address

Set destination address.

Click [Setting…] to Select the

[PLC name], [Device type], [Address], [System tag],

[Index register] of destination address.

Users can also set address in General tab while adding a new object.

After completing all settings and pressing the “OK” button, a new Data Transfer

(Time-based) Object is created. The summary displays all the registered data transfer objects with brief information as shown below.

307

Objects

13.27 PLC Control

Overview

The PLC control object activates a specific operation when the corresponding control device is triggered.

Configuration

Click the “PLC Control” icon and the “PLC Control Object” summary appears as shown below.

Press the “New…” button and the “PLC Control” dialog box appears. Set all the attributes of PLC control and press OK button, a new PLC control object will be created.

308

Objects

Attribute & Trigger address

[Type of control]

To set the type of control. Click the select button and you can drag down a list of all available PLC control functions

a. “Change window”

This is used to change base window. When the value of [Trigger address] is written in a valid window number, the system will close the current window and open the window designated by the [Trigger address]. The new window number will be written to the

[Trigger address + 1].

309

Objects

As an example of the above configuration. When writing a valid window number – 11 into LW0, the system will close the current window and open window 11, then write 11 into LW1 (LW0+1)

If you use 32-bit device as trigger address, and the device type of the trigger address is in word basis, then the system will write the window number into [Trigger address +2].

Below is the list of write address for each different type of data format.

Data Format

16-bit BCD

Trigger address

Address

Write address

Address + 1

32-bit BCD Address

16-bit Unsigned Address

16-bit Signed Address

32-bit Unsigned Address

32-bit Signed Address

Address + 2

Address + 1

Address + 1

Address + 2

Address + 2

Note: If [LB-9017] = ON, the write back operation will not be executed.

If “Clear data after window changed” is selected, the [Trigger address] will be reset to 0 after new window is open.

b. “Write data to PLC (current base window)”

When the system changes the base window, the new window number will be written into the [Trigger address].

310

Objects

c. “General PLC Control”

This function performs data transfer between PLC and HMI when users set appropriate value in [Trigger address].

Control code

[Trigger address]

1

Operation for data transfer

PLC register  HMI RW

2

3

PLC register  HMI LW

HMI RW  PLC register

4 HMI LW  PLC register

With this function the system uses four continuous word devices, please refer to the following explanation.

Address

[Trigger address]

Purpose

Control code

Description

The valid control code is listed in the above table. When a new control code is written into the register, the system will conduct the data transfer function.

[Trigger address+1]

[Trigger address+2]

Number of words to transfer

Offset to the start address of PLC register

The start address of

LW or RW

If the value is “n”, the start address of PLC register is

“Trigger address + 4 + n”.

[Trigger address+3]

As an example, to transfer PLC registers [DM100, 101 … 105] to HMI [RW10, 11 … 15], follow the steps below:

1. Set Trigger address to DM10.

2. Set [DM11] = 6 (no. of words to transfer)

3. Set [DM12] = 86 (DM10+4+86= DM100)

4. Set [DM13] = 10 (RW10)

5. Set [DM10] = 1, The system will execute the data transfer operation.

311

Objects

d. “Back light control (write back)”

Set [Trigger address] to “ON”, the system will turn on/off the backlight and reset the

[Trigger address]. Any touch on the screen will turn the backlight on.

e. “Back light control”

This operation is the same as “Back light control (write back)” except the system would not reset the [Trigger address].

f. “Sound control”

Activate the [Trigger address], the system will play the sound.

Select a sound from sound library for the PLC Control.

You may configure three different ways to activate the [Trigger address ]:

(1) State change from OFF to ON (OFF->ON)

(2) State change from ON to OFF (ON->OFF)

(3) State change (either from ON->OFF or OFF->ON)

g. “Execute macro program”

Activate the [Trigger address], the system will execute the Macro.

You may configure three different ways to activate the [Trigger address ]:

(1) State change from OFF to ON (OFF->ON)

(2) State change from ON to OFF (ON->OFF)

(3) State change (either from ON->OFF or OFF->ON)

(4) Always active when ON

h. “Screen hardcopy”

Activate the [Trigger address], the system will have designated window printed out.

You may configure three different ways to activate the [Trigger address ]:

(1) State change from OFF to ON (OFF->ON)

312

Objects

(2) State change from ON to OFF (ON->OFF)

(3) State change (either from ON->OFF or OFF->ON)

The designated window can be one of following three different types:

[Current base window]

Print the current base window when the operation is activated.

[Window no. from register]

Print the window designated by a PLC device when the operation is activated, if [LW0]

= 14, the window no.14 will be printed out.

[Designate window no.]

Select a base window to be printed out when the operation is activated.

Note

1. The system performs a background printing process when the printed window is not the current base window.

2. For a window designed to be printed at background, users should put neither direct window nor indirect window in it.

313

Objects

13.28 Schedule

Overview

Schedule object is used to turn on/off a bit or write a value to a word device at designated time. The time schedule setting is very flexible, it can be on daily basis or weekly basis. For more advance application you can use a table (a block of word devices) to set start and terminate time, then update the table at any scheduled time.

Configuration

Click the “Schedule” icon on the toolbar and the “Scheduler list” dialog box will appear, press the “New”, the schedule object dialog box will appear as shown below:

314

Objects

Example 1:

The motor is scheduled to be power ON at 8:00 and power off at 17:00, Monday to

Friday.

Here we use LB100 to control the motor. Follow the steps to set up the schedule object.

315

Objects

Click [New…], to add a new object,

[General tab]

[Power-ON start/end action]

Detail message please refer to below Scheduler settings guide.

1. Check [Bit ON] in [Action mode],

2. Set LB100 in [Action address]

316

Objects

[Time Set tab]

3. Select [Time Set] tab, check [Constant]

4. Unselect [Setting on individual day]. In [Start], adjust time as 8:00:00 and select

Monday to Friday.

5. In [End], select [Enable termination action] and adjust time as 17:00:00.

6. Click [OK], a new schedule object is created and display on the schedule list.

317

Objects

Example 2:

Set temperature at 90F at 8:00 and set it back to 30F (standby mode) at 17:00, Monday to Friday.

Click [New…], to add a new schedule object. Follow the steps to set up the schedule object. The [LW100] is used to store set value of temperature.

318

Objects

[General tab]

1. [Power-ON start/end action]

2. Check [Word write] in [Action mode],

3. Set LW100 in [Action address]

319

Objects

4. Check [Constant] and set [Write start value] to 90 in [Word write value settings],

[Time Set tab]

5. Select [Time Set] tab, check [Constant]

6. Unselect [Setting on individual day]. In [Start], adjust time as 8:00:00 and select

Monday to Friday.

7. In [End], select [Enable termination action] and adjust time as 17:00:00.

8. Select [General] tab, set [Write start value] to 90 and [Write end value] to 30.

320

Objects

9. Click [OK], the settings appear in the Scheduler list.

Schedule settings guide

General tab

321

Objects

Action Mode

Select the type of operation performed at designated time.

[Bit ON]

At start time, turn ON the specific bit. At end time, turn OFF the bit.

Example: Start time = 09:00:00

End time = 17:00:00

Start time End time

ON

OFF

09:00:00

12:00:00 17:00:00

[Bit OFF]

At start time, turn OFF the specific bit. At end time, turn ON the bit.

Example: Start time = 09:00:00

End time = 17:00:00

Start time End time

ON

OFF

09:00:00 12:00:00 17:00:00

[Word write]

At start time, the specific [Write start value] is written to the action address. At end time,

[Write end value] is written to the action address.

Example: Device address = LW100

Start time = 09:00:00

End time = 12:00:00

Write start value = 10

Write end value = 0

LW100 10 LW100

09:00:00 12:00:00

322

Objects

Action address

Specify the address where the scheduler performs actions on.

Power-ON start/end action

Select the action to perform when power is turned on.

Enable

If the HMI power is turned ON within the scheduler range, the start action is performed. If the HMI power is turned ON outside of the scheduled range, the termination action is performed.

Inside the scheduled range:

Start time Power ON End time

Start action Termination action

Outside the scheduled range:

Power ON Start time End time

Termination action Start action Termination action

Disable

If power is turned ON but the time is later than the Start Time, the action is not automatically performed. However, the termination action is automatically performed.

Also, if the termination action is not set, the schedule range is unable to recognize and the action is not performed.

Word write value Settings

These settings are active only when Action Mode is set to [Word Write].

When performing start action, the system will write this value into action address.

[Write start value]

For [Constant]

Designates the value to be written at start time.

For [Address]

Designates the address used to store the start time value.

323

Objects

[Write end value]

When performing end action, the system will write this value into action address.

For [Constant]

Designates the value to be written at end time.

For [Address]

Designates the address used to store the end time value.

Note

You can use this option if the [Enable termination action] in [Time Set] tab is selected.

Time Set tab (when [Constant] is selected)

Constant/Address

Select the method to set the start time and end time.

Constant

Specifies a fixed time and day.

Address

The start/end time is retrieved from the device address at on line operation.

324

Objects

Setting on individual day

Enable

Start time and end time can be set in different day of week. There is only one start time and one end time during the week. You have to set both start time and end time with this mode.

Start action

09:00

Termination action

17:00

Monday

Tuesday

NOTE

1. You must enter settings for the Start Time and End Time.

2. You cannot set the Start Time and End Time to the exact same day and time.

Disable

A schedule that is 1 day (Start and End times are within 24 hours) can be entered.

Multiple Start and End days can be selected. You can perform actions at the same time on multiple days.

To specify an End Time, you must select [Enable termination

Start action

09:00

Termination action

17:00

Monday

Tuesday action]

NOTE

You cannot set the Start Time and End Time to the exact same day and time.

The time scheduler is for one day only, so if the End Time is earlier than the Start

Time, the operation of End Time will be performed on the next day.

325

Objects

(For example)

Start day: Monday

Start: 22:00:00

Monday Tuesday

End: 01:00:00

22:00:00 01:00:00

Start

Set the start time and day.

When [Setting on individual day] is disabled, user can designate more than one day.

End

Set the end time and day.

When [Enable termination action] is selected, the end time can be specified.

The day settings can only be set when [Setting on individual day] is enabled.

326

Objects

Time Set tab (when [Address] is selected)

If “address” mode is selected, the system retrieves the start/end time and day from word devices. Therefore, users can set and change scheduled time in operation.

User designates the [Time setting address] as the top address used to store time settings data. The 11 word devices are automatically allotted.

Normally the format of the above word devices is 16-unsigned integer. If a 32-bit word device is chosen, only 0-15 bits are effective and users should zero the 16-31 bits.

a. Control (Time setting address + 0)

327

Objects

The layout of the Control word is shown below. Users set the [ time acquisition request bit

] ON (01) to make the system reads the [Action mode], [Start time], and [End time] and uses them as the new scheduled time.

15 0

Bit

Reserved (0 fixed) 0

Bit 00: time acquisition request bit (0: no action, 1: perform time read)

NOTE The system would not read start and end time data unless the [time acquisition request bit] is set ON.

b. Status (Time setting address + 1)

The layout of the Status word is shown below.

When the system competes the read operation, it will turn the [time acquisition complete bit] ON (01). Also, if the read time data is incorrect, the [error notification bit] will be turned ON (01).

.

15

Reserved (0 fixed)

02 01 00

Bit

0 0

Bit 00: time acquisition complete bit (0: null, 1: read operation complete)

Bit 01: error notification bit (0: no error, 1: start or end time format is incorrect)

NOTE After system reads the time data and turns the [time acquisition complete bit] ON, be sure to turn [Control] [time acquisition request bit] OFF. Once this bit is turned OFF, the system will set both the [Status] [time acquisition complete bit] and [error notification bit] to OFF.

328

Objects

Time acquisition request bit

{PLCI trig}

Data read

{HMI read}

(1) (6) (1)

ON

OFF

(2) (7) (2)

ON

HMI confirm [time acquisition request bit] is ON

HMI confirm [time acquisition request bit] is OFF

(3)Data read

(4)

HMI turn ON [time acquisition completion bit]

(5) (8)

(3)Data read

Time acquisition completion bit

{HMI set}

OFF

Error notification bit

{HMI set}

ON

OFF

(4)

When an error occurs,

HMI turn ON [error notification bit]

(5) (8)

=communication time lag =HMI turn OFF the bit =user turn OFF the bit

c. Action mode (Time setting address + 2)

Enable and disable the [Termination time action] and [Setting on individual day].

15

Reserved (0 fixed)

02 01

0

00

Bit

0

Bit 00: Termination time setting (0: disable, 1: enable)

Bit 01: Setting on individual day (0: disable, 1: enable)

NOTE 1. If [setting on individual day] is OFF, the system still reads all 11 word devices but ignores the end time data.

2. If [setting on individual day] is ON, be sure to enter all start and end time information. If 2 or more of the start/end day bits are turned ON simultaneously, an error occurs.

329

Objects

d. Start/End Day (Start Day: Time setting address + 3, End Day: Time setting address + 7)

Designates the day used as a trigger for the start/termination action.

15

Reserved (0 fixed)

07 06

Sat

05 04

Fri

03 02 01 00

Thu Wed Tue Mon Sun

Bit

Bit 00: Sunday (0: none, 1: select)

Bit 01: Monday (0: none, 1: select)

Bit 02: Tuesday (0: none, 1: select)

Bit 03: Wednesday (0: none, 1: select)

Bit 04: Thursday (0: none, 1: select)

Bit 05: Friday (0: none, 1: select)

Bit 06: Saturday (0: none, 1: select)

e. Start/End Time (Start Time: Time setting address + 4 to + 6, End Time: Time setting address + 8 to + 10)

Set the time values used for the start/termination actions in the following ranges.

Hour: 0 - 23

Minute: 0 - 59

Second: 0 - 59

If you specify a value outside the range, an error will occur.

NOTE The time data format shall be 16-bit unsigned, system doesn’t accept BCD format.

330

Objects

Prohibit tab

Prohibit

Enable

HMI reads the bit status before performing start action. If the bit is ON, the schedule action is not performed.

Sound

Enable

When performing start and termination action, the system will simultaneously play the specified sound.

331

Objects

Restrictions:

User can register the maximum of 32 entries in Scheduler list.

The time scheduler features are one time actions. When the start time or end time is reached, the system writes the value to device just one time. (not repeated)

Start time

Operator turns OFF

End time

Action: Bit Set

Start time: 08:00:00

End time: 08:20:00

ON

OFF

07:50:00 08:00:00 18:10:00 18:20:00

Once the system execute start action, it will read [Write start address] and [Write end address] altogether, after then, even you change the value of [Write end address], the system would not use the new value.

When the operator changes RTC data, for those schedule object with both start time and end time setting, the system will check if the time update changes the status from out of schedule range to within schedule range, if it is, the start action will be performed.

If there are several schedule objects registered the same start time or end time, when time up the system will perform the operation from the first to the last in ascending order.

When [Time Set] are specified as [Address] mode, the system will read [control] word periodically.

When [Time Set] are specified as [Address] and start time and end time is over valid range, the system may not execute operation properly.

When [Time Set] are specified as [Address], the action will not start up until time data update is success.

332

Objects

13.29 Option List

Overview

An Option List displays a list of items that the user can view and select. Once the user selects an item, the value corresponding to the item will be written to a word register.

There are two forms for this object – Listbox and Drop-down list. The listbox lists all items and highlights the selected one. However, the drop-down list normally displays only the selected item. Once the user touches it, the system will display a listbox (which is similar to the one with Listbox style) beneath the object.

Configuration

Click the “Option List” icon, “Option List object properties” dialog box appears as follows:

Option list tab

333

Objects

Attribute

[Mode]

Select the object style; one of Listbox and Drop-down list.

[Item no.]

Set the number of items for the object. Each item represents a state displayed in the list and a value to be written to the [Monitor address].

[Background]

Select background color for the object.

[Selection]

Select background color for the selected/highlighted item.

[Source of item data]

There are Predefine, Dates of historical data, and Item address for selection.

334

Objects

Predefine mode

Monitor address

Select the [PLC name], [Device type], [Address] of the word register device that controls the display of the object and the system writes the value of the item to the word register.

[Write when button is released]

If this function is selected, the operation is activated at touch up. If the function is not selected, the operation is activated at touch down.

: This option is only available in listbox style.

Dates of historical data mode

Item data from dates of historical data (History index mode)

Option List object can be used with Historical Event-Display, Trend-Display and

Data-Display for displaying the History File on the Historical Display objects as below illustration.

[Type]

Alarm (Event) log is used to display Historical Event-Display.

Data sampling is used to display Historical Trend-Display or Data-Display.

[Date]

Set the date format.

[Data Sampling object]

Users have to select which Data sampling object is triggered when selecting “Data sampling” as [Type].

Users should select the same data sampling object with the one selected in Historical

Trend-Display or Data-Display.

335

Objects

Note:

1. The system will automatically disable Mapping table when History Index mode is selected.

2. When users select ”Drop-Down List” in [Attribute] and enable History Index mode, the

Option List displays “?” in Error State.

Item address mode

When selecting [Item address], users have to correctly set the content of [Control address] and [Item address].

Control address

[Address]

Set “1” to the data of the designated register of this address for updating items displayed in Option List using the content of designated register of [Item address]. After updating, the data in this register will restore to “0”.

[Address] + 1

The next address of the designated [Control address], data in this address is for setting the number of items.

Item address

This address is for storing the contents of the items.

[ASCII]

Use ASCII as item contents.

[UNICODE]

Use UNICODE as item contents, such as Chinese characters.

The UNICODE to be used must also be used in other objects. EasyBuilder Pro will then compile these font files in advance, and save to HMI when downloading, only in this way the UNICODE can be displayed correctly.

[The length of each item]

As for item length, it’s now restricted to less than 1024 when [number of items] times

[The length of each item].

Note: The system will automatically disable Mapping table when Item address mode is selected.

336

Objects

Mapping tab

Mapping table

This table displays all available states/items, their item data and values. To change the number of available items, please refer to [Option list tab]  [Attribute]  [Item no.].

[Item]

The system lists all available items. Each item represents a state that will be displayed in the list. This field is read-only.

[

Value]

Here user can assign value for each item, basing on the following two criteria:

337

Objects a. [For reading]: If any change of the content from [Monitor address] is detected, the object compares the content with these values and selects the first matched item.

If no item is matched, the status goes to error state and signals the notification bit register (if requested). b. [For writing]: The system writes this value to [Monitor address] when user selects an item.

[

Item data]

Users can assign data for each item. The option list object displays the data of all items in the list for users to review and select.

[Error state] a. For example, item 8 is the error state when specifying 8 in [Item no.]. Similarly, if you set [Item no.] to 11 then state 11 would be the error state, and so on. b. On error state, the listbox-style option list removes the highlight to represent no item is selected and the drop-down list displays the data of error state. c.

The item of error state is only applied to the drop-down list style. The listbox-style list has nothing to do with this item.

[Set default]

Set default values for all states, i.e. set 0 for item 0, 1 for item 1, and so on.

Error Notification

The system will set ON/OFF to the specified bit register when error is detected. The signal of the bit register could be used to trigger a procedure for correcting the error.

338

Objects

13.30 Timer

Overview

Use timer variables to enable timer instructions. Timer variables consist of the following six special variables.

Timer Variable

Input bit (IN)

Measurement bit

(TI)

Output bit (Q)

Variables Type

Bit type

Bit type

Bit type

Description

The master switch of timer.

Turn ON when the timer begin counting.

Activate when the timer finish counting.

Preset time (PT)

Elapsed time (ET)

Reset bit (R)

Word type

Word type

Bit type

Set the timer value.

Display current elapsed value of timer.

Reset the elapsed time (ET) to 0.

Configuration

Click the “Timer” icon, “Timer object properties” dialog box appears as follows:

339

Objects

Mode

On delay

Description

Point 1: When the IN turns ON, the TI be turned ON and the elapsed time ET increases. The Q remains

OFF.

Point 2: When the ET equals the PT, the Q be turned

340

Off delay

Pulse

Objects

ON and the TI be turned OFF.

Point 3: When the IN turns OFF, the Q be turned OFF and the ET reset to 0.

Point 4: When the IN turns ON, the TI be turned ON and the elapsed time ET increases.

Point 5: Turn the IN to OFF before the ET reaches the

PT, the TI be turned OFF, and the ET reset to 0. (the

Q remains OFF)

Point 1: When the IN turns ON, the TI remains OFF and the Q be turned ON.

Point 2: When the IN turns OFF, the TI be turned ON and the elapsed time ET increases. (the Q remains

ON)

Point 3: When the ET equals the PT, the Q and TI are turned OFF.

Point 4: When the IN turns ON, the Q be turned ON and the ET reset to 0.

Point 5: When the IN turns OFF, the TI be turned ON and the elapsed time ET increases. (the Q remains

ON)

Point 6: Turn the IN to ON before the ET reaches the

PT, the TI be turned OFF, and the ET reset to 0. (the

Q remains ON)

Point 1: When the IN turns ON, the TI and Q are turned ON, and the elapsed time ET increases.

Point 2: When the ET equals PT, the TI and Q are turned OFF.

Point 3: When the IN turns ON, the TI and Q are turned ON, and the elapsed time ET increases.

Point 4: When the ET equals the PT, the TI and Q are

341

Objects turned OFF.

Accumulated On delay Point 1: When the IN turns ON, the TI be turned ON and the elapsed time ET increases. (the Q remains

OFF)

Point 2: When the IN turns OFF, and if the ET is less than the PT, the TI be turned OFF. The ET is in the retentive state.

Point 3: When the IN turns ON, the TI be turned ON.

The timer measurement starts again and the ET is added to the kept value. The Q remains OFF.

Accumulated Off delay

Point 4: When the ET reaches the PT, the TI be turned OFF and the Q be turned ON.

Point 5: When the IN turns OFF, the Q be turned

OFF. (Reset the ET to 0 by using Reset bit (R).)

Point 1: When the IN turns ON, the Q be turned ON and TI remains OFF.

Point 2: When the IN turns OFF, the TI be turned ON and the elapsed time ET increases. (the Q remains

ON)

Point 3: When the IN turns ON, the timer measurement pauses.

Point 4: When the IN turns OFF, the paused timer measurement continues.

Point 5: When the ET equals the PT, the TI and Q are turned OFF. (Reset the ET to 0 by using Reset bit

(R).)

342

Objects

13.31 Video In

HMI provides Video Input function. Users can install surveillance camera, then monitor the factory any time they want. The video images can also be stored in devices and play them with Media Player, or analyze them on PC.

This function can be utilized in different aspects. Apart from monitoring factory, it can also be used in driving device or Building Automation monitoring.

For hardware, HMI provides 2 channels for Video Input. Users can freely switch channels to monitor, and capture images without being influenced when pause playing.

The captured images will still be real-time external image input. The supported formats are NTSC and PAL.

343

Objects

Use Control Function

Check [Use control function]

Suppose [Control Address] is designated as “LW100”:

A. Users can set [Control Address+ 0] to enable/stop Video Input function.

[LW100] = 0  Stop Playing.

[LW100] = 1  Input video image in VIP 1 and display it in screen.

[LW100] = 2  Input video image in VIP 2 and display it in screen.

[LW100] = 3  Input video image in VIP 1 but don’t display it in screen. In this way users can still execute Capture image.

[LW100] = 4  Input video image in VIP 2 but don’t display it in screen. In this way users can still execute Capture image.

B. Users can set [Control Address +1] to control the displaying of video image:

[LW101] = 1  Pause/Continue playing.

C. If users change value in [Control Address + 0], the system will keep the new value.

D. If users change value in [Control Address + 1], system will execute the corresponding command first then erase the new value and set it back to “0”.

E. If not using [Control Function], system will play the channel set in [Input channel] automatically.

If check

[Display adjustment]

The screen brightness and contrast ratio can be adjusted. If designate “LW100” as control address:

A. Adjust Contrast Ratio [Control Address + 2]: LW102, range: 1~100.

B. Adjust Brightness [Control Address + 3]: LW103, range: 1~100.

344

Objects

Use Capture Function

Definition: Capture the image of the input video.

Illustration:

A.

[Capture address] the Control Address that triggers system to capture the image of video.

B.

[Storage medium] To choose where to save the video image. Available storage:

SD card or USB disk.

-

VIP 1 video image will be saved in file VIP 1 in the chosen storage and VIP 2 video image in file VIP2.

C.

[Record time] To set a period of time for image capturing.

-

The longest period can be set starts from 10 seconds before triggering

[Capture address] to 10 seconds after triggering. In this case there will be 21 images captured, including the one captured at the triggering moment.

-

The time interval for capturing is once in each second.

-

The captured .jpg file will be named in the following format:

Before or after [Capture address] is triggered: YYYYMMDDhhmmss.jpg

345

Objects

The moment that[Capture address] is triggered: [email protected]

Take the illustration above as sample, set [Record time] “Before” and “After” to “5” seconds, when [Capture address] changes from OFF to ON, system will be triggered to capture , one image each second, from 5 seconds before the triggering time to 5 seconds after the triggering time.

Note:

1. Video In Object can only be used in HMI which supports VIP function.

2. Only video image in one channel can be input at any moment while running system.

3. Capture function won’t be influenced by “pause” playing. The video image that should be played while not paused will still be captured.

4. Recommended Format and Resolution:

1:1 50%

NTSC 720 x 480 360 x 240

PAL 720 x 576 360 x 288

346

Objects

13.32 System Message

Use this utility to edit messages that displays in popup message boxes.

Confirmation required

Display whenever security requires the user to confirm operation.

The [Message] shown on confirmation dialog, and the text label of the 2 buttons [OK] and [Cancel], can all be set. Please use the same font for the labels of [Message], [OK] and [Cancel]. Additionally, only when selecting [Label Library] for [Message], the use of

Label Library for [OK] and [Cancel] buttons can be enabled.

347

Objects

Deny write-command

Display when system tag LB-9196 (local HMI supports monitor function only) is turned

ON.

Allow write-command

Display when system tag LB-9196 (local HMI supports monitor function only) is turned

OFF.

348

Objects

13.33 Recipe View

Overview

A Recipe View Object can be used for displaying a specific recipe data. Users can watch all items and values of the recipe by this object.

Configuration

Click the [Recipe View] icon in the toolbar and the [Recipe View Object’s

Properties] dialog box will appear, fill in each items and press [OK]; a new recipe view object will be created.

349

General

Objects

Recipe table

[Recipe Name]

Choose the desired recipe name or look for other recipes from the pull down list.

Title

Each item has a title. The title is referring to the setting in [System

Parameter Setting]

-> [Recipe].

[Transparent]

If this option is being ticked, the title wouldn’t have background color. Furthermore, it wouldn’t appear an option for choosing color.

Profile

The frame and background color of the object can be set.

[Transparent]

If this option is being ticked, the background color wouldn’t be shown. Furthermore, it wouldn’t appear an option for choosing color.

350

Objects

Grid

The dividing line divides every single data.

[Transparent]

If this option is being ticked, no dividing line will be shown. Furthermore, it wouldn’t appear an option for choosing color.

Selection Control

The displayed color when pointing to a specific row.

Default sort method

Setting the way to sort records in the table of Recipe View Object.

[Ascending ] and [Descending] can be selected.

Users need to create the recipe data before using this Recipe View Object, please refer to User Manual Chapter 5 – System Parameter Settings.

Besides, please create the records of recipe by Recipe Records Object, please refer to

User Manual Chapter 24- Recipe Editor for more information.

351

Objects

How to monitor or modify Recipe Records?

To watch / Add / Delete the displayed records, a register can be set for inputting a specific value. Create 4 Numeric Input Objects first, address: Selection, Count,

Command, and Result.

[Selection]

The current selection of record, numbered from zero. If choose the first record, the value of

Selection will show “0”, and so on. As shown the record shaded pink will display “1” in Selection.

[Count]

The number of records in current Recipe. As shown, there are 5 records, therefore displays “5” in count.

[Command]

Enter certain value will send command to the selected record.

Enter “1”, Add a new Recipe Record to the last row.

Enter “2”, Update the selected Recipe Record.

Enter “3”, Delete the selected Recipe Record.

[Result]

View the result of executing commands.

Display “1”, Command successfully executed.

Display “2”, The selected Record does not exist.

Display “4”, Unknown command.

Display “8”, Records reach limit (10000 records), no new records can be added.

352

Shape Library and Picture Library

Chapter 14 Shape Library and Picture Library

EasyBuilder Pro provides Shape Library and Picture Library features to add visual effects on objects. Each Shape and Picture includes up to 256 states. This chapter expatiates on how to create Shape Library and Picture Library.

For usage of shape and picture library, please refer to “Chapter 9 Object General

Properties”.

14.1 Creating Shape Library

A shape is a graph composed of lines, rectangles, and circles. A complete Shape can possess more than one state, and each state can include two parts: frame and inner.

See the illustration below:

The frame and inner of a shape can be used separately or together by an object. Click

[Call up Shape Library], and the [Shape Library] dialogue appears as below:

353

Shape Library and Picture Library

Setting

Library

State

Select Lib.

Description

Shape Libraries which have been added into the current project.

Select the library source of a Shape from the list.

Select the state to be displayed by current Shape. If the selected

Shape isn’t displayed, it means that the Shape does not exist or the state of the Shape isn’t defined.

Click [Select Lib.], and the following dialog appears for users to select the file path of the Shape Library to be added.

By previewing the content of the library right side of the window, users can select suitable library.

354

Shape Library and Picture Library

New Lib. Click the button to add a new Shape Library.

Unattach Lib. Click the button to delete the Shape Library in [Library] from current project.

Delete All

States

Delete Cur.

State

Rename

Delete all states of the selected Shape.

Delete current state of the selected Shape.

Rename the selected Shape.

355

Shape Library and Picture Library

Place Export the Shape to be placed to current window.

The following shows how to create a new Shape Library and add a Shape with two states to it.

Step 1

Click [New Lib.] and input the name of the new Shape Library.

A new Shape Library “TEST” will be added to the [Shape Library] dialogue. At this moment, no Shape is in the library.

356

Shape Library and Picture Library

Step 2

Add a state to the selected Shape. First, use the drawing tools to draw a graph in the window and select the graph to be added to the Shape Library.

Chick the [Save to Shape Library] button in toolbar and the following dialogue appears.

Setting

Shape library

Description

Shape no.

State

Description

Select the Shape Library for the graph to be added to. In this example, “TEST” library is selected.

The name of the Shape.

The number in Shape Library current graph will be added in.

Select the state of the Shape which this graph represents. In this case the state is set “0”. EasyBuilder Pro provides 256 states for

357

Frame

Inner

Shape Library and Picture Library each Shape.

If

[Frame] is selected, the graph will become a frame of the

Shape.

If [Inner] is selected, the graph will become an inner part of the

Shape.

This part shows the current status of the shape, at this moment shape [no. 0] in [state 0] in library “Test” is with undefined frame and inner.

After clicking [OK], the graph will be added to Shape Library. Illustration below shows that Shape [No.0] in library “Test” has only one state, [state0], and is defined as a frame.

Step 3

Likewise, create another Shape state by the same process as in Step 2, but this new graph has to be defined as [state 1]:

358

Shape Library and Picture Library

A complete Shape with two states is created. See the following picture.

359

Shape Library and Picture Library

14.2 Creating Picture Library

Click the [Call up Picture Library] button in toolbar, and the [Picture Library] dialogue appears.

Setting

Library

State

Select Lib.

Description

Picture Libraries which have been added into the current project.

Select the library source of a Picture from the list.

Select the state that current graph represents. If the selected

Picture isn’t displayed, it means that the Picture does not exist or the state of the Picture isn’t defined.

Click [Select Lib. ...] and the following dialog appears for users to select the file path of the Picture Library to be added.

By previewing the content of the library right side of the window, users can select suitable library.

360

Shape Library and Picture Library

New Lib.

Click the button to add a new Picture Library.

Unattach Lib.

Click the button to delete the Picture Library in [Library] from the current project.

Delete All States

Delete all states of the selected Picture.

Delete Cur. State

Delete current state of the selected Picture.

Rename

Rename the selected Picture.

Insert Before

Add a new state before the current state.

361

Insert After

Shape Library and Picture Library

Add a new state after the current state.

Import Picture

Add a new picture to the Picture Library.

Modify Picture

Export

Modify the selected picture.

Export the selected picture to the appointed place. As shown below, users can get the original picture.

Note: The compatible picture format are *.bmp, *.jpg, *.gif, *.dpd, and *.png. When adding a GIF picture in Picture Library, if this picture file is animated, the number of times to play this animation can be set by users as below.

362

Shape Library and Picture Library

The example below shows how to create a new Picture Library and add a Picture with two states into it.

Step 1

Click [New Lib.] and input the name of the new Picture Library.

363

Shape Library and Picture Library

A new Picture Library “TEST” will be added to the [Picture Library] dialogue. At this moment, there is no Picture in the library.

Step 2

Prepare the pictures to be added; suppose the two graphs below are used to represent state 0 and state 1 respectively.

Click [Import Picture] and a dialogue appears as below. Set [Picture no.] and

[Picture name] for it, and then click [Next].

Step 3

When the dialogue below is shown, select the source of picture for state 0, and select the correct transparent color. In the example below, the blue color RGB (0, 0, 255) is a transparent color. After the settings of the state 0 are completed, click [Next] button to continue the settings of the other state.

364

Shape Library and Picture Library

Before choosing transparent color, check [Transparent] box first and then left click on location-to-be of the graph. At this time, EasyBuilder Pro will automatically display RGB value of the transparent color. Take above as an example, the actual shape shown as below:

Step 4

Likewise, select the source of a picture for state 1 and select the correct transparent color for it. After the settings are completed, click the [Finish] button.

365

Shape Library and Picture Library

Below shows the complete picture created. A new picture “F Yellow” can be found in the

[Picture Library] dialogue. From the information we know the picture is in the format of bitmap and with two states.

366

Label Library and Multi-Language Usage

Chapter 15 Label Library and Multi-Language Usage

Design the content of

Label Library.

15.1 Introduction

Select suitable label when text is needed.

The system in operation will display the corresponding text to the language in use according to the settings. EasyBuilder Pro supports 8 different languages simultaneously.

Click [Label Library Manager]

[State no.]

Indicates the current state.

Each Label has maximum of 256 states (state no.

0~255). The

State no. is determined by

[Language no.] selected. If using

1~3 languages, the maximum state no. is 256. If using more than 4 languages, divide

768 by language number to get the max. state number.

EX number of languages is 24, 768/24=32 (states)

Add a new

Label.

Modify the content of selected

Label.

UNICODE is not supported when importing and exporting EXCEL file.

Save all current

Labels in *.lbl format.

Export the current Label

Library in *.csv or *.xls formats to specified location.

Load existing

*.lbl file to

Label Library.

Import a

Label Library in *.csv or

*.xls formats to the current project *.mtp.

367

Label Library and Multi-Language Usage

15.2 Building Label Library

1. Open [Label Tag Library] -> [New]

[Label name]

User can specify the name of the Label.

[No. of states]

The number of states can be shown by this Label.

2. Click [OK] a new

Label “Pump

Alarm” with 2 states will be added to the

Label Library, select it and click

[Settings].

3. Set up the corresponding language contents.

368

Label Library and Multi-Language Usage

15.3 Setting Label Font

[Label Tag Library] / [Font] see the languages the current Label contains and set the font. Different languages can use different font.

[Font] When using a Label to show different languages, different fonts can be selected for each language.

[Comment]

The memo for each font.

369

Label Library and Multi-Language Usage

15.4 Using Label Library

When there are already some defined labels in Label Library, users can find those Labels in [Label tag] by selecting [Use label library] in the object’s

[Label] tab.

When

[Use label library] is selected, [Content] field shows the content of selected Label Tag and the settings of

[Font] are also included in the Label

Library. Please note that languages 2 ~ 24 can only set the Font

[Size], other settings for example:

[Color], [Align], [Blink] etc. will follow the settings of language 1.

370

Label Library and Multi-Language Usage

15.5 Settings of Multi-Language (System Register LW-9134)

When users would like to have the object’s text to show multi-language, except for using Label Library, the system reserved register [LW-9134]: language mode can be used. The value of [LW-9134] can be set from 0 to 7. Different data of [LW-9134] corresponds to different languages. Up to 24 languages can be set in EasyBuilder Pro, and 8 (max.) of them can be displayed on HMI. The way of using [LW-9134] will differ if the languages are not all chosen when compiling and downloading the project.

If user defines 5 languages

When compiling if only languages 1, 3, 5 are chosen

For [LW-9134] the corresponding values are:

1

English

2

Traditional Chinese

0

3

Simplified Chinese

4

French

5

Korean

1

2

How to use multi-language:

1. Create a “Text” object and tick

[Use

Label Library].

2. Create a

“Numeric Input” and use

System Tag [LW-9134].

371

Label Library and Multi-Language Usage

When compiling, tick the defined and needed languages.

The simulation is shown below, if we change the value of [LW-9134], the content of the “Text” object will be changed.

372

Label Library and Multi-Language Usage

A Maximum of 8 languages can be downloaded to HMI at the same time.

Please confirm your internet connection before downloading the demo project.

373

Alarm

Address Tag Library

Chapter 16 Address Tag Library

16.1 Creating Address Tag Library

Users are generally recommended to define commonly-used addresses in the address tag library when start to build a project. It not only avoids inputting addresses repeatedly but also expresses the function of an address more clearly.

Display

User-defined address tags

Display

System-reserved address tags

To create a new address tag,

please see next page:

Save all current address tags as

*.tgl file.

Load existing

*.tgl file to

Address Tag

Library.

Export current

Address Tag

Library to the appointed space in

*.csv format.

Import the saved *.csv file of

Address

Tag Library to current project.

Export current

Address Tag

Library to the appointed space in

*.xls format.

Import the saved *.xls file of Address Tag

Library to current project.

Modify the selected address tag.

374

Address Tag Library

Click [New]

Name of the address tag

Selected from

[Device list]

The type of address; [bit]/

[word] types available

The device type; the available types are related to

[PLC name] &

[Address type]

Address of the

Tag

Click

[OK]

A newly added tag will be found in the [Customized] library.

375

Address Tag Library

16.2 Using Address Tag Library

1. Define Address Tag Library

2. Create an object, select

[General] / [PLC name]

3. Click [Setting]

4. Tick [User-defined tag]

5. From [Device type] select the defined tag.

6. Upon completion, the window tree will show the address tag name used for the object.

376

Transferring Recipe Data

Chapter 17 Transferring Recipe Data

Recipe Data refers to data stored at RW and RW_A addresses. The way of reading and writing Recipe Data is nothing different from operating a word register. The difference is that Recipe Data is stored in flash memory, when restarting HMI, the latest data records in RW and RW_A are kept the same.

The size of Recipe Data in RW is 512K words, and RW_A is 64K words. Users can update Recipe Data with SD Card, USB disk, USB cable or Ethernet and use this data to update data in PLC. Recipe Data can also be uploaded to the designated address; furthermore, PLC data can be saved in recipe memory.

The following explains the ways of operating Recipe Data.

377

Transferring Recipe Data

17.1 Updating Recipe Data with Ethernet or USB cable

1. Open Utility Manager and click [Download].

2. Select [RW] and [RW_A] and designate the directory of the source file.

3. After downloading, restart HMI, RW and RW_A will be updated.

Select the source file directory.

Tick

[Reboot HMI

after download] instead of rebooting

HMI manually.

When [Reset recipe] is selected, before start downloading, EasyBuilder Pro will set all the data of [RW] and [RW_A] to “0” first.

378

Transferring Recipe Data

17.2 Updating Recipe Data with CF/SD Card or USB Disk

1. Open Utility Manager and click

[Build Download Data for CF/SD Card or

USB Disk].

2. Insert SD card or USB disk into PC

3. Click [Browse] to designate the file path.

4. Click [Build], EasyBuilder Pro will then build the sources into SD card or

USB disk.

Select the source file directory.

■ When download data is successfully built, two folders can be found: history and emt3000. emt3000 is for storing project files;

history is for storing Recipe Data and Data Sampling / Event Log records.

379

Transferring Recipe Data

17.3 Transferring Recipe Data

Use [Data Transfer (Trigger-based) object] to transfer Recipe Data to the appointed address, or save the data of the designated address to [RW] and

[RW_A].

The starting address of the data is to be transferred from.

The starting address of the data is to be transferred to.

The number of words of the data from Source to

Destination.

17.4 Saving Recipe Data Automatically

In order to prolong HMI flash memory life span, EasyBuilder Pro will save

Recipe Data automatically every minute to HMI. To avoid losing data when switching HMI off during the interval between saving operations, system register [LB-9029: Save all recipe data to machine (set ON)] is provided.

Sending ON signal to [LB-9029] will make EasyBuilder Pro save Recipe Data once. Sending ON signal to [LB-9028: Reset all recipe data (set ON)],

EasyBuilder Pro will clear all Recipe Data and return to “0”.

380

Macro Reference

Chapter 18 Macro Reference

Macros provide the additional functionality your application may need. Macros are automated sequences of commands that are executed at run-time. Macros allow you to perform tasks such as complex scaling operations, string handling, and user interactions with your projects. This chapter describes syntax, usage, and programming methods of macro commands.

18.1 Instructions to the Macro Editor

1. Macro editor provides the following new functions: a.

displaying line number b.

Undo / Redo c.

Cut / Copy / Paste d.

Select All e.

Toggle Bookmark / Previous Bookmark / Next Bookmark / Clear All Bookmarks f.

Toggle All Outlining g.

Security -> Use execution condition h.

Periodical execution i.

Execute one time when HMI starts

The instructions below show you how to use these new functions.

381

Macro Reference

2.

Open the macro editor; you’ll see the line numbers displayed on the left-hand side of the edit area. edit area

3. Right click on the edit area to open the pop-up menu as shown below:

382

Macro Reference

The disabled items are colored grey, which indicates that it is not possible to use that function in the current status of the editor. For example, you should mark a selected area to enable the copy function, otherwise it will be disabled.

Accelerators are supported as described in the menu.

4. Above the edit area locates the toolbar. It provides “Undo”, “Redo”, “Cut”, “Copy”,

“Paste”, “Toggle Bookmark”, “Next Bookmark”, “Previous Bookmark” and “Clear All

Bookmarks” buttons for instant use.

5. Modifications made to the editor will enable the undo function. Redo function will be enabled after the undo action is taken. To perform the undo/redo action, right click to select the item or use the accelerator (Undo: Ctrl+Z, Redo: Ctrl+Y).

Undo

Undo

383

Macro Reference

Redo

Redo

6. Select a word in the editor to enable the cut and copy function. After cut or copy is performed, the paste function is enabled.

384

Macro Reference

7. Use “Select All” to include all the content in the edit area.

8. If the macro code goes very long, for easier reading, bookmarks are provided. The illustration below shows how it works. a.

Move your cursor to the position in the edit area where to insert a bookmark.

Right click, select “Toggle Bookmark”. There will be a blue little square that represents a bookmark on the left side of edit area.

385

Macro Reference b.

If there’s already a bookmark where the cursor is placed, select “Toggle

Bookmark” to close it, otherwise to open it. c.

Right click and select “Next Bookmark”, the cursor will move to where the next bookmark locates. Selecting” Previous Bookmark” will move the cursor to the previous bookmark.

Next Bookmark

Next Bookmark

Next Bookmark

d.

Selecting “Clear All Bookmarks” will close all bookmarks.

9. Macro editor provides macro code outlining function, for easier viewing. This function is to hide macro codes that belong to same block, and display them with an icon.

There will be a tree diagram on the left side of edit area. Users can click to hide the block or to open as shown below:

386

Macro Reference

Press to outline for-next

Press to outline if-then block

10. Right click to select “Toggle All Outlining” to open all macro code blocks.

387

Macro Reference

11. Sometimes the outlining might be incorrect since that the keywords are misjudged. For example:

To solve this problem,right click to select “Update All Outlining” to retrieve correct outlining.

12. The statements enclosed in the following keywords are called a “block” of the macro code: a.

Function block: sub – end sub b.

Reiterative statements: i. for – next ii. while – wend c.

Logical statements: i. if – end if d.

Selective statements: select case – end select

388

Macro Reference

13 When checking “Periodical execution”, this Macro will be triggered periodically.

14 Select Security -> Use execution condition -> Settings to enter Security Settings: a. Disable when Bit is ON: When Bit is ON, this Macro is disabled. b. Disable when Bit is OFF: When Bit is OFF, this Macro is disabled.

15 Select “Execute one time when HMI starts”, this Macro will be executed once when

HMI starts up.

389

Macro Reference

18.2 Macro Construction

A Macro is made up of statements. The statements contain constants, variables and operations. The statements are put in a specific order to create the desired output.

A Macro is constructed in the following fashion:

Global Variable Declaration -----------------------------------Optional

Sub Function Block Declarations -----------------------------------Optional

Local Variable Declarations

End Sub

macro_command main() ------------------------------------Required

Local Variable Declarations

[Statements]

end macro_command ------------------------------------Required

Macro must have one and only one main function which is the execution start point of macro. The format is:

macro_command Function_Name()

end macro_command

Local variables are used within the main macro function or in a defined function block. Its value remains valid only within the specific block.

Global variables are declared before any function blocks and are valid for all functions in the macro. When local variables and global variables have the same declaration of name, only the local variables are valid.

The example below is a simple Macro which includes a variable declaration and a function call. macro_command main()

short pressure = 10 // local variable declaration

SetData(pressure, "Allen-Bradley DF1", N7, 0, 1) // function calling end macro_command

390

Macro Reference

18.3 Syntax

18.3.1 Constants and Variables

18.3.1.1Constants

Constants are fixed values and can be written directly into statements. The format is as below:

Constant Type

Decimal integer

Hexadecimal

ASCII

Note

Must begin with 0x

String must be enclosed in single quotes

Example

345, -234, 0, 23456

0x3b, 0xffff, 0x237

‘a’, ‘data’, ‘name’

Boolean

Example of some statements using constants: macro_command main() short A, B // A and B are variables

A = 1234

B = 0x12 // 1234 and 0x12 are constants true, false end macro_command

18.3.1.2 Variables

Variables are names that represent information. The information can be changed as the variable is modified by statements.

Naming Rules for Variables

1. A variable name must start with an alphabet.

2. Variable names longer than 32 characters are not allowed.

3. Reserved words cannot be used as Variable names.

There are 8 different Variable types, 5 for signed data types and 3 for unsigned data types:

391

Macro Reference

Variable Type

bool

Char short

Int float unsigned char unsigned short

Description

1 bit (discrete)

8 bits (byte)

16 bits (word)

32 bits (double word)

32 bits (double word)

8 bits (byte)

16 bits (word)

Range

0, 1

+127~-128

+32767~-32768

+2147483647~-2147483648

0 to 255

0 to 65535 unsigned int 32 bits (double word) 0 to 4,294,967,295

Declaring Variables

Variables must be declared before being used. To declare a variable, specify the type before the variable name.

Example: int a short b, switch float pressure unsigned short c

Declaring Arrays

Macros support one-dimensional arrays (zero-based index). To declare an array of variables, specify the type and the variable name followed by the number of variables in the array enclosed in brackets “[]”. Arrays are 1 to 4096 variables in length. (Macros only support up to 4096 variables per macro).

Example: int a[10] short b[20], switch[30] float pressure[15]

Minimum of array index is 0 and maximum of array index is (array size – 1).

Example: char data 100] // array size is 100 where: minimum of array index is 0 and maximum of array index is 99 ( 100 – 1)

392

Macro Reference

Variable and Array Initialization

There are two ways variables can be initialized:

1. By statement using the assignment operator (=)

Example: int a float b[3] a = 10 b[0] = 1

2. During declaration char a = ‘5’, b = 9

The declaration of arrays is a special case. The entire array can be initialized during declaration by enclosing comma separated values inside curly brackets “{}”.

Example: float data[4] = {11, 22, 33, 44} // now data[0] is 11, data[1] is 22….

18.3.2 Operators

Operations are used to designate how data is to be manipulated. In each statement, the operator on the left is set to the conditions on the right.

Operator

=

Description

Assignment operator

Example

pressure = 10

*

/

+

-

Arithmetic Operators Description

Addition

Subtraction

Multiplication

Division

%

Modulo division (return remainder)

Example

A = B + C

A = B – C

A = B * C

A = B / C

A = B % 5

393

Macro Reference

Comparison

Operators

<

<=

>

>=

==

<>

Description

Less than

Less than or equal to

Greater than

Greater than or equal to

Equal to

Not equal to

Example

if A < 10 then B = 5 if A <= 10 then B = 5 if A > 10 then B = 5 if A >= 10 then B = 5 if A == 10 then B = 5 if A <> 10 then B = 5

Logic Operators

And

Or

Xor

Not

Description

Logical AND

Logical OR

Logical Exclusive OR

Logical NOT

Example

if A < 10 and B > 5 then C = 10 if A >= 10 or B > 5 then C = 10 if A xor 256 then B = 5 if not A then B = 5

Shift and bitwise operators are used to manipulate bits within char, short, and int variable types with both signed and unsigned. The priority of these operators is from left to right within the statement.

Shift Operators

<<

Example

A = B << 8

>>

Description

Shifts the bits in a bitset to the left a specified number of positions

Shifts the bits in a bitset to the right a specified number of positions

A = B >> 8

|

^

~

Bitwise Operators

&

Description

Bitwise AND

Bitwise OR

Bitwise XOR

One’s complement

Example

A = B & 0xf

A = B | C

A = B ^ C

A = ~B

394

Macro Reference

Priority of All Operators

The overall priority of all operations from highest to lowest is as follows:

Operations within parenthesis are carried out first

Arithmetic operations

Shift and Bitwise operations

Comparison operations

Logic operations

Assignment

Reserved Keywords

The following keywords are reserved for Macro use. They cannot be used for variable, array, or function names.

+, -, *, /, %, >=, >, <=, <, <>, ==, and, or, xor, not, <<, >>,=, &, |, ^, ~ exit, macro_command, for, to, down, step, next, return, bool, short, int, char, float, void, if, then, else, break, continue, set, sub, end, while, wend, true, false

SQRT, CUBERT, LOG, LOG10, SIN, COS, TAN, COT, SEC, CSC, ASIN, ACOS, ATAN,

BIN2BCD, BCD2BIN, DEC2ASCII, FLOAT2ASCII, HEX2ASCII, ASCII2DEC,

ASCII2FLOAT, ASCII2HEX, FILL, RAND, DELAY, SWAPB, SWAPW, LOBYTE, HIBYTE,

LOWORD, HIWORD, GETBIT, SETBITON, SETBITOFF, INVBIT, ADDSUM, XORSUM,

CRC, INPORT, OUTPORT, POW, GetError, GetData, GetDataEx, SetData, SetDataEx,

SetRTS, GetCTS, Beep, SYNC_TRIG_MACRO, ASYNC_TRIG_MACRO, TRACE,

FindDataSamplingDate, FindDataSamplingIndex, FindEventLogDate, FindEventLogIndex

StringGet, StringGetEx, StringSet, StringSetEx, StringCopy, StringMid, StringDecAsc2Bin,

StringBin2DecAsc, StringDecAsc2Float, StringFloat2DecAsc, StringHexAsc2Bin,

StringBin2HexAsc, StringLength, StringCat, StringCompare, StringCompareNoCase,

StringFind, StringReverseFind, StringFindOneOf, StringIncluding, StringExcluding,

StringToUpper, StringToLower, StringToReverse, StringTrimLeft, StringTrimRight,

StringInsert

395

Macro Reference

18.4 Statement

18.4.1 Definition Statement

This covers the declaration of variables and arrays. The formal construction is as follows: type name where define the type of name

Example: int A //define a variable A as an integer type name[constant] where define the type of array name

Example: int B[10] where define a variable B as a one-dimensional array of size 10

18.4.2 Assignment Statement

Assignment statements use the assignment operator to move data from the expression on the right side of the operator to the variable on the left side. An expression is the combination of variables, constants and operators to yield a value.

Variable = Expression

Example

A = 2 where a variable A is assigned to 2

18.4.3 Logical Statements

Logical statements perform actions depending on the condition of a Boolean expression.

The syntax is as follows:

396

Macro Reference

Single-Line Format

if <Condition> then

[Statements]

else

[Statements]

end if

Example: if a == 2 then b = 1 else b = 2 end if

Block Format

If <Condition> then

[Statements]

else if <Condition – n> then

[Statements]

else

[Statements]

end if

Example: if a == 2 then b = 1 else if a == 3 then b = 2 else b = 3 end if

397

Macro Reference

Syntax description:

if

Must be used to begin the statement

<Condition>

Required. This is the controlling statement. It is FALSE when the

<Condition> evaluates to 0 and TRUE when it evaluates to non- zero.

then

Must precede the statements to execute if the <Condition> evaluates to

TRUE.

[Statements] It is optional in block format but necessary in single-line format without else. The statement will be executed when the <Condition> is TRUE.

else if

Optional. The else if statement will be executed when the relative

<Condition-n> is TRUE.

<Condition-n> Optional. see <Condition>

else

Optional. The else statement will be executed when <Condition> and

<Condition-n> are both FALSE.

end if

Must be used to end an if-then statement.

18.4.4 Selective Statements

The select-case construction can be used to perform selective group of actions depending on the value of the given variable. The actions under the matched case are performed until a break command is read. The syntax is as follows.

Default case free Format

Select Case [variable]

Case [value]

[Statements]

break end Select

Example:

Select Case A

Case 1 b=1 break end Select

398

Macro Reference

Default case Format

Select Case [variable]

Case [value]

[Statements]

break

Case else

[Statements]

break end Select

Example:

Select Case A

Case 1 b=1 break

Case else b=0 break end Select

Multiple cases in the same block

Select Case [variable]

Case [value1]

[Statements]

Case [value2]

[Statements]

break end Select

Example:

Select Case A

Case 1

Case 2 b=2

Case 3 b=3

399

Macro Reference break end Select

Syntax description:

Select Case

Must be used to begin the statement

[variable]

Required. The value of this variable will be compared to the value of each case.

Case else

Optional. It represents the default case. If none of the cases above are matched, the statements under default case will be executed. When a default case is absent, it will skip directly to the end of the select-case statements if there is no matched case.

break end Select

Optional. The statements under the matched case will be executed until the break command is reached. If a break command is absent, it simply keeps on executing next statement until the end command is reached.

Indicates the end of the select-case statements

18.4.5 Reiterative Statements

Reiterative statements control loops and repetitive tasks depending on condition. There are two types of reiterative statements.

18.4.5.1 for-next Statements

The for-next construction is for stepping through a fixed number of iterations. A variable is used as a counter to track progress and test for ending conditions. Use this for fixed execution counts. The syntax is as follows:

for [Counter] = <StartValue> to <EndValue> [step <StepValue>]

[Statements]

next [Counter] or

for [Counter] = <StartValue> down <EndValue> [step <StepValue>]

[Statements]

next [Counter]

400

Macro Reference

Example: for a = 0 to 10 step 2 b = a next a

Syntax description:

for

[Counter]

Must be used to begin the statement

Required. This is the controlling statement. The result of evaluating the variable is used as a test of comparison.

<StartValue> Required. The initial value of [Counter]

to/down

Required. This determines if the <step> increments or decrements the

<Counter>.

“to” increments <Counter> by <StepValue>.

“down” decrements <Counter> by <StepValue>.

<EndValue> Required. The test point. If the <Counter> is greater than this value, the macro exits the loop.

step

Optional. Specifies that a <StepValue> other than one is to be used.

[StepValue] Optional. The increment/decrement step of <Counter>. It can be omitted when the value is 1 If [step <StepValue>] are omitted the step value defaults to 1.

[Statements] Optional. Statements to execute when the evaluation is TRUE. “for-next” loops may be nested.

next

[Counter]

Required.

Optional. This is used when nesting for-next loops.

18.4.5.2 while-wend Statements

The while-wend construction is for stepping through an unknown number of iterations. A variable is used to test for ending conditions. When the condition is TRUE, the statements are executed repetitively until the condition becomes FALSE. The syntax is as follows.

while <Condition>

[Statements]

wend

401

Macro Reference

Example: while a < 10 a = a + 10 wend

Syntax description:

while continue

Must be used to begin the statement

Required. This is the controlling statement. When it is TRUE, the loop begins execution. When it is FALSE, the loop terminates.

return [value] Statements to execute when the evaluation is TRUE.

wend

Indicates the end of the while-end statements

18.4.5.3 Other Control Commands break

Used in for-next and while-wend. It skips immediately to the end of the reiterative statement.

continue return

Used in for-next and while-wend. It ends the current iteration of a loop and starts the next one.

The return command inside the main block can force the macro to stop anywhere. It skips immediately to the end of the main block.

402

Macro Reference

18.5 Function Blocks

Function blocks are useful for reducing repetitive codes. It must be defined before use and supports any variable and statement type. A function block is called by putting its name followed by parameters, in parenthesis, in the Main Macro Function. After the function block is executed, it returns the value to the Main Function where it is used as an assignment or condition. A return type is not necessary in definition of function, which means that a function block is not always necessary to return a value. The parameters can also be absent in definition of function while the function has no need to take any parameters from the Main Function. The syntax is as follows:

Definition of function with return type:

sub type <name> [(parameters)]

Local variable declarations

[Statements]

[ return [value]]

end sub

Example: sub int Add(int x, int y)

int result result = x +y return result

end sub macro_command main() int a = 10, b = 20, sum sum = Add(a, b) end macro_command or: sub int Add()

int result, x=10, y=20 result = x +y return result

end sub

403

Macro Reference macro_command main() int sum sum = Add() end macro_command

Definition of function without return type:

sub <name> [(parameters)]

Local variable declarations

[Statements]

end sub

Example: sub Add(int x, int y)

int result result = x +y

end sub macro_command main() int a = 10, b = 20

Add(a, b) end macro_command or: sub Add()

int result, x=10, y=20 result = x +y

end sub

404

Macro Reference macro_command main()

Add() end macro_command

Syntax description:

sub type

Must be used to begin the function block

Optional. This is the data type of value that the function returns. A function block is not always necessary to return a value.

(parameters)

Optional. The parameters hold values that are passed to the function by the Main Macro. The passed parameters must have their type declared in the parameter field and assigned a variable name.

For example: sub int MyFunction(int x, int y). x and y would be integers passed to the function by the Main Macro. This function is called by a statement that looks similar to this: ret = MyFunction(456, pressure) where “pressure” must be integer according to the definition of function.

Notice that the calling statement can pass hard coded values or variables to the function. After this function is executed, an integer values is return to ‘ret’.

Local variable declaration

Variables that are used in the function block must be declared first.

This is in addition to passed parameters. In the above example x and y are variables that the function can used. Global variables are also available for use in function block.

[Statements]

Statements to execute

[return [value]] Optional. Used to return a value to the calling statement. The value can be a constant or a variable. Return also ends function block execution. A function block is not always necessary to return a value, but, when the return type is defined in the beginning of the definition of function, the return command is needed.

end sub

Must be used to end a function block.

405

Macro Reference

18.6 Build-In Function Block

EasyBuilder Pro has some build-in functions for retrieving and transferring data to the

PLC, data management and mathematical functions.

18.6.1 Mathematical Functions

Name

Syntax

SQRT

SQRT(source, result)

Description Calculate the square root of source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Source must be a nonnegative value.

Example

macro_command main() float source, result

SQRT(15, result) source = 9.0

SQRT(source, result)// result is 3.0 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

CUBERT

CUBERT (source, result)

Description Calculate the cube root of source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Source must be a nonnegative value.

Example

macro_command main() float source, result

CUBERT (27, result) // result is 3.0 source = 27.0

CUBERT(source, result)// result is 3.0 end macro_command

406

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

POW

POW (source1, source2, result)

Description Calculate source1 raised to the power of source2.

Source1 and source2 can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Source1 and source2 must be a nonnegative value.

Example

macro_command main() float y, result y = 0.5

POW (25, y, result) // result = 5 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

SIN

SIN(source, result)

Description Calculate the sine of source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() float source, result

SIN(90, result)// result is 1 source = 30

SIN(source, result)// result is 0.5 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

COS

COS(source, result)

Description Calculate the cosine of source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() float source, result

407

Macro Reference

COS(90, result)// result is 0 source = 60

GetData(source, "Local HMI", LW, 0, 1)

COS(source, result)// result is 0.5 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

TAN

TAN(source, result)

Description Calculate the tangent of source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() float source, result

TAN(45, result)// result is 1 source = 60

TAN(source, result)// result is 1.732 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

COT

COT(source, result)

Description Calculate the cotangent of source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() float source, result

COT(45, result)// result is 1 source = 60

COT(source, result)// result is 0.5774 end macro_command

408

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

SEC

SEC(source, result)

Description Calculate the secant of source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() float source, result

SEC(45, result)// result is 1.414 source = 60

SEC(source, result)// if source is 60, result is 2 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

CSC

CSC(source, result)

Description Calculate the cosecant of source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() float source, result

CSC(45, result)// result is 1.414 source = 30

CSC(source, result)// result is 2 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

ASIN

ASIN(source, result)

Description Calculate the hyperbolic sine of source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() float source, result

409

Macro Reference

ASIN(0.8660, result)// result is 60 source = 0.5

ASIN(source, result)// result is 30 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

ACOS

ACOS(source, result)

Description Calculate the hyperbolic cosine of source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() float source, result

ACOS(0.8660, result)// result is 30 source = 0.5

ACOS(source, result)// result is 60 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

ATAN

ATAN(source, result)

Description Calculate the hyperbolic tangent of source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() float source, result

ATAN(1, result)// result is 45 source = 1.732

ATAN(source, result)// result is 60 end macro_command

410

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

LOG

LOG (source, result)

Description Calculates the natural logarithm of a number.

Source can be either a variable or a constant.

Result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() float source = 100, result

LOG (source, result)// result is approximately 4.6052 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

LOG10

LOG10 (source, result)

Description Calculates the base-10 logarithm of a number.

Source can be either a variable or a constant.

Result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() float source = 100, result

LOG10 (source, result)// result is 2 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

RAND

RAND(result)

Description Calculates a random integer saved into result.

Result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() short result

RAND (result)// result is not a fixed value when executes macro every time end macro_command

411

Macro Reference

18.6.2 Data Transformation

Name

Syntax

BIN2BCD

BIN2BCD(source, result)

Description Transforms a binary-type value (source) into a BCD-type value (result).

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() short source, result

BIN2BCD(1234, result)// result is 0x1234 source = 5678

BIN2BCD(source, result)// result is 0x5678 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

BCD2BIN

BCD2BIN (source, result)

Description Transforms a BCD-type value (source) into a binary-type value (result).

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() short source, result

BCD2BIN(0x1234, result)// result is 1234 source = 0x5678

BCD2BIN(source, result)// result is 5678 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

DEC2ASCII

DEC2ASCII(source, result[start], len)

412

Macro Reference

Description Transforms a decimal value (source) into ASCII string saved to an array

(result). len represents the length of the string and the unit of length depends on result’s type., i.e. if result’s type is “char” (the size is byte), the length of the string is (byte * len). If result’s type is “short” (the size is word), the length of the string is (word * len), and so on.

The first character is put into result[start], the second character is put into result[start + 1], and the last character is put into result[start + (len -1)].

Example

Source and len can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable. Start must be a constant. macro_command main() short source char result1[4] short result2[4] source = 5678

DEC2ASCII(source, result1[0], 4)

// result1[0] is '5', result1[1] is '6', result1[2] is '7', result1[3] is '8'

// the length of the string (result1) is 4 bytes( = 1 * 4)

DEC2ASCII(source, result2[0], 4)

// result2[0] is '5', result2[1] is '6', result2[2] is '7', result2[3] is '8'

// the length of the string (result2) is 8 bytes( = 2 * 4) end macro_command

Name

HEX2ASCII

Syntax

HEX2ASCII(source, result[start], len)

Description Transforms a hexadecimal value (source) into ASCII string saved to an array (result). len represents the length of the string and the unit of length depends on result’s type., i.e. if result’s type is “char” (the size is byte), the length of the string is (byte * len). If result’s type is “short” (the size is word), the length

Example

of the string is (word * len), and so on. source and len can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable. start must be a constant. macro_command main()

413

Macro Reference short source char result[4] source = 0x5678

HEX2ASCII (source, result[0], 4)

// result[0] is '5', result[1] is '6', result[2] is '7', result[3] is '8' end macro_command

Name

Syntax

FLOAT2ASCII

FLOAT2ASCII (source, result[start], len)

Description Transforms a floating value (source) into ASCII string saved to an array

(result). len represents the length of the string and the unit of length depends on result’s type., i.e. if result’s type is “char” (the size is byte), the length of the string is (byte * len). If result’s type is “short” (the size is word), the length of the string is (word * len), and so on.

Example

Source and len can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable. Start must be a constant. macro_command main() float source char result[4] source = 56.8

FLOAT2ASCII (source, result[0], 4)

// result[0] is '5', result[1] is '6', result[2] is '.', result[3] is '8' end macro_command

Name

Syntax

ASCII2DEC

ASCII2DEC(source[start], result, len)

Description Transforms a string (source) into a decimal value saved to a variable

(result).

The length of the string is len. The first character of the string is source[start].

Source and len can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a

414

Macro Reference

Example

variable. Start must be a constant. macro_command main() char source[4] short result source[0] = '5' source[1] = '6' source[2] = '7' source[3] = '8'

ASCII2DEC(source[0], result, 4) // result is 5678 end macro_command

Name

ASCII2HEX

Syntax

ASCII2HEX (source[start], result, len)

Description Transforms a string (source) into a hexadecimal value saved to a variable

(result).

The length of the string is len. The first character of the string is source[start].

Source and len can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable. Start must be a constant.

Example

macro_command main() char source[4] short result source[0] = '5' source[1] = '6' source[2] = '7' source[3] = '8'

ASCII2HEX (source[0], result, 4) // result is 0x5678 end macro_command

415

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

ASCII2FLOAT

ASCII2FLOAT (source[start], result, len)

Description Transforms a string (source) into a float value saved to a variable (result).

The length of the string is len. The first character of the string is source[start].

Source and len can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable. Start must be a constant.

Example

macro_command main() char source[4] float result source[0] = '5' source[1] = '6' source[2] = '.' source[3] = '8'

ASCII2FLOAT (source[0], result, 4) // result is 56.8 end macro_command

416

Macro Reference

18.6.3 Data Manipulation

Name

Syntax

FILL

FILL(source[start], preset, count)

Description Sets the first count elements of an array (source) to a specified value

(preset). source and start must be a variable, and preset can be a constant or variable.

Example

macro_command main() char result[4] char preset

FILL(result[0], 0x30, 4)

// result[0] is 0x30, result[1] is 0x30, , result[2] is 0x30, , result[3] is 0x30 preset = 0x31

FILL(result[0], preset, 2) // result[0] is 0x31, result[1] is 0x31 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

SWAPB

SWAPB(source, result)

Description Exchanges the high-byte and low-byte data of a 16-bit source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() short source, result

SWAPB(0x5678, result)// result is 0x7856 source = 0x123

SWAPB(source, result)// result is 0x2301 end macro_command

417

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

SWAPW

SWAPW(source, result)

Description Exchanges the high-word and low-word data of a 32-bit source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() int source, result

SWAPW (0x12345678, result)// result is 0x56781234 source = 0x12345

SWAPW (source, result)// result is 0x23450001 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

LOBYTE

LOBYTE(source, result)

Description Retrieves the low byte of a 16-bit source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() short source, result

LOBYTE(0x1234, result)// result is 0x34 source = 0x123

LOBYTE(source, result)// result is 0x23 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

HIBYTE

HIBYTE(source, result)

Description Retrieves the high byte of a 16-bit source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() short source, result

418

Macro Reference

HIBYTE(0x1234, result)// result is 0x12 source = 0x123

HIBYTE(source, result)// result is 0x01 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

LOWORD

LOWORD(source, result)

Description Retrieves the low word of a 32-bit source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() int source, result

LOWORD(0x12345678, result)// result is 0x5678 source = 0x12345

LOWORD(source, result)// result is 0x2345 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

HIWORD

HIWORD(source, result)

Description Retrieves the high word of a 32-bit source into result.

Source can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() int source, result

HIWORD(0x12345678, result)// result is 0x1234 source = 0x12345

HIWORD(source, result)// result is 0x0001 end macro_command

419

Macro Reference

18.6.4 Bit Transformation

Name

Syntax

GETBIT

GETBIT(source, result, bit_pos)

Description Gets the state of designated bit position of a data (source) into result.

Result’s value will be 0 or 1.

Source and bit_pos can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() int source, result short bit_pos

GETBIT(9, result, 3)// result is 1 source = 4 bit_pos = 2

GETBIT(source, result, bit_pos)// result is 1 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

SETBITON

SETBITON(source, result, bit_pos)

Description Changes the state of designated bit position of a data (source) to 1, and put changed data into result.

Source and bit_pos can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() int source, result short bit_pos

SETBITON(1, result, 3)// result is 9 source = 0 bit_pos = 2

SETBITON (source, result, bit_pos)// result is 4 end macro_command

420

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

SETBITOFF

SETBITOFF(source, result, bit_pos)

Description Changes the state of designated bit position of a data (source) to 0, and put in changed data into result.

Source and bit_pos can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() int source, result short bit_pos

SETBITOFF(9, result, 3)// result is 1 source = 4 bit_pos = 2

SETBITOFF(source, result, bit_pos)// result is 0 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

INVBIT

INVBIT(source, result, bit_pos)

Description Inverts the state of designated bit position of a data (source), and put changed data into result.

Source and bit_pos can be a constant or a variable, but result must be a variable.

Example

macro_command main() int source, result short bit_pos

INVBIT(4, result, 1)// result = 6 source = 6 bit_pos = 1

INVBIT(source, result, bit_pos)// result = 4 end macro_command

421

Macro Reference

18.6.5 Communication

Name

Syntax

DELAY

DELAY(time)

Description Suspends the execution of the current macro for at least the specified interval (time). The unit of time is millisecond.

Time can be a constant or a variable.

Example

macro_command main() int time == 500

DELAY(100)// delay 100 ms

DELAY(time)// delay 500 ms end macro_command

Name

Syntax

ADDSUM

ADDSUM(source[start], result, data_count)

Description Adds up the elements of an array (source) from source[start] to source[start + data_count - 1] to generate a checksum.

Puts in the checksum into result. Result must be a variable.

Data_count is the amount of the accumulated elements and can be a constant or a variable.

Example

macro_command main() char data[5] short checksum data[0] = 0x1 data[1] = 0x2 data[2] = 0x3 data[3] = 0x4 data[4] = 0x5

ADDSUM(data[0], checksum, 5)// checksum is 0xf end macro_command

422

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

XORSUM

XORSUM(source[start], result, data_count)

Description Uses an exclusion method to calculate the checksum from source[start] to source[start + data_count - 1].

Puts the checksum into result. Result must be a variable.

Data_count is the amount of the calculated elements of the array and can be a constant or a variable.

Example

macro_command main() char data[5] = {0x1, 0x2, 0x3, 0x4, 0x5} short checksum

XORSUM(data[0], checksum, 5)// checksum is 0x1 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

CRC

CRC(source[start], result, data_count)

Description Calculates 16-bit CRC of the variables from source[start] to source[start + count - 1].

Puts in the 16-bit CRC into result. Result must be a variable.

Data_count is the amount of the calculated elements of the array and can be a constant or a variable.

Example

macro_command main() char data[5] = {0x1, 0x2, 0x3, 0x4, 0x5} short 16bit_CRC

CRC(data[0], 16bit_CRC, 5)// 16bit_CRC is 0xbb2a end macro_command

Name

Syntax

Description

OUTPORT

OUTPORT(source[start], device_name, data_count)

Sends out the specified data from source[start] to source[start + count -1] to

PLC via a COM port or the ethernet.

Device_name is the name of a device defined in the device table and the

423

Macro Reference device must be a “Free Protocol”-type device.

Data_count is the amount of sent data and can be a constant or a variable.

Example

To use an OUTPORT function, a “Free Protocol” device must be created first as follows:

The device is named ”MODBUS RTU Device”. The port attribute depends on the setting of this device. (the current setting is “19200,E, 8, 1”)

Below is an example of executing an action of writing single coil (SET ON) to a MODBUS device. macro_command main() char command[32] short address, checksum

FILL(command[0], 0, 32)// command initialization command[0] = 0x1// station no command[1] = 0x5// function code : Write Single Coil

424

Macro Reference address = 0

HIBYTE(address, command[2])

LOBYTE(address, command[3]) command[4] = 0xff// force bit on command[5] = 0

CRC(command[0], checksum, 6)

LOBYTE(checksum, command[6])

HIBYTE(checksum, command[7])

// send out a “Write Single Coil” command

OUTPORT(command[0], "MODBUS RTU Device", 8) end macro_command

Name

Syntax

INPORT

INPORT(read_data[start], device_name, read_count, return_value)

Description Reads data from a COM port or the ethernet. These data is stored to read_data[start]~ read_data[start + read_count - 1]. device_name is the name of a device defined in the device table and the device must be a “Free Protocol”-type device. read_count is the required amount of reading and can be a constant or a variable.

Example

If the function is used successfully to get sufficient data, return_value is 1, otherwise is 0.

Below is an example of executing an action of reading holding registers of a MODBUS device.

// Read Holding Registers macro_command main() char command[32], response[32] short address, checksum short read_no, return_value, read_data[2]

425

Macro Reference

FILL(command[0], 0, 32)// command initialization

FILL(response[0], 0, 32) command[0] = 0x1// station no command[1] = 0x3// function code : Read Holding Registers address = 0

HIBYTE(address, command[2])

LOBYTE(address, command[3]) read_no = 2// read 2 words (4x_1 and 4x_2)

HIBYTE(read_no, command[4])

LOBYTE(read_no, command[5])

CRC(command[0], checksum, 6)

LOBYTE(checksum, command[6])

HIBYTE(checksum, command[7])

// send out a ‘Read Holding Registers” command

OUTPORT(command[0], "MODBUS RTU Device", 8)

// read responses for a ‘Read Holding Registers” command

INPORT(response[0], "MODBUS RTU Device", 9, return_value) if return_value > 0 then read_data[0] = response[4] + (response[3] << 8)// data in 4x_1 read_data[1] = response[6] + (response[5] << 8)// data in 4x_2

SetData(read_data[0], "Local HMI", LW, 100, 2) end if end macro_comm and

Name

Syntax

INPORT2

INPORT2(response[start], device_name, receive_len, wait_time)

Description Read data from a communication port (COM Port or Ethernet Port). The

426

Macro Reference

Example

data read will be saved in “response”. The description of device_name is the same as OUTPORT. receive_len stores the length of the data recived, this must be a variable. receive_len total length can’t exceed the size of “response”. wait_time (in millisecond) can be a constant or variable. After the data is read, if there's no upcoming data during the designated time interval, the function returns. macro_command main() short wResponse[6], receive_len, wait_time=20

INPORT2(wResponse[0], "Free Protocol", receive_len, wait_time)

// wait_time unit : millisecond if receive_len > 0 then

SetData(wResponse[0], "Local HMI", LW, 0, 6)

// set responses to LW0 end if end macro_comm and

Name

Syntax

GetData

GetData(read_data[start], device_name, device_type, address_offset, data_count) or

GetData(read_data, device_name, device_type, address_offset, 1)

Description Receives data from the PLC. Data is stored into read_data[start]~ read_data[start + data_count - 1].

Data_count is the amount of received data. In general, read_data is an array, but if data_count is 1, read_data can be an array or an ordinary variable. Below are two methods to read one word data from PLC. macro_command main() short read_data_1[2], read_data_2

GetData(read_data_1[0], “FATEK KB Series”, RT, 5, 1)

GetData(read_data_2, “FATEK KB Series”, RT, 5, 1) end macro_command

427

Macro Reference

Device_name is the PLC name enclosed in the double quotation marks (“) and this name has been defined in the device list of system parameters as follows (see FATEK KB Series):

Device_type is the device type and encoding method (binary or BCD) of the PLC data. For example, if device_type is LW_BIN, it means the register is LW and the encoding method is binary. If use BIN encoding method, “_BIN” can be ignored.

If device_type is LW_BCD, it means the register is LW and the encoding method is BCD.

Address_offset is the address offset in the PLC.

For example, GetData(read_data_1[0], “FATEK KB Series”, RT, 5, 1) represents that the address offset is 5.

If address_offset uses the format – “N#AAAAA”, N indicates that PLC’s station number is N. AAAAA represents the address offset. This format is used while multiple PLCs or controllers are connected to a single serial port. For example, GetData(read_data_1[0], “FATEK KB Series”, RT, 2#5,

1) represents that the PLC’s station number is 2. If GetData() uses the default station number defined in the device list as follows, it is not necessary to define station number in address_offset.

428

Macro Reference

Example

The number of registers actually read from depends on both the type of the read_data variable and the value of the number of data_count.

type of

read_data char (8-bit)

data_coun

t

1

actual number of

16-bit register read

1 char (8-bit) bool (8-bit) bool (8-bit) short (16-bit) short (16-bit)

2

1

2

1

2

1

1

1

1

2 int (32-bit) int (32-bit) float (32-bit)

1

2

1

2

4

2 float (32-bit) 2 4

When a GetData() is executed using a 32-bit data type (int or float), the function will automatically convert the data. For example, macro_command main() float f

GetData (f, "MODBUS" , 6 x, 2 , 1 ) // f will contain a floating point value end macro_command macro_command

main() bool a

429

Name

Syntax

Macro Reference bool b[30] short c short d[50] int e int f[10] double g[10]

// get the state of LB2 to the variable a

GetData(a, “Local HMI”, LB, 2, 1)

// get 30 states of LB0 ~ LB29 to the variables b[0] ~ b[29]

GetData(b[0], “Local HMI”, LB, 0, 30)

// get one word from LW2 to the variable c

GetData(c, “Local HMI”, LW, 2, 1)

// get 50 words from LW0 ~ LW49 to the variables d[0] ~ d[49]

GetData(d[0], “Local HMI”, LW, 0, 50)

// get 2 words from LW6 ~ LW7 to the variable e

// note that the type of e is int

GetData(e, “Local HMI”, LW, 6, 1)

// get 20 words (10 integer values) from LW0 ~ LW19 to variables f[0] ~ f[9]

// since each integer value occupies 2 words

GetData(f[0], “Local HMI”, LW, 0, 10)

// get 2 words from LW2 ~ LW3 to the variable f

GetData(f, “Local HMI”, LW, 2, 1) end macro_command

GetDataEx

GetDataEx (read_data[start], device_name, device_type, address_offset, data_count) or

GetDataEx (read_data, device_name, device_type, address_offset, 1)

430

Macro Reference

Description Receives data from the PLC and continue executing next command even if no response from this device.

Descriptions of read_data, device_name, device_type, address_offset and data_count are the same as GetData.

Example

macro_command

main() bool a bool b[30] short c short d[50] int e int f[10] double g[10]

// get the state of LB2 to the variable a

GetDataEx (a, “Local HMI”, LB, 2, 1)

// get 30 states of LB0 ~ LB29 to the variables b[0] ~ b[29]

GetDataEx (b[0], “Local HMI”, LB, 0, 30)

// get one word from LW2 to the variable c

GetDataEx (c, “Local HMI”, LW, 2, 1)

// get 50 words from LW0 ~ LW49 to the variables d[0] ~ d[49]

GetDataEx (d[0], “Local HMI”, LW, 0, 50)

// get 2 words from LW6 ~ LW7 to the variable e

// note that he type of e is int

GetDataEx (e, “Local HMI”, LW, 6, 1)

// get 20 words (10 integer values) from LW0 ~ LW19 to f[0] ~ f[9]

// since each integer value occupies 2 words

GetDataEx (f[0], “Local HMI”, LW, 0, 10)

// get 2 words from LW2 ~ LW3 to the variable f

GetDataEx (f, “Local HMI”, LW, 2, 1) end macro_command

431

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

SetData

SetData(send_data[start], device_name, device_type, address_offset, data_count) or

SetData(send_data, device_name, device_type, address_offset, 1)

Description Send data to the PLC. Data is defined in send_data[start]~ send_data[start

+ data_count - 1]. data_count is the amount of sent data. In general, send_data is an array, but if data_count is 1, send_data can be an array or an ordinary variable.

Below are two methods to send one word data. macro_command main() short send_data_1[2] = { 5, 6}, send_data_2 = 5

SetData(send_data_1[0], “FATEK KB Series”, RT, 5, 1)

SetData(send_data_2, “FATEK KB Series”, RT, 5, 1) end macro_command device_name is the PLC name enclosed in the double quotation marks (“) and this name has been defined in the device list of system parameters. device_type is the device type and encoding method (binary or BCD) of the PLC data. For example, if device_type is LW_BIN, it means the register is LW and the encoding method is binary. If use BIN encoding method,

“_BIN” can be ignored.

If device_type is LW_BCD, it means the register is LW and the encoding method is BCD. address_offset is the address offset in the PLC.

For example, SetData(read_data_1[0], “FATEK KB Series”, RT, 5, 1) represents that the address offset is 5.

If address_offset uses the format – “N#AAAAA”, N indicates that PLC’s station number is N. AAAAA represents the address offset. This format is used while multiple PLCs or controllers are connected to a single serial port. For example, SetData(read_data_1[0], “FATEK KB Series”, RT, 2#5,

1) represents that the PLC’s station number is 2. If SetData () uses the default station number defined in the device list, it is not necessary to define station number in address_offset.

432

Example

Macro Reference

The number of registers actually sends to depends on both the type of the send_data variable and the value of the number of data_count.

type of

read_data char (8-bit)

data_count

1

actual number of

16-bit register send

1 char (8-bit) bool (8-bit) bool (8-bit) short (16-bit) short (16-bit)

2

1

2

1

2

1

1

1

1

2 int (32-bit) int (32-bit) float (32-bit)

1

2

1

2

4

2 float (32-bit) 2 4

When a SetData() is executed using a 32-bit data type (int or float), the function will automatically send int-format or float-format data to the device. For example, macro_command main() float f = 2.6

SetData (f, "MODBUS" , 6 x, 2 , 1 ) // will send a floating point value to the device end macro_command macro_command

main() int i bool a = true bool b[30] short c = false short d[50] int e = 5 int f[10]

433

Name

Syntax

Macro Reference for i = 0 to 29 b[i] = true next i for i = 0 to 49 d[i] = i * 2 next i for i = 0 to 9 f [i] = i * 3 next i

// set the state of LB2

SetData(a, “Local HMI”, LB, 2, 1)

// set the states of LB0 ~ LB29

SetData(b[0], “Local HMI”, LB, 0, 30)

// set the value of LW2

SetData(c, “Local HMI”, LW, 2, 1)

// set the values of LW0 ~ LW49

SetData(d[0], “Local HMI”, LW, 0, 50)

// set the values of LW6 ~ LW7, note that the type of e is int

SetData(e, “Local HMI”, LW, 6, 1)

// set the values of LW0 ~ LW19

// 10 integers equal to 20 words, since each integer value occupies 2 words.

SetData(f[0], “Local HMI”, LW, 0, 10) end macro_command

SetDataEx

SetDataEx (send_data[start], device_name, device_type, address_offset,

434

Macro Reference data_count) or

SetDataEx (send_data, device_name, device_type, address_offset, 1)

Description Send data to the PLC and continue executing next command even if no response from this device.

Descriptions of send_data, device_name, device_type, address_offset and data_count are the same as SetData.

Example macro_command

main() int i bool a = true bool b[30] short c = false short d[50] int e = 5 int f[10] for i = 0 to 29 b[i] = true next i for i = 0 to 49 d[i] = i * 2 next i for i = 0 to 9 f [i] = i * 3 next i

// set the state of LB2

SetDataEx (a, “Local HMI”, LB, 2, 1)

// set the states of LB0 ~ LB29

SetDataEx (b[0], “Local HMI”, LB, 0, 30)

// set the value of LW2

SetDataEx (c, “Local HMI”, LW, 2, 1)

435

Macro Reference

// set the values of LW0 ~ LW49

SetDataEx (d[0], “Local HMI”, LW, 0, 50)

// set the values of LW6 ~ LW7, note that the type of e is int

SetDataEx (e, “Local HMI”, LW, 6, 1)

// set the values of LW0 ~ LW19

// 10 integers equal to 20 words, since each integer value occupies 2 words.

SetDataEx (f[0], “Local HMI”, LW, 0, 10) end macro_command

Name

Syntax

GetError

GetError (err)

Description Get an error code.

Example

macro_command main() short err char byData[10]

GetDataEx(byData[0], “MODBUS RTU”, 4x, 1, 10)// read 10 bytes

// if err is equal to 0, it is successful to execute GetDataEx()

GetErr(err)// save an error code to err end macro_command

Name

Syntax

PURGE

PURGE (com_port)

Description com_port refers to the COM port number which ranges from 1 to 3. It can be either a variable or a constant.

This function is used to clear the input and output buffers associated with the COM port.

Example

macro_command main()

436

Macro Reference int com_port=3

PURGE (com_port)

PURGE (1) end macro_command

Name

Syntax

SetRTS

SetRTS(com_port, source)

Description Set RTS state for RS232. com_port refers to the COM port number 1 . It can be either a variable or a constant. Source also can be either a variable or a constant.

This command raise RTS signal while the value of source is greater than 0 and lower RTS signal while the value of source equals to 0.

Example

macro_command main() char com_port=1 char value=1

SetRTS(com_port, value) // raise RTS signal of COM1 while value>0

SetRTS(1, 0) // lower RTS signal of COM1 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

GetCTS

GetCTS(com_port, result)

Description Get CTS state for RS232. com_port refers to the COM port number 1. It can be either a variable or a constant. Result is used for receiving the CTS signal. It must be a variable.

This command receives CTS signal and stores the received data in the result variable. When the CTS signal is pulled high, it writes 1 to result, otherwise, it writes 0.

Example

macro_command main() char com_port=1

437

Macro Reference char result

GetCTS(com_port, result) // get CTS signal of COM1

GetCTS (1, result) // get CTS signal of COM1 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

Beep

Beep ()

Description Plays beep sound.

This command plays a beep sound with frequency of 800 hertz and

Example

duration of 30 milliseconds. macro_command main()

Beep() end macro_command

438

Macro Reference

18.6.6 String Operation Functions

Name

Syntax

StringGet

StringGet(read_data[start], device_name, device_type, address_offset, data_count)

Description Receives data from the PLC. The String data is stored into read_data[start]~ read_data[start + data_count - 1]. read_data must be a one-dimensional char array.

Data_count is the number of received characters, it can be either a constant or a variable.

Device_name is the PLC name enclosed in the double quotation marks (“) and this name has been defined in the device list of system parameters as follows (see FATEK KB Series):

Device_type is the device type and encoding method (binary or BCD) of the

PLC data. For example, if device_type is LW_BIN, it means the register is LW and the encoding method is binary. If use BIN encoding method, “_BIN” can be ignored.

If device_type is LW_BCD, it means the register is LW and the encoding method is BCD.

Address_offset is the address offset in the PLC.

For example, StringGet(read_data_1[0], “FATEK KB Series”, RT, 5, 1) represents that the address offset is 5.

If address_offset uses the format – “N#AAAAA”, N indicates that PLC’s station number is N. AAAAA represents the address offset. This format is used while

439

Macro Reference multiple PLCs or controllers are connected to a single serial port. For example, StringGet(read_data_1[0], “FATEK KB Series”, RT, 2#5, 1) represents that the PLC’s station number is 2. If StringGet() uses the default station number defined in the device list as follows, it is not necessary to define station number in address_offset.

Example

The number of registers actually read from depends on the value of the number of data_count since that the read_data is restricted to char array.

type of

read_data char (8-bit)

data_count actual number of 16-bit register

read

1 1 char (8-bit) 2 1

1 WORD register(16-bit) equals to the size of 2 ASCII characters. According to the above table, reading 2 ASCII characters is actually reading the content of one 16-bit register. macro_command

main() char str1[20]

// read 10 words from LW0~LW9 to the variables str1[0] to str1[19]

// since that 1 word can store 2 ASCII characters, reading 20 ASCII

// characters is actually reading 10 words of register

StringGet(str1[0], “Local HMI”, LW, 0, 20) end macro_command

440

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

Description Receives data from the PLC and continue executing next command even if no response from this device.

Descriptions of read_data, device_name, device_type, address_offset and data_count are the same as GetData.

Example

StringGetEx

StringGetEx (read_data[start], device_name, device_type, address_offset, data_count) macro_command

main() char str1[20] short test=0

// macro will continue executing test = 1 even if the MODBUS device is

// not responding

StringGetEx(str1[0], "MODBUS RTU", 4x, 0, 20) test = 1

// macro will not continue executing test = 2 until MODBUS device responds

StringGet(str1[0], "MODBUS RTU", 4x, 0, 20) test = 2 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringSet

StringSet(send_data[start], device_name, device_type, address_offset, data_count)

Description Send data to the PLC. Data is defined in send_data[start]~ send_data[start

+ data_count - 1]. send_data must be a one-dimensional char array. data_count is the number of sent characters, it can be either a constant or a variable. device_name is the PLC name enclosed in the double quotation marks (“) and this name has been defined in the device list of system parameters. device_type is the device type and encoding method (binary or BCD) of the PLC data. For example, if device_type is LW_BIN, it means the register is LW and the encoding method is binary. If use BIN encoding method, “_BIN” can be ignored.

441

Macro Reference

If device_type is LW_BCD, it means the register is LW and the encoding method is BCD. address_offset is the address offset in the PLC.

For example, StringSet(read_data_1[0], “FATEK KB Series”, RT, 5, 1) represents that the address offset is 5.

If address_offset uses the format – “N#AAAAA”, N indicates that PLC’s station number is N. AAAAA represents the address offset. This format is used while multiple PLCs or controllers are connected to a single serial port. For example, StringSet(read_data_1[0], “FATEK KB Series”, RT,

2#5, 1) represents that the PLC’s station number is 2. If SetData () uses the default station number defined in the device list, it is not necessary to define station number in address_offset.

The number of registers actually sends to depends on the value of the number of data_count, since that send_data is restricted to char array.

type of

read_data char (8-bit)

data_count actual number of 16-bit register

send

1 1 char (8-bit) 2 1

1 WORD register(16-bit) equals to the size of 2 ASCII characters.

According to the above table, sending 2 ASCII characters is actually writing to one 16-bit register. The ASCII characters are stored into the

WORD register from low byte to high byte. While using the ASCII display object to display the string data stored in the registers, data_count must be a multiple of 2 in order to display full string content. For example: macro_command main() char src1[10]="abcde"

StringSet(src1[0], "Local HMI", LW, 0, 5) end macro_command

The ASCII display object shows:

442

Macro Reference

If data_count is an even number that is greater than or equal to the length of the string, the content of string can be completely shown: macro_command main() char src1[10]="abcde"

StringSet(src1[0], "Local HMI", LW, 0, 6) end macro_command

Example macro_command

main() char str1[10]=”abcde”

// Send 3 words to LW0~LW2

// Data are being sent until the end of string is reached.

// Even though the value of data_count is larger than the length of string

// , the function will automatically stop.

StringSet(str1[0], "Local HMI", LW, 0, 10) end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringSetEx

StringSetEx (send_data[start], device_name, device_type, address_offset, data_count)

Description Send data to the PLC and continue executing next command even if no response from this device.

Descriptions of send_data, device_name, device_type, address_offset and data_count are the same as StringSet.

Example macro_command

main() char str1[20]=”abcde” short test=0

// macro will continue executing test = 1 even if the MODBUS device is

// not responding

StringSetEx(str1[0], "MODBUS RTU", 4x, 0, 20) test = 1

// macro will not continue executing test = 2 until MODBUS device

443

Macro Reference responds

StringSet(str1[0], "MODBUS RTU", 4x, 0, 20) test = 2 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringCopy success = StringCopy (“source”, destination[start]) or success = StringCopy (source[start], destination[start])

Description Copy one string to another. This function copies a static string (which is enclosed in quotes) or a string that is stored in an array to the destination buffer.

The source string parameter accepts both static string (in the form:

“source”) and char array (in the form: source[start]). destination[start] must be an one-dimensional char array.

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns

Example false. If the length of source string exceeds the max. size of destination buffer, it returns false and the content of destination remains the same.

The success field is optional.

macro_command main() char src1[5]="abcde" char dest1[5] bool success1 success1 = StringCopy(src1[0], dest1[0])

// success1=true, dest1=”abcde” char dest2[5] bool success2 success2 = StringCopy("12345", dest2[0])

// success2=true, dest2=”12345” char src3[10]="abcdefghij" char dest3[5] bool success3 success3 = StringCopy(src3[0], dest3[0])

444

Macro Reference

// success3=false, dest3 remains the same. char src4[10]="abcdefghij" char dest4[5] bool success4 success4 = StringCopy(src4[5], dest4[0])

// success4=true, dest4=”fghij” end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringDecAsc2Bin success = StringDecAsc2Bin(source[start], destination) or success = StringDecAsc2Bin(“source”, destination)

Description This function converts a decimal string to an integer. It converts the decimal string in source parameter into an integer, and stores it in the destination variable.

The source string parameter accepts both static string (in the form:

“source”) and char array (in the form: source[start]).

Destination must be a variable, to store the result of conversion.

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns

Example false. If the source string contains characters other than ‘0’ to ‘9’, it returns false.

The success field is optional.

macro_command main() char src1[5]="12345" int result1 bool success1 success1 = StringDecAsc2Bin(src1[0], result1)

// success1=true, result1 is 12345 char result2 bool success2 success2 = StringDecAsc2Bin("32768", result2)

// success2=true, but the result exceeds the data range of result2

445

Macro Reference char src3[2]="4b" char result3 bool success3 success3 = StringDecAsc2Bin (src3[0], result3)

// success3=false, because src3 contains characters other than ‘0’ to ‘9’ end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringBin2DecAsc success = StringBin2DecAsc (source, destination[start])

Description This function converts an integer to a decimal string. It converts the integer in source parameter into a decimal string, and stores it in the destination buffer.

Source can be either a constant or a variable.

Destination must be an one-dimensional char array, to store the result of conversion.

Example

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns false. If the length of decimal string after conversion exceeds the size of destination buffer, it returns false.

The success field is optional.

macro_command main() int src1 = 2147483647 char dest1[20] bool success1 success1 = StringBin2DecAsc(src1, dest1[0])

// success1=true, dest1=”2147483647” short src2 = 0x3c char dest2[20] bool success2 success2 = StringBin2DecAsc(src2, dest2[0])

// success2=true, dest2=”60” int src3 = 2147483647 char dest3[5] bool success3

446

Macro Reference success3 = StringBin2DecAsc(src3, dest3[0])

// success3=false, dest3 remains the same. end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringDecAsc2Float success = StringDecAsc2Float (source[start], destination) or success = StringDecAsc2Float (“source”, destination)

Description This function converts a decimal string to floats. It converts the decimal string in source parameter into float, and stores it in the destination variable.

The source string parameter accepts both static string (in the form:

“source”) and char array (in the form: source[start]).

Destination must be a variable, to store the result of conversion.

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns false. If the source string contains characters other than ‘0’ to ‘9’ or ‘.’, it

Example returns false.

The success field is optional.

macro_command main() char src1[10]="12.345" float result1 bool success1 success1 = StringDecAsc2Float(src1[0], result1)

// success1=true, result1 is 12.345 float result2 bool success2 success2 = StringDecAsc2Float("1.234567890", result2)

// success2=true, but the result exceeds the data range of result2, which

// might result in loss of precision char src3[2]="4b" float result3 bool success3 success3 = StringDecAsc2Float(src3[0], result3)

// success3=false, because src3 contains characters other than ‘0’ to ‘9’ or

447

Macro Reference

// ‘.’ end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringFloat2DecAsc success = StringFloat2DecAsc(source, destination[start])

Description This function converts a float to a decimal string. It converts the float in source parameter into a decimal string, and stores it in the destination buffer.

Source can be either a constant or a variable.

Destination must be an one-dimensional char array, to store the result of conversion.

Example

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns false. If the length of decimal string after conversion exceeds the size of destination buffer, it returns false.

The success field is optional.

macro_command main() float src1 = 1.2345 char dest1[20] bool success1 success1 = StringFloat2DecAsc(src1, dest1[0])

// success1=true, dest1=” 1.2345” float src2 = 1.23456789 char dest2 [20] bool success2 success2 = StringFloat2DecAsc(src2, dest2 [0])

// success2=true, but it might lose precision float src3 = 1.2345 char dest3[5] bool success3 success3 = StringFloat2DecAsc(src3, dest3 [0])

// success3=false, dest3 remains the same. end macro_command

448

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

Description This function converts a hexadecimal string to binary data. It converts the hexadecimal string in source parameter into binary data , and stores it in the destination variable.

The source string parameter accepts both static string (in the form:

“source”) and char array (in the form: source[start]).

Destination must be a variable, to store the result of conversion.

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns false. If the source string contains characters other than ‘0’ to ‘9’, ‘a’ to ‘f’ or

‘A’ to ‘F’, it returns false.

The success field is optional.

Example

StringHexAsc2Bin success = StringHexAsc2Bin (source[start], destination) or success = StringHexAsc2Bin (“source“, destination) macro_command main() char src1[5]="0x3c" int result1 bool success1 success1 = StringHexAsc2Bin(src1[0], result1)

// success1=true, result1 is 3c short result2 bool success2 success2 = StringDecAsc2Bin("1a2b3c4d", result2)

// success2=true, result2=3c4d.The result exceeds the data range of

// result2 char src3[2]="4g" char result3 bool success3 success3 = StringDecAsc2Bin (src3[0], result3)

// success3=false, because src3 contains characters other than ‘0’ to ‘9’

// , ‘a’ to ‘f’ or ‘A’ to ‘F’ end macro_command

449

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

StringBin2HexAsc success = StringBin2HexAsc (source, destination[start])

Description This function converts binary data to a hexadecimal string. It converts the binary data in source parameter into a hexadecimal string, and stores it in the destination buffer.

Source can be either a constant or a variable.

Destination must be an one-dimensional char array, to store the result of conversion.

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns false. If the length of hexadecimal string after conversion exceeds the size of destination buffer, it returns false.

The success field is optional.

Example macro_command main() int src1 = 20 char dest1[20] bool success1 success1 = StringBin2HexAsc(src1, dest1[0])

// success1=true, dest1=”14” short src2 = 0x3c char dest2[20] bool success2 success2 = StringBin2HexAsc(src2, dest2[0])

// success2=true, dest2=”3c” int src3 = 0x1a2b3c4d char dest3[6] bool success3 success3 = StringBin2HexAsc(src3, dest3[0])

// success3=false, dest3 remains the same. end macro_command

450

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

Description Retrieve a character sequence from the specified offset of the source string and store it in the destination buffer.

The source string parameter accepts both static string (in the form:

“source”) and char array (in the form: source[start]). For source[start], the start offset of the substring is specified by the index value. For static source string(“source”), the second parameter(start) specifies the start offset of the substring.

The count parameter specifies the length of substring being retrieved.

Destination must be an one-dimensional char array, to store the retrieved substring.

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns false. If the length of retrieved substring exceeds the size of destination buffer, it returns false.

The success field is optional.

Example

StringMid success = StringMid (source[start], count, destination[start]) or success = StringMid (“string“, start, count, destination[start]) macro_command main() char src1[20]="abcdefghijklmnopqrst" char dest1[20] bool success1 success1 = StringMid(src1[5], 6, dest1[0])

// success1=true, dest1=”fghijk” char src2[20]="abcdefghijklmnopqrst" char dest2[5] bool success2 success2 = StringMid(src2[5], 6, dest2[0])

// success2=false, dest2 remains the same. char dest3[20]="12345678901234567890" bool success3 success3 = StringMid("abcdefghijklmnopqrst", 5, 5, dest3[15])

// success3= true, dest3=” 123456789012345fghij” end macro_command

451

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

Description Obtain the length of a string. It returns the length of source string and stores it in the length field on the left-hand side of ‘=’ operator.

The source string parameter accepts both static string (in the form:

“source”) and char array (in the form: source[start]).

The return value of this function indicates the length of the source string.

Example

StringLength length = StringLength (source[start]) or length = StringLength (“source“) macro_command main() char src1[20]="abcde" int length1 length1= StringLength(src1[0])

// length1=5 char src2[20]={'a', 'b', 'c', 'd', 'e'} int length2 length2= StringLength(src2[0])

// length2=20 char src3[20]="abcdefghij" int length3 length3= StringLength(src3 [2])

// length3=8 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringCat success = StringCat (source[start], destination[start]) or success = StringCat (“source”, destination[start])

Description This function appends source string to destination string. It adds the contents of source string to the last of the contents of destination string.

The source string parameter accepts both static string (in the form:

“source”) and char array (in the form: source[start]).

Destination must be an one-dimensional char array.

452

Macro Reference

Example

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns false. If the length of result string after concatenation exceeds the max. size of destination buffer, it returns false.

The success field is optional.

macro_command main() char src1[20]="abcdefghij" char dest1[20]="1234567890" bool success1 success1= StringCat(src1[0], dest1[0])

// success1=true, dest1=”123456790abcdefghij” char dest2 [10]="1234567890" bool success2 success2= StringCat("abcde", dest2 [0])

// success2=false, dest2 remains the same. char src3[20]="abcdefghij" char dest3[20] bool success3 success3= StringCat(src3[0], dest3[15])

// success3=false, dest3 remains the same. end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringCompare ret = StringCompare (str1[start], str2[start]) ret = StringCompare (“string1“, str2[start]) ret = StringCompare (str1[start], “string2”) ret = StringCompare (“string1”, “string2”)

Description Do a case-sensitive comparison of two strings.

The two string parameters accept both static string (in the form: “string1”) and char array (in the form: str1[start]).

This function returns a Boolean indicating the result of comparison. If two

Example strings are identical, it returns true. Otherwise it returns false.

The ret field is optional.

macro_command main()

453

Macro Reference char a1[20]="abcde" char b1[20]="ABCDE" bool ret1 ret1= StringCompare(a1[0], b1[0])

// ret1=false char a2[20]="abcde" char b2[20]="abcde" bool ret2 ret2= StringCompare(a2[0], b2[0])

// ret2=true char a3 [20]="abcde" char b3[20]="abcdefg" bool ret3 ret3= StringCompare(a3[0], b3[0])

// ret3=false end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringCompareNoCase ret = StringCompareNoCase(str1[start], str2[start]) ret = StringCompareNoCase(“string1“, str2[start]) ret = StringCompareNoCase(str1[start], “string2”) ret = StringCompareNoCase(“string1”, “string2”)

Description Do a case-insensitive comparison of two strings.

The two string parameters accept both static string (in the form: “string1”) and char array (in the form: str1[start]).

This function returns a Boolean indicating the result of comparison. If two strings are identical, it returns true. Otherwise it returns false.

The ret field is optional.

Example macro_command main() char a1[20]="abcde" char b1[20]="ABCDE" bool ret1 ret1= StringCompareNoCase(a1[0], b1[0])

// ret1=true

454

Macro Reference char a2[20]="abcde" char b2[20]="abcde" bool ret2 ret2= StringCompareNoCase(a2[0], b2[0])

// ret2=true char a3 [20]="abcde" char b3[20]="abcdefg" bool ret3 ret3= StringCompareNoCase(a3[0], b3[0])

// ret3=false end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringFind position = StringFind (source[start], target[start]) position = StringFind (“source“, target[start]) position = StringFind (source[start], “target”) position = StringFind (“source“, “target“)

Description Return the position of the first occurrence of target string in the source string.

The two string parameters accept both static string (in the form: “source”) and char array (in the form: source[start]).

Example

This function returns the zero-based index of the first character of substring in the source string that matches the target string. Notice that the entire sequence of characters to find must be matched. If there is no matched substring, it returns -1.

macro_command main() char src1[20]="abcde" char target1[20]="cd" bool pos1 pos1= StringFind(src1[0], target1[0])

// pos1=2 char target2[20]="ce" bool pos2

455

Macro Reference pos2= StringFind("abcde", target2[0])

// pos2=-1 char src3[20]="abcde" bool pos3 pos3= StringFind(src3[3], "cd")

// pos3=-1 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringReverseFind position = StringReverseFind (source[start], target[start]) position = StringReverseFind (“source“, target[start]) position = StringReverseFind (source[start], “target”) position = StringReverseFind (“source“, “target“)

Description Return the position of the last occurrence of target string in the source string.

The two string parameters accept both static string (in the form: “source”) and char array (in the form: source[start]).

This function returns the zero-based index of the first character of substring in the source string that matches the target string. Notice that the entire sequence of characters to find must be matched. If there exists multiple substrings that matches the target string, function will return the position of

Example the last matched substring. If there is no matched substring, it returns -1.

macro_command main() char src1[20]="abcdeabcde" char target1[20]="cd" bool pos1 pos1= StringReverseFind(src1[0], target1[0])

// pos1=7 char target2[20]="ce" bool pos2 pos2= StringReverseFind("abcdeabcde", target2[0])

// pos2=-1 char src3[20]="abcdeabcde"

456

Macro Reference bool pos3 pos3= StringReverseFind(src3[6], "ab")

// pos3=-1 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringFindOneOf position = StringFindOneOf (source[start], target[start]) position = StringFindOneOf (“source“, target[start]) position = StringFindOneOf (source[start], “target”) position = StringFindOneOf (“source“, “target“)

Description Return the position of the first character in the source string that matches any character contained in the target string.

The two string parameters accept both static string (in the form: “source”) and char array (in the form: source[start]).

Example

This function returns the zero-based index of the first character in the source string that is also in the target string. If there is no match, it returns

-1.

macro_command main() char src1[20]="abcdeabcde" char target1[20]="sdf" bool pos1 pos1= StringFindOneOf(src1[0], target1[0])

// pos1=3 char src2[20]="abcdeabcde" bool pos2 pos2= StringFindOneOf(src2[1], "agi")

// pos2=4 char target3 [20]="bus" bool pos3 pos3= StringFindOneOf("abcdeabcde", target3[1])

// pos3=-1 end macro_command

457

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

Description Retrieve a substring of the source string that contains characters in the set string, beginning with the first character in the source string and ending when a character is found in the source string that is not in the target string.

The source string and set string parameters accept both static string (in the form: “source”) and char array (in the form: source[start]).

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns false. If the length of retrieved substring exceeds the size of destination buffer, it returns false.

Example

StringIncluding success = StringIncluding (source[start], set[start], destination[start]) success = StringIncluding (“source“, set[start], destination[start]) success = StringIncluding (source[start], “set“, destination[start]) success = StringIncluding (“source“, “set“, destination[start]) macro_command main() char src1[20]="cabbageabc" char set1[20]="abc" char dest1[20] bool success1 success1 = StringIncluding(src1[0], set1[0], dest1[0])

// success1=true, dest1="cabba" char src2[20]="gecabba" char dest2[20] bool success2 success2 = StringIncluding(src2[0], "abc", dest2[0])

// success2=true, dest2="" char set3[20]="abc" char dest3[4] bool success3 success3 = StringIncluding("cabbage", set3[0], dest3[0])

// success3=false, dest3 remains the same. end macro_command

458

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

Description Retrieve a substring of the source string that contains characters that are not in the set string, beginning with the first character in the source string and ending when a character is found in the source string that is also in the target string.

The source string and set string parameters accept both static string (in the form: “source”) and char array (in the form: source[start]).

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns false. If the length of retrieved substring exceeds the size of destination buffer, it returns false.

Example

StringExcluding success = StringExcluding (source[start], set[start], destination[start]) success = StringExcluding (“source“, set[start], destination[start]) success = StringExcluding (source[start], “set“, destination[start]) success = StringExcluding (“source“, “set“, destination[start]) macro_command main() char src1[20]="cabbageabc" char set1[20]="ge" char dest1[20] bool success1 success1 = StringExcluding(src1[0], set1[0], dest1[0])

// success1=true, dest1="cabba" char src2[20]="cabbage" char dest2[20] bool success2 success2 = StringExcluding(src2[0], "abc", dest2[0])

// success2=true, dest2="" char set3[20]="ge" char dest3[4] bool success3 success3 = StringExcluding("cabbage", set3[0], dest3[0])

// success3=false, dest3 remains the same. end macro_command

459

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

Description Convert all the characters in the source string to uppercase characters and store the result in the destination buffer.

The source string parameter accepts both static string (in the form:

"source") and char array (in the form: source[start]).

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns false. If the length of result string after conversion exceeds the size of destination buffer, it returns false.

Example

StringToUpper success = StringToUpper (source[start], destination[start]) success = StringToUpper ("source", destination[start]) macro_command main() char src1[20]="aBcDe" char dest1[20] bool success1 success1 = StringToUpper(src1[0], dest1[0])

// success1=true, dest1="ABCDE" char dest2[4] bool success2 success2 = StringToUpper("aBcDe", dest2[0])

// success2=false, dest2 remains the same. end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringToLower success = StringToLower (source[start], destination[start]) success = StringToLower ("source", destination[start])

Description Convert all the characters in the source string to lowercase characters and store the result in the destination buffer.

The source string parameter accepts both static string (in the form:

"source") and char array (in the form: source[start]).

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns false. If the length of result string after conversion exceeds the size of destination buffer, it returns false.

Example macro_command main()

460

Macro Reference char src1[20]="aBcDe" char dest1[20] bool success1 success1 = StringToUpper(src1[0], dest1[0])

// success1=true, dest1="abcde" char dest2[4] bool success2 success2 = StringToUpper("aBcDe", dest2[0])

// success2=false, dest2 remains the same. end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringToReverse success = StringToReverse (source[start], destination[start]) success = StringToReverse ("source", destination[start])

Description Reverse the characters in the source string and store it in the destination buffer.

The source string parameter accepts both static string (in the form:

"source") and char array (in the form: source[start]).

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns false. If the length of reversed string exceeds the size of destination buffer, it returns false.

Example macro_command main() char src1[20]="abcde" char dest1[20] bool success1 success1 = StringToUpper(src1[0], dest1[0])

// success1=true, dest1="edcba" char dest2[4] bool success2 success2 = StringToUpper("abcde", dest2[0])

// success2=false, dest2 remains the same. end macro_command

461

Macro Reference

Name

Syntax

Description Trim the leading specified characters in the set buffer from the source string.

The source string and set string parameters accept both static string (in the form: "source") and char array (in the form: source[start]).

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns false. If the length of trimmed string exceeds the size of destination buffer, it returns false.

Example

StringTrimLeft success = StringTrimLeft (source[start], set[start], destination[start]) success = StringTrimLeft (“source“, set[start], destination[start]) success = StringTrimLeft (source[start], “set“, destination[start]) success = StringTrimLeft (“source“, “set“, destination[start]) macro_command main() char src1[20]= "# *a*#bc" char set1[20]="# *" char dest1[20] bool success1 success1 = StringTrimLeft (src1[0], set1[0], dest1[0])

// success1=true, dest1="a*#bc" char set2[20]={'#', ' ', '*'} char dest2[4] success2 = StringTrimLeft ("# *a*#bc", set2[0], dest2[0])

// success2=false, dest2 remains the same. char src3[20]="abc *#" char dest3[20] bool success3 success3 = StringTrimLeft (src3[0], "# *", dest3[0])

// success3=true, dest3="abc *#" end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringTrimRight success = StringTrimRight (source[start], set[start], destination[start]) success = StringTrimRight (“source“, set[start], destination[start])

462

Macro Reference success = StringTrimRight (source[start], “set“, destination[start]) success = StringTrimRight (“source“, “set“, destination[start])

Description Trim the trailing specified characters in the set buffer from the source string.

The source string and set string parameters accept both static string (in the form: "source") and char array (in the form: source[start]).

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns false. If the length of trimmed string exceeds the size of destination buffer, it returns false.

Example macro_command main() char src1[20]= "# *a*#bc# * " char set1[20]="# *" char dest1[20] bool success1 success1 = StringTrimRight(src1[0], set1[0], dest1[0])

// success1=true, dest1="# *a*#bc" char set2[20]={'#', ' ', '*'} char dest2[20] success2 = StringTrimRight("# *a*#bc", set2[0], dest2[0])

// success2=true, dest2="# *a*#bc" char src3[20]="ab**c *#" char dest3[4] bool success3 success3 = StringTrimRight(src3[0], "# *", dest3[0])

// success3=false, dest3 remains the same. end macro_command

Name

Syntax

StringInsert success = StringInsert (pos, insert[start], destination[start]) success = StringInsert (pos, “insert“, destination[start]) success = StringInsert (pos, insert[start], length, destination[start]) success = StringInsert (pos, “insert“, length, destination[start])

Description Insert a string in a specific location within the destination string content. The insert location is specified by the pos parameter.

463

Example

Macro Reference

The insert string parameter accepts both static string (in the form: "source") and char array (in the form: source[start]).

The number of characters to insert can be specified by the length parameter.

This function returns a Boolean indicating whether the process is successfully done or not. If successful, it returns true, otherwise it returns false. If the length of string after insertion exceeds the size of destination buffer, it returns false.

macro_command main() char str1[20]="but the question is" char str2[10]=", that is" char dest[40]="to be or not to be" bool success success = StringInsert(18, str1[3], 13, dest[0])

// success=true, dest="to be or not to be the question" success = StringInsert(18, str2[0], dest[0])

// success=true, dest="to be or not to be, that is the question" success = StringInsert(0, "Hamlet:", dest[0])

// success=false, dest remains the same. end macro_command

464

Macro Reference

18.6.7 Recipe Query Function

Name

Syntax

RecipeGetData

RecipeGetData (destination, recipe_address, record_ID)

Description Get Recipe Data. The gained data will be stored in destination, and must be a variable. Recipe address consists of recipe name and item name:

“recipe_name.item_name”. record_ID specifies the ID number of the record in recipe being gained.

Example

macro_command main() int data=0 char str[20] int recordID bool result recordID = 0 result = RecipeGetData(data, "TypeA.item_weight", recordID)

// From recipe "TypeA" get the data of the item “item_weight” in record 0. recordID = 1 result = RecipeGetData(str[0], "TypeB.item_name", recordID)

// From recipe "TypeB" get the data of the item “item_name” in record 1. end macro_command

Name

Syntax

RecipeQuery

RecipeQuery (SQL command, destination)

Description Use SQL statement to query recipe data. The number of records of query result will be stored in the destination. This must be a variable. SQL command can be static string or char array. Example:

RecipeQuery(“SELECT * FROM TypeA”, destination) or

RecipeQuery(sql[0], destination)

SQL statement must start with ”SELECT * FROM” followed by recipe name and query condition.

Example

macro_command main()

465

Macro Reference int total_row=0 char sql[100]="SELECT * FROM TypeB" bool result result = RecipeQuery("SELECT * FROM TypeA", total_row)

// Query Recipe "TypeA". Store the number of records of query result in total_row. result = RecipeQuery(sql[0], total_row)

// Query Recipe "TypeB". Store the number of records of query result in total_row. end macro_command

Name

Syntax

RecipeQueryGetData

RecipeQueryGetData (destination, recipe_address, result_row_no)

Description Get the data in the query result obtained by RecipeQuery. This function must be called after calling RecipeQuery, and specify the same recipe

Example

name in recipe_address as RecipeQuery. result_row_no specifies the sequence row number in query result macro_command main() int data=0 int total_row=0 int row_number=0 bool result_query bool result_data result_query = RecipeQuery("SELECT * FROM TypeA", total_row)

// Query Recipe "TypeA". Store the number of records of query result in total_row. if (result_query) then for row_number=0 to total_row-1 result_data = RecipeQueryGetData(data, "TypeA.item_weight", row_number) next row_number end if

466

Macro Reference end macro_command

Name

Syntax

RecipeQueryGetRecordID

RecipeQueryGetRecordID (destination, result_row_no)

Description Get the record ID numbers of those records gained by RecipeQuery. This function must be called after calling RecipeQuery.

Example

result_row_no specifies the sequence row number in query result, and write the obtained record ID to destination. macro_command main() int recordID=0 int total_row=0 int row_number=0 bool result_query bool result_id result_query = RecipeQuery("SELECT * FROM TypeA", total_row)

// Query Recipe "TypeA". Store the number of records of query result in total_row. if (result_query) then for row_number=0 to total_row-1 result_id = RecipeQueryGetRecordID(recordID, row_number) next row_number end if end macro_command

467

Macro Reference

18.6.8 Miscellaneous

Name

Syntax

SYNC_TRIG_MACRO

SYNC_TRIG_MACRO(macro_id)

Description Trigger the execution of a macro synchronously (use macro_id to designate this macro) in a running macro.

The current macro will pause until the end of execution of this called macro. macro_id can be a constant or a variable.

Example

macro_command main() char ON = 1, OFF = 0

SetData(ON, “Local HMI”, LB, 0, 1)

SYNC_TRIG_MACRO(5)// call a macro (its ID is 5)

SetData(OFF, “Local HMI”, LB, 0, 1) end macro_command

Name

ASYNC_TRIG_MACRO

Syntax

ASYNC_TRIG_MACRO (macro_id)

Description Trigger the execution of a macro asynchronously (use macro_id to designate this macro) in a running macro.

The current macro will continue executing the following instructions after triggering the designated macro; in other words, the two macros will be active simultaneously. macro_id can be a constant or a variable.

Example

macro_command main() char ON = 1, OFF = 0

SetData(ON, “Local HMI”, LB, 0, 1)

ASYNC_TRIG_MACRO(5)// call a macro (its ID is 5)

SetData(OFF, “Local HMI”, LB, 0, 1)

468

Macro Reference end macro_command

Name

Syntax

TRACE

TRACE(format, argument)

Description Use this function to send specified string to the EasyDiagnoser. Users can print out the current value of variables during run-time of macro for debugging.

When TRACE encounters the first format specification (if any), it converts the value of the first argument after format and outputs it accordingly.

format refers to the format control of output string. A format specification, which consists of optional (in [ ]) and required fields (in bold), has the following form:

%[flags] [width] [.precision] type

Each field of the format specification is described as below:

flags (optional):

-

+

width (optional):

A nonnegative decimal integer controlling the minimum number of characters printed.

precision (optional):

A nonnegative decimal integer which specifies the precision and the number of characters to be printed.

type:

C or c : specifies a single-byte character. d : signed decimal integer. i : signed decimal integer. o : unsigned octal integer. u : unsigned decimal integer.

X or x : unsigned hexadecimal integer.

E or e : Signed value having the form.

[ – ]d .dddd e [sign]ddd where d is a single decimal digit, dddd is one or more decimal digits, ddd is exactly three decimal digits, and sign is + or –. f : Signed value having the form [ – ]dddd .dddd, where dddd is one or more decimal digits.

469

Macro Reference

Example

The length of output string is limited to 256 characters. The extra characters will be ignored.

The argument part is optional. One format specification converts exactly one argument. macro_command main() char c1 = ’a’ short s1 = 32767 float f1 = 1.234567

TRACE(“The results are”) // output: The results are

TRACE(“c1 = %c, s1 = %d, f1 = %f”, c1, s1, f1)

// output: c1 = a, s1 = 32767, f1 = 1.234567 end macro_command

Name

Syntax

FindDataSamplingDate return_value = FindDataSamplingDate (data_log_number, index, year, month, day) or

FindDataSamplingDate (data_log_number, index, year, month, day)

Description A query function for finding the date of specified data sampling file according to the data sampling no. and the file index. The date is stored into “year”, “month” and “day” respectively in the format of YYYY, MM and

DD.

The directory of saved data: [Storage location]\[filename]\yyyymmdd.dtl.

The data sampling files under the same directory are sorted according to the file name and are indexed starting from 0. The most recently saved file has the smallest file index number. For example, if there are four data sampling files as follows:

20101210.dtl

20101230.dtl

20110110.dtl

470

Macro Reference

Example

20110111.dtl

The file index are:

20101210.dtl -> index is 3

20101230.dtl -> index is 2

20110110.dtl -> index is 1

20110111.dtl -> index is 0

“return_value” equals to 1 if referred data sampling file is successfully found, otherwise it equals to 0.

“data_log_number” and “index” can be constant or variable. “year”,

“month”, “day” and “return_value” must be variable.

The “return_value” field is optional. macro_command main() short data_log_number = 1, index = 2, year, month, day short success

// if there exists a data sampling file named 20101230.dtl, with data sampling // number 1 and file index 2.

// the result after execution: success == 1, year == 2010, month == 12 and

//day == 30 success = FindDataSamplingDate(data_log_number, index, year, month, day) end macro_command

Name

Syntax

FindDataSamplingIndex return_value = FindDataSamplingIndex (data_log_number, year, month, day, index) or

FindDataSamplingIndex (data_log_number, year, month, day, index)

Description A query function for finding the file index of specified data sampling file according to the data sampling no. and the date. The file index is stored into “index”. “year”, “month” and “day” are in the format of YYYY, MM and

DD respectively. data sampling no.

471

Macro Reference

Example

The directory of saved data: [Storage location]\[filename]\yyyymmdd.dtl.

The data sampling files under the same directory are sorted according to the file name and are indexed starting from 0. The most recently saved file has the smallest file index number. For example, if there are four data sampling files as follows:

20101210.dtl

20101230.dtl

20110110.dtl

20110111.dtl

The file index are:

20101210.dtl -> index is 3

20101230.dtl -> index is 2

20110110.dtl -> index is 1

20110111.dtl -> index is 0

“return_value” equals to 1 if referred data sampling file is successfully found, otherwise it equals to 0.

“data_log_number”, “year”, “month” and “day” can be constant or variable.

“index” and “return_value” must be variable.

The “return_value” field is optional. macro_command main() short data_log_number = 1, year = 2010, month = 12, day = 10, index short success

// if there exists a data sampling file named 20101210.dtl, with data sampling // number 1 and file index 2.

// the result after execution: success == 1 and index == 2 success = FindDataSamplingIndex (data_log_number, year, month, day, index) end macro_command

Name

Syntax

FindEventLogDate return_value = FindEventLogDate (index, year, month, day) or

FindEventLogDate (index, year, month, day)

Description A query function for finding the date of specified event log file according to file index. The date is stored into “year”, “month” and “day” respectively in

472

Macro Reference

Example

the format of YYYY, MM and DD.

The event log files stored in the designated position (such as HMI memory storage or external memory device) are sorted according to the file name and are indexed starting from 0. The most recently saved file has the smallest file index number. For example, if there are four event log files as follows:

EL_20101210.evt

EL_20101230.evt

EL_20110110.evt

EL_20110111.evt

The file index are:

EL_20101210.evt -> index is 3

EL_20101230.evt -> index is 2

EL_20110110.evt -> index is 1

EL_20110111.evt -> index is 0

“return_value” equals to 1 if referred data sampling file is successfully found, otherwise it equals to 0.

“index” can be constant or variable. “year”, “month”, “day” and

“return_value” must be variable.

The “return_value” field is optional. macro_command main() short index = 1, year, month, day short success

// if there exists an event log file named EL_20101230.evt,with index 1

// the result after execution: success == 1, year == 2010, month == 12, day

//== 30 success = FindEventLogDate (index, year, month, day) end macro_command

Name

Syntax

FindEventLogIndex return_value = FindEventLogIndex (year, month, day, index) or

FindEventLogIndex (year, month, day, index)

Description A query function for finding the file index of specified event log file according to date. The file index is stored into “index”. “year”, “month” and

473

Example

Macro Reference

“day” are in the format of YYYY, MM and DD respectively.

The event log files stored in the designated position (such as HMI memory storage or external memory device) are sorted according to the file name and are indexed starting from 0. The most recently saved file has the smallest file index number. For example, if there are four event log files as follows:

EL_20101210.evt

EL_20101230.evt

EL_20110110.evt

EL_20110111.evt

The file index are:

EL_20101210.evt -> index is 3

EL_20101230.evt -> index is 2

EL_20110110.evt -> index is 1

EL_20110111.evt -> index is 0

“return_value” equals to 1 if referred data sampling file is successfully found, otherwise it equals to 0.

“year”, “month” and “day” can be constant or variable. “index” and

“return_value” must be variable.

The “return_value” field is optional. macro_command main() short year = 2010, month = 12, day = 10, index short success

// if there exists an event log file named EL_20101210.evt, with index 2

// the result after execution: success == 1, index == 2 success = FindEventLogIndex (year, month, day, index) end macro_command

474

Macro Reference

18.7 How to Create and Execute a Macro

18.7.1 How to Create a Macro

Macro programming can be divided into some steps as follows,

Step 1:

Click on “Macro Manager” icon on the tool bar of EasyBuilder Pro to open Macro Manager dialogue box as follows.

On Macro Manager, all macros compiled successfully are displayed in “Macro list”, and all macros in developing are displayed in ‘Macro under development”. The following is a description of the various buttons.

475

Macro Reference

[New]

Opens a blank “WorkSpace” editor for creating a new macro.

[Delete]

Deletes the selected macro.

[Edit]

Opens the “WorkSpace” editor, and loads the selected macro.

[Copy]

Copies the selected macro into the clipboard.

[Paste]

Pastes the macro in the clipboard into the list, and creates a new name for the macro.

[OK]

Confrim all the edited Macros and click this button to save the new contents before leaving this dialog.

[Cancel]

Cancel the editing and leave Macro editing dialog.

[Library…]

Open Macro Funtion Library managing dialog.

Step 2:

Press the “New” button to open a blank “WorkSpace” editor. Every macro has a unique number defined in “Macro ID” edit box, and macro name must exist, otherwise an error will appear while compiling.

476

Macro Reference

Step 3:

Design your macro. If it is necessary to use build-in functions (like SetData() or Getdata()), press ‘Get/Set FN…” button to open API dialog and select the function and set essential parameters.

Step 4:

After the completion of a new macro, press ‘Compile” button to compile the macro.

477

Macro Reference

If there is no error, press “Exit” button and find that a new macro “macro_test” exists in

“Macro list”.

478

Macro Reference

18.7.2 Execute a Macro

There are several ways to execute a macro. a. With a PLC Control object

1. Open the PLC Control object and set the attribute to “Execute macro program”.

2. Select the macro by name. Choose a bit and select a trigger condition to trigger the macro. The macro will continue to be re-triggered as long as the condition is met. In order to guarantee that the macro will run only once, consider latching the trigger bit, and then resetting the trigger condition within the macro.

3. Use a Set Bit or Toggle Switch object to activate the bit. b. With a Set Bit or Toggle Switch object

1. On the General tab of the Set Bit or Toggle Switch dialog, select the “Execute

Macro” option.

2. Select the macro to execute. The macro will execute one time when the button is activated. c. With a Function Key object

1. On the General tab of the Function Key dialog, select the Execute Macro option.

2. Select the macro to execute. The macro will execute one time when the button is activated.

Macro Execution Conditions:

1. Periodical Execution: Macro will be triggered periodically.

2. Execute one time when HMI starts: Macro will be executed once when HMI starts up.

479

Macro Reference

18.8 User Defined Macro Function

When editing Macro, to save time of defining functions, user may search for the needed from built-in Macro Function Library. However, certain functions, though frequently used, may not be found there. In this case, user may define the needed function and save it for future use. Next time when the same function is required, the saved functions can be called from Macro Function Library for easier editing. Additionally, Macro Function Library greatly enhances the portability of user-defined functions. Before building a function please check the built-in functions or online function library to see if it exists.

480

Macro Reference

18.8.1 Import Function Library File

Open a project in HMI programming software, the default Function Library File will be read automatically and the function information will be loaded in. At this moment if a user-defined function is called, the relevant *.mlb file must be imported first.

1. Default Function Library File Name: MacroLibrary (without filename extension)

2. Function Library Directory: HMI programming software installation directory\library

(folder)

3. \library (folder) contains two types of function library files:

Without filename extension: MacroLibrary, the Default Function Library for HMI programming software to read at the beginning.

With filename extension (*.mlb): Such as ”math.mlb”. The files to be read / written when users import / export. These files are portable and can be called from the folder when needed.

4. When opening HMI programming software, only the functions in Default Function

Library will be loaded in, to use functions in *.mlb files, please import them first.

481

Macro Reference

18.8.2 How to Use Macro Function Library

1. Select the function directly from

Macro Function Library.

2. In WorkSpace click [GET/SET FN…] to open API dialog box.

3. At least check one from [Library] or

[Build-in] and select the function to be used.

4. The description displayed in API dialog is the same as written in

Function Editor.

482

Macro Reference

5. Select the function to be used, fill in the corresponding variables according to the data type.

Upon completion of the steps above, user-defined functions can be used freely without defining the same functions repeatedly.

483

Macro Reference

18.8.3 Function Library Management Interface

1 Open Macro management dialog, click [Library] to enter

Macro Function Library interface.

2 A list of functions will be shown, when the project is opened, the software will load in all the functions in the Default Function

Library.

3. The format of each line in function list:

return_type function_name ( parameter_type1, …, parameter_typeN)

return_type indicates the type of the return value. If this value does not exist, this column will be omitted. function_name indicates the name of the function. “N” in parameter_typeN stands for the number of parameter types. If this function does not accept any parameters, this column will be omitted.

484

Macro Reference

18.8.3.1 Create a Function

1.

Click [New] to enter Function

Editor.

2.

Edit function in Function Editing

Field.

3.

Edit function description here: specifications, usages, editor’s statement etc.

4.

After editing a function, click [Compile] and [Save] to save this function to the Library. If it is not compiled, a warning dialog will be shown.

5. Successfully added into Macro

Function Library.

485

Macro Reference

1. The total size of data type can be declared in a function is 4096 bytes.

2. Function name must only contain alphanumeric characters, and cannot start with a number.

486

Macro Reference

18.8.3.2 Delete a Function

1. In function list select the function to be deleted and click [Delete].

2. Click [Yes] to confirm, [No] to cancel the deletion.

3. Click [Yes] to delete

MAX_SHORT function.

487

Macro Reference

18.8.3.3 Modify a Function

1. Users can modify the functions exist in the Library.

2. Select a function to modify by clicking [Edit] to enter Function

Editor

3. Double click on the function to be modified can also enter Function

Editor.

4. After modifying, [Compile] then

[Save] before leaving.

488

Macro Reference

18.8.3.4 Import a Function

1. Functions can be imported using an external *.mlb file.

2. EX: To import a function library

“math.mlb” which contains a function

“test1”.

3. Click [Open].

4. When importing a function with a name which already exists in the Library, a message will popup.

OK: Overwrite the existing function with the imported one.

NO: Cancel the importing of the function with the same name.

Yes to all: Overwrite using all the imported functions with the same name.

No to all: Cancel the importing of all the functions with the same name.

5. The imported functions will be saved in Default Function Library, so if “math.mlb” file is deleted,

“test1” will still exist in the Library, even when restart software.

489

Macro Reference

18.8.3.5 Export a Function

1. Export the function from Function

Library and save as *.mlb file.

2. Click [Export].

3. Select the function to be exported, and click [Export].

4. A “math.mlb” file can be found under export directory. This file contains 4 functions: ADD, SUBS,

MUL, and DIV.

5. The exported *.mlb file can be imported to another PC. Open HMI programming software, import, then the functions in this file can be used.

490

Macro Reference

18.9 Some Notes about Using the Macro

1. The maximum storage space of local variables in a macro is 4K bytes. So the maximum array size of different variable types are as follows: char a[4096] bool b[4096] short c[2048] int d[1024] float e[1024]

2. A maximum of 255 macros are allowed in an EasyBuilder Pro project.

3. A macro may cause the HMI to lock up. Possible causes are:

A macro contains an infinite loop with no PLC communication.

The size of an array exceeds the storage space in a macro.

4. PLC communication time may cause the macro to execute slower than expected. Also, too many macro instructions may slow down the PLC communication.

491

Macro Reference

18.10 Use the Free Protocol to Control a Device

When EasyBuilder Pro does not provide an essential driver for communication with a device, Users also can make use of OUTPORT and INPORT to control the device. The data sent with OUTPORT and INPORT must follow the device’s communication protocol.

The following example explains how to use these two functions to control a MODBUS RTU device.

First, create a new device in the device table. The device type of the new device is set to

“Free Protocol” and named with “MODBUS RTU device” as follows:

The interface of the device (PLC I/F) uses “RS-232” now. If connecting a MODBUS

TCP/IP device, the interface must select ‘Ethernet”. In addition, it is necessary to set correct IP and port number as follows:

492

Macro Reference

Suppose that HMI will read the data of 4x_1 and 4x_2 on the device. First, utilize

OUTPORT to send out a read request to the device. The prototype of OUTPORT is:

OUTPORT(command[start], device_name, cmd_count)

Since “MODBUS RTU device” is a MODBUS RTU device, the read request must follow

MODBUS RTU protocol. The request uses”Reading Holding Registers (0x03)” command to read data. The following picture displays the content of the command. (The items of the station number (byte 0) and the last two bytes (CRC) are ignored).

Depending on the protocol, the content of a read command as follows (The total is 8 bytes): command[0] : station number (BYTE 0) command[1] : function code (BYTE 1) command[2] : high byte of starting address (BYTE 2) command[3] : low byte of starting address (BYTE 3) command[4] : high byte of quantity of registers (BYTE 4) command[5] : low byte of quantity of registers (BYTE 5) command[6] : low byte of 16-bit CRC (BYTE 6) command[7] : high byte of 16-bit CRC (BYTE 7)

So a read request is designed as follows : char command[32] short address, checksum

FILL(command[0], 0, 32) // initialize command[0]~command[31] to 0

493

Macro Reference command[0] = 0x1 // station number command[1] = 0x3 // read holding registers (function code is 0x3) address = 0// starting address (4x_1) is 0

HIBYTE(address, command[2])

LOBYTE(address, command[3]) read_no = 2// the total words of reading is 2 words

HIBYTE(read_no, command[4])

LOBYTE(read_no, command[5])

CRC(command[0], checksum, 6)// calculate 16-bit CRC

LOBYTE(checksum, command[6])

HIBYTE(checksum, command[7])

Lastly, use OUPORT to send out this read request to PLC

OUTPORT(command[0], "MODBUS RTU Device", 8)// send read request

After sending out the request, use INPORT to get the response from PLC. Depending on the protocol, the content of the response is as follows (the total byte is 9): command[0] : station number (BYTE 0) command[1] : function code (BYTE 1) command[2] : byte count (BYTE 2) command[3] : high byte of 4x_1 (BYTE 3) command[4] : low byte of 4x_1 command[5] : high byte of 4x_2

(BYTE 4)

(BYTE 5) command[6] : high byte of 4x_2 command[7] : low byte of 16-bit CRC command[8] : high byte of 16-bit CRC

(BYTE 6)

(BYTE 7)

(BYTE 8)

The usage of INPORT is described below:

INPORT(response[0], "MODBUS RTU Device", 9, return_value)// read response

Where the real read count is restored to the variable return_value (unit is byte). If return_value is 0, it means reading fails in executing INPORT.

494

Macro Reference

Depending on the protocol, response[1] must be equal to 0x3, if the response is correct.

After getting correct response, calculate the data of 4x_1 and 4x_2 and put in the data into

LW100 and LW101 of HMI. if (return_value >0 and response[1] == 0x3) then

read_data[0] = response[4] + (response[3] << 8)// 4x_1

read_data[1] = response[6] + (response[5] << 8)// 4x_2

SetData(read_data[0], "Local HMI", LW, 100, 2) end if

The complete macro is as follows:

// Read Holding Registers macro_command main() char command[32], response[32] short address, checksum short read_no, return_value, read_data[2], i

FILL(command[0], 0, 32)// initialize command[0]~command[31] to 0

FILL(response[0], 0, 32) command[0] = 0x1// station number command[1] = 0x3// read holding registers (function code is 0x3) address = 0 address = 0// starting address (4x_1) is 0

HIBYTE(address, command[2])

LOBYTE(address, command[3]) read_no = 2/ the total words of reading is 2 words

HIBYTE(read_no, command[4])

LOBYTE(read_no, command[5])

CRC(command[0], checksum, 6)// calculate 16-bit CRC

LOBYTE(checksum, command[6])

495

Macro Reference

HIBYTE(checksum, command[7])

OUTPORT(command[0], "MODBUS RTU Device", 8 )// send request

INPORT(response[0], "MODBUS RTU Device", 9, return_value)// read response if (return_value > 0 and response[1] == 0x3) then

read_data[0] = response[4] + (response[3] << 8)// 4x_1

read_data[1] = response[6] + (response[5] << 8)// 4x_2

SetData(read_data[0], "Local HMI", LW, 100, 2) end if end macro_command

The following example explains how to design a request to set the status of 0x_1. The request uses ”Write Single Coil(0x5)” command.

The complete macro is as follows:

// Write Single Coil (ON) macro_command main() char command[32], response[32] short address, checksum short i, return_value

FILL(command[0], 0, 32)// initialize command[0]~ command[31] to 0

FILL(response[0], 0, 32)

496

Macro Reference command[0] = 0x1// station number command[1] = 0x5// function code : write single coil address = 0

HIBYTE(address, command[2])

LOBYTE(address, command[3]) command[4] = 0xff// force 0x_1 on command[5] = 0

CRC(command[0], checksum, 6)

LOBYTE(checksum, command[6])

HIBYTE(checksum, command[7])

OUTPORT(command[0], "MODBUS RTU Device", 8)// send request

INPORT(response[0], "MODBUS RTU Device", 8, return_value)// read response end macro_command

497

Macro Reference

18.11 Compiler Error Message

1. Error Message Format:

error c# : error description

(# is the error message number)

Example: error C37 : undeclared identifier : i

When there are compile errors, the error description can be referenced by the compiler error message number.

2. Error Description

(C1) syntax error’identifier’

There are many possibilities to cause compiler error.

For example:

macro_command main()

char i, 123xyz // this is an unsupported variable name

end macro_command

(C2) ‘identifier’ used without having been initialized

Macro must define the size of an array during declaration.

For example:

macro_command main()

char i

int g[i] // i must be a numeric constant

end macro_command

(C3) redefinition error : ‘identifier’

The name of variable and function within its scope must be unique.

For example:

macro_command main()

int g[10],g // error

end macro_command

498

Macro Reference

(C4) function name error : ‘identifier’

Reserved keywords and constant can not be the name of a function

For example: sub int if() // error

(C5) parentheses have not come in pairs

Statement missing “(“ or “)”

For example: macro_command main ) // missing “(“

(C6) illegal expression without matching ‘if’

Missing expression in “if” statement

(C7) illegal expression (no ‘then’) without matching ‘if’

Missing “then” in “if” statement

(C8) illegal expression (no ‘end if’)

Missing “end if”

(C9) illegal ‘end if’ without matching ‘if’

Unfinished “If’ statement before “End If”

(C10) illegal ‘else’

The format of “if” statement is :

if [logic expression] then

[ else [if [logic expression] then ] ]

end if

Any format other than this format will cause a compile error.

(C17) illegal expression (no 'for') without matching ‘next

“for” statement error : missing “for” before “next”

(C18) illegal variable type (not integer or char)

Should be integer or char variable

499

Macro Reference

(C19) variable type error

Missing assign statement

(C20) must be keyword ‘to’ or ‘down’

Missing keyword “to” or “down”

(C21) illegal expression (no 'next')

The format of “for” statement is: for [variable] = [initial value] to [end value] [step] next [variable]

Any format other than this format will cause a compile error.

(C22) ‘wend’ statement contains no ‘while’

“While” statement error : missing “while” before “Wend”

(C23) illegal expression without matching ‘wend’

The format of “While” statement is : while [logic expression]

wend

Any format other than this format will cause a compile error.

(C24) syntax error : ‘break’

“break” statement can only be used in “for”, “while” statement.

(C25) syntax error : ‘continue’

“continue” statement can only be used in “for” statement, or “while” statement.

(C26) syntax error

Error in expression.

500

Macro Reference

(C27) syntax error

The mismatch of an operation object in expression can cause a compile error.

For example : macro_command main( ) int a, b for a = 0 to 2 b = 4 + xyz // illegal : xyz is undefined next a end macro_command

(C28) must be ‘macro_command’

There must be ’macro_command’

(C29) must be key word ‘sub’

The format of function declaration is: sub [data type] function_name(…)

………..

end sub

For example::

sub int pow(int exp)

…….

end sub

Any format other than this format will cause a compile error.

(C30) number of parameters is incorrect

Mismatch of the number of parameters

(C31) parameter type is incorrect

Mismatch of data type of parameter. When a function is called, the data type and the number of parameters should match the declaration of function, otherwise it will cause a compile error.

501

Macro Reference

(C32) variable is incorrect

The parameters of a function must be equivalent to the arguments passing to a function to avoid compile error.

(C33) function name : undeclared function

(C34) expected constant expression

Illegal array index format.

(C35) invalid array declaration

(C36) array index error

(C37) undeclared identifier : i ‘identifier’

Any variable or function should be declared before use.

(C38) u n-supported PLC data address

The parameter of GetData( … ) , SetData( … ) should be legal PLC address. If the address is illegal, this error message will be shown.

(C39) ‘idenifier’ must be integer, char or constant

The format of array is:

Declaration: array_name[constant] (constant is the size of the array)

Usage: array_name[integer, character or constant]

Any format other than this format will cause a compile error.

(C40) execution syntax should not exist before variable declaration or constant definition

For example : macro_command main( ) int a, b for a = 0 To 2

b = 4 + a int h , k // illegal – definitions must occur before any statements or expressions

// for example, b = 4 + a next a end macro_command

502

Macro Reference

(C41) float variables cannot be contained in shift calculation

(C42) function must return a value

(C43) function should not return a value

(C44) float variables cannot be contained in calculation

(C45) PLC address error

(C46) array size overflow (max. 4k)

(C47) macro command entry function is not only one

(C48) macro command entry function must be only one

The only one main entrance of macro is : macro_command function_name( ) end macro_command

(C49) an extended addressee’s station number must be between 0 and 255

For example :

SetData(bits[0] , “PLC 1”, LB , 300#123, 100)

// illegal : 300#123 means the station number is 300, but the maximum is 255

(C50) an invalid PLC name

PLC name is not defined in the device list of system parameters.

(C51) macro command do not control a remote device

A macro can only control a local machine.

For example :

SetData(bits[0] , “PLC 1”, LB , 300#123, 100)

“PLC 1“ is connected with the remote HMI ,so it can not work.

503

Macro Reference

18.12 Sample Macro Code

1. ”for” statement and other expressions (arithmetic, bitwise shift, logic and comparison)

macro_command main()

int a[10], b[10], i

b[0]= (400 + 400 << 2) / 401

b[1]= 22 *2 - 30 % 7

b[2]= 111 >> 2

b[3]= 403 > 9 + 3 >= 9 + 3 < 4 + 3 <= 8 + 8 == 8

b[4]= not 8 + 1 and 2 + 1 or 0 + 1 xor 2

b[5]= 405 and 3 and not 0

b[6]= 8 & 4 + 4 & 4 + 8 | 4 + 8 ^ 4

b[7]= 6 – (~4)

b[8]= 0x11

b[9]= 409 for i = 0 to 4 step 1 if (a[0] == 400) then

GetData(a[0],”Device 1”, 4x, 0,9)

GetData(b[0],”Device 1”, 4x, 11,10) end If

next i end macro_command

2. “while”, “if” and “break” statements

macro_command main()

int b[10], i i = 5 while i == 5 - 20 % 3

GetData(b[1], ”Device 1”, 4x, 11, 1) if b[1] == 100 then break end if

504

Macro Reference wend end macro_command

3. Global variables and function call

char g sub int fun(int j, int k)

int y

SetData(j, “Local HMI”, LB, 14, 1)

GetData(y, “Local HMI”, LB, 15, 1)

g = y return y end Sub macro_command main()

int a, b, i a = 2 b = 3

i = fun(a, b)

SetData(i, “Local HMI”, LB, 16, 1) end macro_command

4. ”if” statement

macro_command main()

int k[10], j

for j = 0 to 10 k[j] = j

next j

if k[0] == 0 then

SetData(k[1], “Device 1”, 4x, 0, 1)

end if

505

Macro Reference if k[0] == 0 then

SetData(k[1], “Device 1”, 4x, 0, 1)

else

SetData(k[2], “Device 1”, 4x, 0, 1) end if

if k[0] == 0 then

SetData(k[1], “Device 1”, 4x, 1, 1)

else if k[2] == 1 then

SetData(k[3], “Device 1”, 4x, 2, 1) end If

if k[0] == 0 then

SetData(k[1], “Device 1”, 4x, 3, 1) else if k[2] == 2 then

SetData(k[3], “Device 1”, 4x, 4, 1) else

SetData(k[4], “Device 1”, 4x, 5, 1) end If end macro_command

5. “while” and wend” statements

macro_command main()

char i = 0 int a[13], b[14], c = 4848

b[0] = 13 while b[0] a[i] = 20 + i * 10 if a[i] == 120 then c =200 break end if i = i + 1

506

Macro Reference

wend

SetData(c, “Device 1”, 4x, 2, 1) end macro_command

6. “break” and “continue” statements

macro_command main()

char i = 0

int a[13], b[14], c = 4848

b[0] = 13 while b[0] a[i] = 20 + i * 10 if a[i] == 120 then c =200 i = i + 1 continue end if i = i + 1 if c == 200 then

SetData(c, “Device 1”, 4x, 2, 1)

break end if wend end macro_command

7. Array

macro_command main()

int a[25], b[25], i b[0] = 13

507

Macro Reference

for i = 0 to b[0] step 1 a[i] = 20 + i * 10 next i

SetData(a[0], “Device 1”, 4x, 0, 13) end macro_command

508

Macro Reference

18.13 Macro TRACE Function

1. TRACE function is added to MACRO, and can be used with EasyDiagnoser, for viewing current content of the variable used.

The following illustrates how to use TRACE function in MACRO.

First of all, add macro_1 in the project, and in macro_1 add TRACE (“LW = %d”, a) . “%d” indicates to display current value of LW in decimal. The content of macro_1 is as the following: macro_command main() short a

GetData (a, "Local HMI" , LW, 0 , 1 ) a= a + 1

SetData (a, "Local HMI" , LW, 0 , 1 )

TRACE ( "LW0 = %d" , a) end macro_command

For the detailed usage of TRACE function, please refer to the illustration in the following paragraph.

509

Macro Reference

Secondly, add Numeric Display and Function Key objects in window 10 of the project. The settings of these objects are shown below. Function Key object is used to execute macro_1.

510

Macro Reference

Lastly, compile the completed project and execute Off-line or On-line simulation.

When processing simulation on PC, right click and select “Run EasyDiagnoser” in the pop-up menu.

Afterwards, EasyDiagnoser will be started. [Logger] window displays whether

EasyDiagnoser is able to connect with the HMI to be watched or not. [Output] window

511

Macro Reference displays the output of the TRACE function. The illustration below shows that

EasyDiagnoser succeeds in connecting with HMI.

When EasyDiagnoser is not able to connect with HMI, [Logger] window displays content as shown below:

512

Macro Reference

The possible reason of not being able to get connection with HMI can be failure in executing simulation on PC. Another reason is that the Port No. used in project for simulation on PC is incorrect (or occupied by system). Please change Port No. as shown, compile project then do simulation again.

When opening EasyDiagnoser, the Port No. should be set the same as that in project.

Only in this way can the communication succeed.

513

Macro Reference

The three successive ports of the project port no. are preserved for HMI communication.

Take the setting above as example, Port No. is set as 8005, therefore port 8005, 8006 and

8007 will be preserved. In this case when executing simulation on PC, please make sure that these ports are not occupied by other programs.

2. TRACE Syntax List:

Name

Syntax

TRACE

TRACE(format, argument)

Description Use this function to send specified string to the EasyDiagnoser. Users can print out the current value of variables during run-time of macro for debugging.

When TRACE encounters the first format specification (if any), it converts the value of the first argument after format and outputs it accordingly.

format refers to the format control of output string. A format specification, which consists of optional (in [ ]) and required fields (in bold), has the following form:

%[flags] [width] [.precision] type

Each field of the format specification is described as below:

flags (optional):

-

+

width (optional):

A nonnegative decimal integer controlling the minimum number of characters printed.

precision (optional):

A nonnegative decimal integer which specifies the precision and the number of characters to be printed.

type:

C or c : specifies a single-byte character. d : signed decimal integer. i : signed decimal integer. o : unsigned octal integer. u : unsigned decimal integer.

X or x : unsigned hexadecimal integer.

E or e : Signed value having the form.

514

Example

Macro Reference

[ – ]d .dddd e [sign]ddd where d is a single decimal digit, dddd is one or more decimal digits, ddd is exactly three decimal digits, and sign is + or –. f : Signed value having the form [ – ]dddd .dddd, where dddd is one or more decimal digits.

The length of output string is limited to 256 characters.

The argument part is optional. macro_command main() char c1 = ’a’ short s1 = 32767 float f1 = 1.234567

TRACE(“The results are”) // output: The results are

TRACE(“c1 = %c, s1 = %d, f1 = %f”, c1, s1, f1)

// output: c1 = a, s1 = 32767, f1 = 1.234567 end macro_command

3. Newly Added LB9059 – disable MACRO TRACE function (when ON)

When set ON, the output message of TRACE won't be sent to EasyDiagnoser.

4. Users can directly execute EasyDiagnoser.exe from Utility Manager. In Utility Manager, current HMI on line will be listed; users can simply select the HMI to be watched.

Please note that Project Port should be the same as Port No. used in project file.

515

Macro Reference

5. Download project to HMI to start operating. When EasyDiagnoser is unable to get connection with the HMI to be watched, it is possible that HMI power is not ON, or Port

No. is incorrect. This may cause EasyDiagnoser to connect then disconnect with HMI continuously. Please check if the Port No. in EasyDiagnoser settings is same as that of the project. The way to change it is described before.

6. When EasyDiagnoser succeeds in connecting with HMI, simply execute macro_1,

[Output] window will then display the output of the TRACE function.

516

Macro Reference

517

Macro Reference

18.14 The Usage of String Operation Functions

String operation functions are added to macro which provides users a more convenient way to operate strings. The term “string” means a sequence of ASCII characters, each of which occupies 1 byte. The sequence of characters can be stored into 16-bit registers with least significant byte first. For example, create an ASCII input object and setup as follows:

Run simulation and input “abcdef”:

The string “abcdef” is stored in LW0~LW2 as follows (LB represents low byte and HB represents high byte):

The ASCII input object reads 1 word (2 bytes) at a time as described in the previous chapter. Suppose an ASCII input object is set to read 3 words as shown in the above example, it can actually read at most 6 ASCII characters since that one ASCII character occupies 1 byte.

The functionality of each string operation function is described in the following table:

518

Macro Reference

Function name

StringGet

StringGetEx

StringSet

StringSetEx

StringCopy

StringMid

StringDecAsc2Bin

StringBin2DecAsc

StringDecAsc2Float

StringFloat2DecAsc

StringHexAsc2Bin

Description

Read string data from a device.

Read string data from a device and continue executing next command even if no response from that device.

Write string data to a device.

Write string data to a device and continue executing next command even if no response from that device.

Copy one string to another.

Retrieve a substring.

Convert a decimal string to an integer.

Convert an integer to a decimal string.

Convert a decimal string to floats.

Convert a float to a decimal string.

Convert a hexadecimal string to binary data.

StringBin2HexAsc

StringLength

StringCat

StringCompare

StringToUpper

StringToLower

StringToReverse

StringTrimLeft

Convert binary data into a hexadecimal string.

Obtain the length of a string.

Append source string to destination string.

Do a case-sensitive comparison of two strings.

StringCompareNoCase Do a case-insensitive comparison of two strings.

StringFind Find a substring inside a larger string.

StringReverseFind Find a substring inside a larger string; starts from the end.

StringFindOneOf

StringIncluding

Find the first matching character from a set.

Extracts a substring that contains only the characters in a set.

StringExcluding Extracts a substring that contains only the characters not in a set.

Convert the characters of a string to uppercase.

Convert the characters of a string to lowercase.

StringTrimRight

StringInsert

Reverse the characters of a string.

Trim the leading specified characters in a set from the source string.

Trim the trailing specified characters in a set from the source string.

Insert a string in a specific location within another string.

519

Macro Reference

For more detailed information of the above string operation functions, please check out the

“Build-In Function Block” section. In order to demonstrate the powerful usage of string operation functions, the following examples will show you step by step how to create executable project files using the new functions; starts from creating a macro, ends in executing simulation.

1. How to read (or write) a string from a device.

Create a new macro:

Edit the content:

The first function “StringGet” is used to read a string from LW0~LW19, and store it into the str array. The second function “StringSet” is used to output the content of str array.

Add ASCII Input and Function Key objects in window 10 of the project. The settings of these objects are shown as below. Function Key object is used to execute macro_1.

520

Macro Reference

521

Macro Reference

Lastly, compile the completed project and execute Off-line or On-line simulation. Follow the steps below to operate the executing project:

Step 1: input string

Step 2: press “GO” button

Step 3: output string

2. Initialization of a string.

Create a new macro and edit the content:

522

Macro Reference

The data enclosed in double quotation mark (“”) is viewed as a string. str1 is initialized as a string while str2 is initialized as a char array. The following snapshot of simulation shows the difference between str1 and str2 using two ASCII input objects.

Macro compiler will add a terminating null character (‘\0’) at the end of a string. The function “StringSet” will send each character of str1 to registers until a null character is reached. The extra characters following the null character will be ignored even if the data count is set to a larger value than the length of string.

On the contrary, macro compiler will not add a terminating null character (‘\0’) at the end of a char array. The actual number of characters of str2 being sent to registers depends on the value of data count that is passed to the “StringSet” function.

3. A simple login page.

Create a new macro and edit the content:

523

Macro Reference

The first two “StringGet” functions will read the strings input by users and store them into arrays named name_input and password_input separately. Use the function

“StringCompare” to check if the input account name and password are matched. If the account name is matched, name_match is set true; if the password is matched, password_match is set true. If both name_match and password_match are true, output the string “Success! Access Accepted.”. Otherwise, output the string “Fail! Access Denied.”.

Add ASCII Input and Function Key objects in window 10 of the project. The settings of these objects are shown as below. Function Key object is used to execute macro_1.

Object 2

Object 3

Object 1

Object 4

Object settings:

Object 1: Function Key

Object 2: ASCII Input

524

Macro Reference

Object 3: ASCII Input

525

Macro Reference

Object 4: ASCII Display

Lastly, compile the completed project and execute Off-line or On-line simulation. Follow the steps below to operate the executing project:

526

Macro Reference

527

Macro Reference

528

Macro Reference

18.15 Macro Password Protection

On MACRO editing window there’s the [Password protect] selection, tick it and click [Set password…] to set a password less than or equals to 10 characters (support ASCII character only, ex. “a$#*hFds”).

After setting MACRO password, users will have to input correct password when opening

MACRO editing window.

EasyBuilder Pro should be rebooted for typing the password again after 3 incorrect attempts.

529

Macro Reference

[Caution] When MACRO is password protected, decompilation of XOB file will not be able to restore MACRO contents.

530

Set HMI as a MODBUS Server

Chapter 19 Set HMI as a MODBUS Server

19.1 Setting HMI as MODBUS Device

Once HMI is set as MODBUS Server, the data of HMI can be read or written via MODBUS protocol.

Refer to the illustration above, it shows HMI is set as MODBUS Server. The HMI, PC or other devices can use MODBUS protocol to read or write the data from HMI via Ethernet or RS232/485 interface. Please follow the steps below.

531

Set HMI as a MODBUS Server

19.1.1 Creating a MODBUS Server

First of all, add a new device “MODBUS Server” in the [Device] tab of [System

Parameter Settings]. The [PLC I/F] can be set to RS232, RS485 2W, RS485 4W,

Ethernet.

532

Set HMI as a MODBUS Server

If [PLC I/F] is set to [RS232] or [RS485], please fill in [COM Port Settings] (COM 1~COM

3) and set correct communication parameters as shown below. MODBUS Server station no. is set to 1.

If [PLC I/F] is set to [Ethernet], the [IP address] is set as shown:

Please refer to HMI Port no. to set MODBUS Server Port no. Go to [Model] tab of

[System Parameter Settings], the HMI [Port no]. is shown there.

After finishing the setting, MODBUS Server will be listed in [Device] tab.

533

Set HMI as a MODBUS Server

You can send MODBUS command to read or write the data from MODBUS Server after downloading the XOB file to HMI.

534

Set HMI as a MODBUS Server

19.1.2 Read from / Write to MODBUS Server

HMI (the client) can read from / write to another HMI (the server) via MODBUS protocol.

Add a new device in the project of client. If client’s [PLC I/F] is set to [Ethernet], please select ”MODBUS TCP/IP” as [PLC type] and fill in the correct [IP] (the IP of server HMI) and [Port no.].

535

Set HMI as a MODBUS Server

If the client use [RS232/485] interface, the [PLC type] must be set to ”MODBUS RTU”.

Please make sure the communication parameter setting is correct.

Set and click [OK], a new device”MODBUS RTU” will be listed in the [Device] tab.

536

Set HMI as a MODBUS Server

In the setting page of each object, there is a “MODBUS RTU” in the [PLC name] selection list; you can then select appropriate device type and address.

Since the server is HMI, the corresponding read and write address are as follows: reading / writing 0x/1x(1~9999) reading / writing 3x/4x/5x(1~9999) to reading / writing LB(0~9998) to reading / writing LW(0~9998) reading / writing 3x/4x/5x(10000~75533) to reading / writing RW(0~65533)

537

Set HMI as a MODBUS Server

19.2 Changing the Station Number of a MODBUS Server in Runtime

Change the related reserved registers to modify the station number of a MODBUS Server

(HMI).

[LW-9541] The station number of a MODBUS server (COM 1)

[LW-9542] The station number of a MODBUS server (COM 2)

[LW-9543] The station number of a MODBUSI server (COM 3)

[LW-9544] The station number of a MODBUS server (Ethernet)

538

Set HMI as a MODBUS Server

19.3 About MODBUS Address Type

Address types under MODBUS protocol in EasyBuilder Pro are 0x, 1x, 3x, 4x, 5x, 6x,

3x_bit and 4x_bit.

Modbus RTU function code:

0x 0x01 Read coil

0x_multi_coils 0x01 Read coil

1x

3x

4x

5x

0x02 Read discrete input

0x04 Read input register

0x03 Read holding register

0x03 Read holding register

0x05 write single coil

0x0f write multiple coil

N/A for write operation

N/A for write operation

0x10 write multiple register

0x10

6x

3x_bit

0x03 Read holding register

0x04 Read input register

0x06 write single register

N/A for write operation

4X_bit

Note:

0x03 Read holding register 0x10 write multiple register

Address type “5x” is mapping to Hold Reg. The communication protocol of 5x is almost same as “4x” except “5x”makes double word swap.

If 4x contains following information

Address 1 2 3 4 5 6 ...

Data in word 0x1 0x2 0x3 0x4 0x5 0x6

Data 0x20001 0x40003 0x60005

For 5x, it becomes

Address 1 2 3 4 5 6 ...

Data in word 0x2 0x1 0x4 0x3 0x6 0x5

Data 0x10002 0x30004 0x50006

Address type 6x is limited to data of one word only.

 difference is that 3x_bit and 4x_bit read single bit of the whole data.

539

How to Connect a Barcode Device

Chapter 20 How to Connect a Barcode Device

Barcode interfaces:

20.1 How to Connect a Barcode Device

Weintek HMI support connecting barcode (USB/COM) device. Please add a new barcode device in [Edit]/ [System Parameter Settings]/ [Device list] first as shown below.

Click [Settings...] and finish

[Barcode

Device Settings]:

The settings are detailed respectively below.

540

How to Connect a Barcode Device

[COM][Baud rate][Data bits][Parity][Stop bits]

Barcode device can be connected to any of COM 1 ~ COM 3 or USB. When use COM interface, please set the communication parameters of barcode device accordingly.

When USB interface is used, the parameters needn’t to be set.

[Read byte limit]

This function will restrict the number of byte to read in order to prevent barcode device from reading too much data. The range is 10 ~ 512.

For example:

When [Read byte limit] is set to “10”, if the data the barcode device should read:

“0x34 0x39 0x31 0x32 0x30 0x30 0x34 0x37 0x30 0x38 0x33 0x38”.

(12 bytes)

Only the first 10 bytes will be read in this case.

“0x34 0x39 0x31 0x32 0x30 0x30 0x34 0x37 0x30 0x38”

[Use a start code]

With this function, HMI will only view the first data read by barcode device that identifies with start code to be legal input. Otherwise the data read will be ignored. All the data other than start code will be saved in designated address. Enter the decimal

ASCII value of the character.

For example: if the start code is 255(0xff), and original data read:

“ 0xff 0x34 0x39 0x31 0x32 0x30 0x30 0x34 0x37” ,

541

How to Connect a Barcode Device

The data saved in designated barcode device address will be:

“0x34 0x39 0x31 0x32 0x30 0x30 0x34 0x37”

[Terminator]

Terminator means the end of data, when terminator is detected; it stands for the end of data stream.

[CR/LF] 0x0a or 0x0d stands for the end of data.

[STX/ETX] 0x02 or 0x03 stands for the end of data.

[Other] User can set the terminator manually.

[None] HMI will save all read data to designated address of barcode device.

After completing all settings described above, a new “Barcode” device will be listed in the [Device list].

Now the barcode device can be selected in [PLC type] on the object parameters setting dialogue box. There are 2 types of address:

Address

type

Address

name

Description

Bit FLAG

FLAG 0 indicates the status of data reading. When reading data is complete, the status of FLAG 0 will be changed from OFF to ON. It will not return to OFF automatically, users are free to set base on actual usage.

Word BARCODE

BARCODE 0 Number of bytes currently read.

BARCODE 1 ~ n Store the data read by barcode device.

The following is a barcode device setting example, the barcode read is

9421007480830. BARCODE 0 is the address of “Numeric Display” object (bytes) and

BARCODE 1 ~ n is the address of “ASCII

Display” object (barcode).

542

How to Connect a Barcode Device

In the example the data stored by barcode device corresponding address are listed below:

Barcode corresponding address

Data

BARCODE 0

13 bytes (decimal)

The data saved in this address is 14 bytes = 7 words. If the number of byte is odd, system will add a byte (0x00) to make it even.

BARCODE 1

BARCODE 2

BARCODE 3

BARCODE 4

BARCODE 5

3439HEX

3132HEX

3030HEX

3437HEX

3038HEX

BARCODE 6

BARCODE 7

BARCODE 8

3338HEX

0030HEX empty

■ USB barcode interface does not support on-line simulation.

■ HMI now only supports barcode device to connect with one USB interface. When Device Table of project includes this kind of device, keyboard will be detected as barcode device, and LB-9064 will be set to ON automatically when power on. For restoring keyboard to normal function and to pause using barcode device, set

LB-9064 to OFF. For restoring barcode device, simply set LB-9064 to ON.

Please confirm your Internet connection before downloading the demo project.

543

Ethernet Communication and Multi-HMI Connection

Chapter 21 Ethernet Communication and Multi-HMI Connection

There are two ways of Ethernet communication:

1. Use RJ45 straight through cable + hub

2. Use RJ45 crossover cable and without hub, but this is limited to the condition of point to point connection (HMI to HMI or PC to HMI).

Through Ethernet network, EasyBuilder Pro provides the following methods for data transmission:

1. HMI to HMI communication

2. PC to HMI communication

3. Operating the PLC connected to other HMI

544

Ethernet Communication and Multi-HMI Connection

21.1 HMI to HMI Communication

In the communication between HMI A and HMI B, when using [set bit] object on

HMI A to control [LB-0] of HMI B:

1. Set the IP address of the two HMI, example: HMI A = 192.168.1.1, HMI B =

192.168.1.2

2. HMI A project /

[System Parameter Settings]

/ [Device list]

Add a remote HMI B.

IP 192.168.1.2

2. Set Bit / [PLC name]

select “HMI B” to control the address of remote HMI.

■ One HMI can handle requests from a maximum of other 64 HMI simultaneously.

545

Ethernet Communication and Multi-HMI Connection

21.2 PC to HMI Communication

With On-line Simulation Function, PC can collect data of HMI through Ethernet network and save the data files on PC.

PC can control HMI by operating system reserved register.

HMI can control PC, for example, commanding PC to save data from HMI or PLC.

Suppose PC is going to communicate with two HMI (HMI A and HMI B), the setting procedure of the project file on PC:

1. Set the IP address of the two HMI, example: HMI A = 192.168.1.1, HMI B =

192.168.1.2

2. PC project/

[System Parameter] /

[Device List], add remote HMI A &HMI B.

3. Set Bit /

[PLC name], select the device to be controlled, if it’s HMI A [LB], select

“HMI A”.

■ The number of HMI that a PC can control is not limited.

■HMI can control data on PC by considering PC another HMI. Add PC as a new Remote HMI device to the HMI MTP project and set the IP address of the

Remote HMI pointing to the PC.

546

Ethernet Communication and Multi-HMI Connection

21.3 Operate the PLC Connected with Other HMI

Through Ethernet network, PC or HMI can operate PLC that is connected to other

HMI; as shown above, a Mitsubishi PLC connected to COM 1of HMI B. When using

PC or HMI A to read PLC data, the procedure for setting PC or HMI A project:

1. Set HMI B IP, for example: 192.168.1.2

2. PC or HMI A project /

[System Parameter] /

[Device list], add a remote PLC, and set correct parameters.

Since this PLC is connected to remote

HMI B, set IP the same as HMI B (192.168.1.2).

3.

Set Bit/ [PLC

name] select “PLC on

HMI B” (remote PLC) to control the PLC connected to HMI B.

547

System Reserved Words/Bits

Chapter 22 System Reserved Words / Bits

Some Local Words and Local Bits are reserved for system usage. These registers are all with different functions described below:

548

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.1 The Address Ranges of Local HMI Memory

22.1.1 Bits

Memory

Local Memory

Bits

Device Type

LB

Local Word Bits LW_BIT

Range

0 ~ 12095

Retentive

Memory Bit

Index

Retentive

Memory Word

Bits

Retentive

Memory A Word

Bits

RBI

RW_Bit

RW_A_Bit

DDDDD

Format

0 ~ 1079915 DDDDDdd

DDDDD: address dd: bit no. (00 ~ 15)

0 ~ 65535f DDDDDh

DDDDD: address h: bit no. (0 ~ f)

Use LW-9000 as Index

Register, and correspond to RW_Bit

Example:

When LW-9000 = 1,

RBI-01 = RW_Bit-11

0 ~ 524287f DDDDDh

DDDDD: address

0 ~ 65535f h: bit no. (0 ~ f)

DDDDh

DDDDD: address h: bit no. (0 ~ f)

549

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.1.2 Words

Memory

Local Memory

Words

Retentive

Memory Words

Retentive

Memory Word

Index

Device Type

LW

RW

RWI

Range

0 ~ 10799

0 ~ 524287

0 ~ 65535

Retentive

Memory A Word

Extended

Memory Words

RW_A 0 ~ 65535

EM0 ~ EM9 0 ~

1073741823

DDDDD

Format

DDDDDD

DDDDD

Use LW-9000 as Index

Register, and correspond to RW

Example:

When LW-9000 = 10,

RWI-5 = RW-15

DDDDD

DDDDDDDDDD

Limited by device, max.

2G

550

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.2 HMI Time

Address Description

LW-9010 (16bit-BCD) : local second

LW-9011 (16bit-BCD) : local minute

LW-9012 (16bit-BCD) : local hour

LW-9013 (16bit-BCD) : local day

LW-9014 (16bit-BCD) : local month

LW-9015 (16bit-BCD) : local year

LW-9016 (16bit-BCD) : local week

LW-9017 (16bit) : local second

LW-9018 (16bit) : local minute

LW-9019 (16bit) : local hour

LW-9020 (16bit) : local day

LW-9021 (16bit) : local month

LW-9022 (16bit) : local year *Note 1

LW-9023 (16bit) : local week *Note 2

LW-9030 (32bit) : system time (unit : 0.1 second)

LW-9048 (16bit) : time (0 : AM, 1 : PM)

LW-9049 (16bit) : local hour (12-hour format) R/W

1. Value range: 2000~2049.

2. Value range: 1~7, stand for Monday ~ Sunday.

R/Y

R

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R

R

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

R/W

MACRO

R/Y

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R

R

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R

R

R

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

551

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.3 User Name and Password

Address Description

LB-9050 user logout

LB-9060 password error

LB-9061 update password (set ON)

LW-9219 (16bit) : user no. (1~12)

LW-9220 (32bit) : password

LW-9222 (16bit) : classes can be operated for current user (bit 0:A, bit 1:B,bit 2:C, ...)

LW-9500 (32bit) : user 1's password

LW-9502 (32bit) : user 2's password

LW-9504 (32bit) : user 3's password

LW-9506 (32bit) : user 4's password

LW-9508 (32bit) : user 5's password

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

W

MACRO

R/Y

Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

Y

R R R

W

R/W

R/W

R

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

LW-9510 (32bit) : user 6's password

LW-9512 (32bit) : user 7's password

LW-9514 (32bit) : user 8's password

LW-9516 (32bit) : user 9's password

LW-9518 (32bit) : user 10's password

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

LW-9520 (32bit) : user 11's password

LW-9522 (32bit) : user 12's password

R/W

R/W

R/W

LW-10754 (8 words) : current user name *Note 1

R/W

1. Only for Security / Enhanced security mode.

Y

R/Y

R/Y

R

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

Y

R/Y

R/Y

R

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

Please confirm your Internet connection before downloading the demo project.

552

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.4 Data Sampling

Address Description

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

MACRO

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

LB-9025

LB-9026

LB-9027 delete the earliest data sampling file on HMI memory (set ON) delete all data sampling files on HMI memory

(set ON) refresh data sampling information on HMI memory (set ON)

LB-9034 save event/data sampling to HMI, USB disk,

SD card (set ON)

LB-11949 delete the earliest data sampling file on SD card (set ON)

LB-11950 delete all data sampling files on SD card (set

ON)

LB-11951 refresh data sampling information on SD card

(set ON)

LB-11952 delete the earliest data sampling file on USB

(set ON)

LB-11953 delete all data sampling files on USB (set ON)

LB-11954 refresh data sampling information on USB

(set ON)

LW-9063 (16bit) : no. of data sampling files on HMI memory

LW-9064 (32bit) : size of data sampling files on HMI memory

LW-10489 (16bit) : no. of data sampling files on SD card

LW-10490 (32bit) : size of data sampling files on SD card

LW-10492 (16bit) : no. of data sampling files on USB

LW-10493 (32bit) : size of data sampling files on USB

W

W

W

W

W

W

W

W

W

W

R

R

R

R

R

R

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

R

R

R

R

R

R

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

R

R

R

R

R

R

553

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.5 Event Log

Address Description

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

W

MACRO

R/Y

Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

Y LB-9021

LB-9022

LB-9023

LB-9024

LB-9034 reset current event log (set ON) delete the earliest event log file on HMI memory (set ON) delete all event log files on HMI memory (set

ON) refresh event log information on HMI memory (set ON) save event/data sampling to HMI, USB disk,

SD card (set ON) acknowledge all alarm events (set ON) unacknowledged events exist (when ON)

LB-9042

LB-9043

LB-11940 delete the earliest event log file on SD card

(set ON)

LB-11941 delete all event log files on SD card (set ON)

LB-11942 refresh event log information on SD card (set

ON)

LB-11943 delete the earliest event log file on USB (set

ON)

LB-11944 delete all event log files on USB (set ON)

LB-11945 refresh event log information on USB (set ON)

LW-9060 (16bit) : no. of event log files on HMI memory

LW-9061 (32bit) : size of event log files on HMI memory

LW-9450 (16bit) : time tag of event log – second *Note1

LW-9451 (16bit) : time tag of event log – minute *Note1

LW-9452 (16bit) : time tag of event log – hour *Note1

LW-9453 (16bit) : time tag of event log – day *Note1

LW-9454 (16bit) : time tag of event log – month *Note1

LW-9455 (16bit) : time tag of event log – year *Note1

LW-10480 (16bit) : no. of event log files on SD card

LW-10481 (32bit) : size of event log files on SD card

LW-10483 (16bit) : no. of event log files on USB

LW-10484 (32bit) : size of event log files on USB

W

W

W

W

W

R

W

W

W

W

Y

Y

R

R

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R

R

R

R

W

W

R

R

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R

R

R

R

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

R

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

R

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

Y

R

R

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R

R

R

R

554

System Reserved Words/Bits

1. If LW-9450 ~ LW-9455 are used as tags of Event Log time source, please set [system parameters] / [General] correctly.

555

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.6 HMI Hardware Operation

Address Description

LB-9018 disable mouse cursor (set ON)

LB-9019 disable/enable buzzer

LB-9020 show (set ON)/ hide (set OFF) system setting bar

LB-9033 disable(when on)/enable (when off) HMI upload function *Note1

LB-9040 backlight up (set ON) *Note2

LB-9041 backlight down (set ON) *Note2

LB-9047 reboot HMI (set ON when LB9048 is on)

LB-9048 reboot-HMI protection

LB-9062 open hardware setting dialog (set ON)

LB-9063 disable(set ON)/enable(set OFF) popuping information dialog while finding an USB disk

LW-9008 (32bit-float) : battery voltage *Note3

LW-9025 (16bit) : CPU loading (x 100%)

LW-9026 (16bit) : OS version (year)

LW-9027 (16bit) : OS version (month)

LW-9028 (16bit) : OS version (day)

LW-9040 (16bit) : backlight index *Note2

LW-9080 (16bit) : backlight saver time (unit : minute)

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

R/W

MACRO

R/Y

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

R/Y

R/W R/Y R/Y

R/W

R/W

W

W

W

R/W

W

R/W

R

R

R

R

R

R

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

Y

Y

Y

R/Y

Y

R/Y

R

R

R

R

R

R

R/Y

R/Y

R

Y

Y

Y

R/Y

Y

R/Y

LW-9081 (16bit) : screen saver time (unit : minute) R/W R/Y R/Y

1. After changing the settings, please reboot HMI for updating.

2. LW-9040 used together with LB-9040 ~ LB-9041 can adjust the backlight brightness with level 0 ~ 31.

3. For LW-9008, when the battery voltage level goes below 2.89V, it is recommended to replace the battery.

R

R

R

R

R

R

R/Y

556

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.7 Local HMI Network Information

Address Description

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

MACRO

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

LW-9125 (16bit) : HMI ethernet gateway 0 (machine used only)

LW-9126 (16bit) : HMI ethernet gateway 1 (machine used only)

LW-9127 (16bit) : HMI ethernet gateway 2 (machine used only)

LW-9128 (16bit) : HMI ethernet gateway 3 (machine used only)

LW-9129 (16bit) : HMI ethernet IP 0 (machine used only)

LW-9130 (16bit) : HMI ethernet IP 1 (machine used only)

LW-9131 (16bit) : HMI ethernet IP 2 (machine used only)

LW-9132 (16bit) : HMI ethernet IP 3 (machine used only)

LW-9133 (16bit) : ethernet port no.

LW-9135 (16bit) : media access control (MAC) address 0

LW-1075

3

LW-9136 (16bit) : media access control (MAC) address 1

LW-9137 (16bit) : media access control (MAC) address 2

LW-9138 (16bit) : media access control (MAC) address 3

LW-9139 (16bit) : media access control (MAC) address 4

LW-9140 (16bit) : media access control (MAC) address 5

LW-1075 (16bit) : HMI ethernet Mask 0 (machine used

0 only)

LW-1075

1

LW-1075

2

(16bit) : HMI ethernet Mask 0 (machine used only)

(16bit) : HMI ethernet Mask 0 (machine used only)

(16bit) : HMI ethernet Mask 0 (machine used only)

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R

R

R

R

R

R

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R

R

R

R

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R

R

R

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R

R

R

R

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R

R

R

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

557

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.8 Recipe and Extended Memory

Address Description

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

W

MACRO

R/Y

Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

Y

W Y Y

LB-9028 reset all recipe data (set ON)

LB-9029 save all recipe data to machine (set ON)

LB-9460 EM0's storage device (SD card) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9461 EM1's storage device (SD card) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9462 EM2's storage device (SD card) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9463 EM3's storage device (SD card) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9464 EM4's storage device (SD card) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9465 EM5's storage device (SD card) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9466 EM6's storage device (SD card) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9467 EM7's storage device (SD card) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9468 EM8's storage device (SD card) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9469 EM9's storage device (SD card) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9470 EM0's storage device (USB disk) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9471 EM1's storage device (USB disk) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9472 EM2's storage device (USB disk) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9473 EM3's storage device (USB disk) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9474 EM4's storage device (USB disk) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9475 EM5's storage device (USB disk) does not exist

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

558

System Reserved Words/Bits

(when ON)

LB-9476 EM6's storage device (USB disk) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9477 EM7's storage device (USB disk) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9478 EM8's storage device (USB disk) does not exist

(when ON)

LB-9479 EM9's storage device (USB disk) does not exist

(when ON)

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

559

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.9 Storage Space Management

Address

LB-9035

Description

HMI free space insufficiency alarm (when ON)

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

R

MACRO

R/Y

R

Remote

HMI

R/Y

R

LB-9036 SD card free space insufficiency alarm (when

R R R

ON)

LB-9037 USB free space insufficiency alarm (when ON) R R R

LW-9070 (16bit) : free space insufficiency warning (Mega bytes)

R R R

LW-9071 (16bit) : reserved free space size (Mega bytes)

LW-9072 (32bit) : HMI current free space (K bytes)

LW-9074 (32bit) : SD current free space (K bytes)

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R LW-9076 (32bit) : USB current free space (K bytes) R

Want to know how to use LW-9072 ~ LW-9078 together with Backup object?

Please confirm your Internet connection before downloading the demo project.

560

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.10 Touch Position

Address Description

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

MACRO

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

LW-9041 (16bit) : touch status word(bit 0 on = user is touching the screen)

R R R

LW-9042 (16bit) : touch x position

LW-9043 (16bit) : touch y position

LW-9044 (16bit) : leave x position

LW-9045 (16bit) : leave y position

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

Want to know how to trigger relevant registers to change window with finger slide?

R

R

R

R

Please confirm your Internet connection before downloading the demo project.

561

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.11 Station Number Variables

Address Description

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

MACRO

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

R/W R/Y R/Y

LW-10000 (16bit) : var0 - station no variable (usage : var0#address)

LW-10001 (16bit) : var1 - station no variable (usage : var1#address)

LW-10002 (16bit) : var2 - station no variable (usage : var2#address)

LW-10003 (16bit) : var3 - station no variable (usage : var3#address)

LW-10004 (16bit) : var4 - station no variable (usage : var4#address)

LW-10005 (16bit) : var5 - station no variable (usage : var5#address)

LW-10006 (16bit) : var6 - station no variable (usage : var6#address)

LW-10007 (16bit) : var7 - station no variable (usage : var7#address)

LW-10008 (16bit) : var8 - station no variable (usage : var8#address)

LW-10009 (16bit) : var9 - station no variable (usage : var9#address)

LW-10010 (16bit) : var10 - station no variable (usage : var10#address)

LW-10011 (16bit) : var11 - station no variable (usage : var11#address)

LW-10012 (16bit) : var12 - station no variable (usage : var12#address)

LW-10013 (16bit) : var13 - station no variable (usage : var13#address)

LW-10014 (16bit) : var14 - station no variable (usage : var14#address)

LW-10015 (16bit) : var15 - station no variable (usage : var15#address)

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

Please confirm your Internet connection before downloading the demo project.

562

LW-9200 (16bit) : address index 0

LW-9201 (16bit) : address index 1

LW-9202 (16bit) : address index 2

LW-9203 (16bit) : address index 3

LW-9204 (16bit) : address index 4

LW-9205 (16bit) : address index 5

LW-9206 (16bit) : address index 6

LW-9207 (16bit) : address index 7

LW-9208 (16bit) : address index 8

LW-9209 (16bit) : address index 9

LW-9210 (16bit) : address index 10

LW-9211 (16bit) : address index 11

LW-9212 (16bit) : address index 12

LW-9213 (16bit) : address index 13

LW-9214 (16bit) : address index 14

LW-9215 (16bit) : address index 15

LW-9230 (32bit) : address index 16

LW-9232 (32bit) : address index 17

LW-9234 (32bit) : address index 18

LW-9236 (32bit) : address index 19

LW-9238 (32bit) : address index 20

LW-9240 (32bit) : address index 21

LW-9242 (32bit) : address index 22

LW-9244 (32bit) : address index 23

LW-9246 (32bit) : address index 24

LW-9248 (32bit) : address index 25

LW-9250 (32bit) : address index 26

LW-9252 (32bit) : address index 27

LW-9254 (32bit) : address index 28

LW-9256 (32bit) : address index 29

LW-9258 (32bit) : address index 30

LW-9260 (32bit) : address index 31

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.12 Index Register

Address Description

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

MACRO

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

563

System Reserved Words/Bits

Please confirm your Internet connection before downloading the demo project.

564

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.13 MTP File Information

Address Description

LW-9100 (16bit) : project name (16 words)

LW-9116 (32bit) : project size in bytes

LW-9118 (32bit) : project size in K bytes

LW-9120 (32bit) : compiler version

LW-9122 (16bit) : project compiled date [year]

LW-9123 (16bit) : project compiled date [month]

LW-9124 (16bit) : project compiled date [day]

R

R

R

R

R

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

R

R

MACRO

R/Y

R

R

Remote

HMI

R/Y

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

565

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.14 MODBUS Server Communication

Address Description

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

MACRO

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

LB-9055

LB-9056

MODBUS server (COM 1) receives a request

(when ON)

MODBUS server (COM 2) receives a request

(when ON)

LB-9057 MODBUS server (COM 3) receives a request

(when ON)

LB-9058 MODBUS server (ethernet) receives a request

(when ON)

LW-9270 (16bit) : request's function code - MODBUS server (COM 1)

LW-9271 (16bit) : request's starting address - MODBUS server (COM 1)

LW-9272 (16bit) : request's quantity of registers -

MODBUS server (COM 1)

LW-9275 (16bit) : request's function code - MODBUS server (COM 2)

LW-9276 (16bit) : request's starting address - MODBUS server (COM 2)

LW-9277 (16bit) : request's quantity of registers -

MODBUS server (COM 2)

LW-9280 (16bit) : request's function code - MODBUS server (COM 3)

LW-9281 (16bit) : request's starting address - MODBUS server (COM 3)

LW-9282 (16bit) : request's quantity of registers -

MODBUS server (COM 3)

LW-9285 (16bit) : request's function code - MODBUS server (ethernet)

LW-9286 (16bit) : request's starting address - MODBUS server (ethernet)

LW-9287 (16bit) : request's quantity of registers -

MODBUS server (ethernet)

LW-9541 (16bit) : MODBUS/ASCII server station no.

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R/W

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R/Y

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R/Y

566

System Reserved Words/Bits

(COM 1)

LW-9542 (16bit) : MODBUS/ASCII server station no.

(COM 2)

LW-9543 (16bit) : MODBUS/ASCII server station no.

(COM 3)

LW-9544 (16bit) : MODBUS/ASCII server station no.

(ethernet)

LW-9570 (32bit) : received data count (bytes) (COM 1

MODBUS server)

LW-9572 (32bit) : received data count (bytes) (COM 2

MODBUS server)

LW-9574 (32bit) : received data count (bytes) (COM 3

MODBUS server)

LW-9576 (32bit) : received data count (bytes) (Ethernet

MODBUS server)

R/W

R/W

R/W

R

R

R

R

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R

R

R

R

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R

R

R

R

567

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.15 Communication Parameters Settings

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Address Description

Local

HMI

MACRO

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

LB-9030 update COM 1 communication parameters (set

ON)

R/W R/Y R/Y

LB-9031 update COM 2 communication parameters (set

ON)

LB-9032 update COM 3 communication parameters (set

ON) disable/enable COM1 broadcast station no. LB-9065

LB-9066

LB-9067 disable/enable COM2 broadcast station no. disable/enable COM3 broadcast station no.

LW-9550 (16bit) : COM 1 mode(0:RS232,1:RS485

2W,2:RS485 4W)

LW-9551 (16bit) : COM 1 baud rate(7:1200,8:2400,0:4800,1:9600,2:19200,3:

38400,4:57600,..)

LW-9552 (16bit) : COM 1 databits (7 : 7 bits, 8 : 8 bits)

LW-9553 (16bit) : COM 1 parity (0:none, 1:even, 2:odd,

3:mark, 4:space)

LW-9554 (16bit) : COM 1 stop bits (1 : 1 bit, 2 : 2 bits)

LW-9555 (16bit) : COM 2 mode(0:RS232,1:RS485

2W,2:RS485 4W)

LW-9556 (16bit) : COM 2 baud rate(7:1200,8:2400,0:4800,1:9600,2:19200,3:

38400,4:57600,..)

LW-9557 (16bit) : COM 2 databits (7 : 7 bits, 8 : 8 bits)

LW-9558 (16bit) : COM 2 parity (0:none, 1:even, 2:odd,

3:mark, 4:space)

LW-9559 (16bit) : COM 2 stop bits (1 : 1 bit, 2 : 2 bits)

LW-9560 (16bit) : COM 3 mode(0:RS232,1:RS485 2W)

LW-9561 (16bit) : COM 3 baud rate(7:1200,8:2400,0:4800,1:9600,2:19200,3:

38400,4:57600,..)

LW-9562 (16bit) : COM 3 databits (7 : 7 bits, 8 : 8 bits)

LW-9563 (16bit) : COM 3 parity (0:none, 1:even, 2:odd,

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

568

System Reserved Words/Bits

3:mark, 4:space)

LW-9564 (16bit) : COM 3 stop bits (1 : 1 bit, 2 : 2 bits)

LW-9565 (16bit) : COM 1 broadcast station no.

LW-9566 (16bit) : COM 2 broadcast station no.

LW-9567 (16bit) : COM 3 broadcast station no.

LW-10500 (16bit) : PLC 1 timeout (unit : 100ms)

LW-10501 (16bit) : PLC 1 turn around delay (unit : ms)

LW-10502 (16bit) : PLC 1 send ACK delay (unit : ms)

LW-10503 (16bit) : PLC 1 parameter 1

LW-10504 (16bit) : PLC 1 parameter 2

LW-10505 (16bit) : PLC 2 timeout (unit : 100ms)

LW-10506 (16bit) : PLC 2 turn around delay (unit : ms)

LW-10507 (16bit) : PLC 2 send ACK delay (unit : ms)

LW-10508 (16bit) : PLC 2 parameter 1

LW-10509 (16bit) : PLC 2 parameter 2

LW-10510 (16bit) : PLC 3 timeout (unit : 100ms)

LW-10511 (16bit) : PLC 3 turn around delay (unit : ms)

LW-10512 (16bit) : PLC 3 send ACK delay (unit : ms)

LW-10513 (16bit) : PLC 3 parameter 1

LW-10514 (16bit) : PLC 3 parameter 2

LW-10515 (16bit) : PLC 4 timeout (unit : 100ms)

LW-10516 (16bit) : PLC 4 turn around delay (unit : ms)

LW-10517 (16bit) : PLC 4 send ACK delay (unit : ms)

(SIEMENS S7/400 Link type)

LW-10518 (16bit) : PLC 4 parameter 1 (SIEMENS S7/400 rack)

LW-10519 (16bit) : PLC 4 parameter 2 (SIEMENS

S7/400 CPU slot)

LW-10520 (16bit) : PLC 5 timeout (unit : 100ms)

LW-10521 (16bit) : PLC 5 turn around delay (unit : ms)

LW-10522 (16bit) : PLC 5 send ACK delay (unit : ms)

(SIEMENS S7/400 Link type)

LW-10523 (16bit) : PLC 5 parameter 1 (SIEMENS S7/400 rack)

LW-10524 (16bit) : PLC 5 parameter 2 (SIEMENS

S7/400 CPU slot)

LW-10525 (16bit) : PLC 6 timeout (unit : 100ms)

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

569

System Reserved Words/Bits

LW-10526 (16bit) : PLC 6 turn around delay (unit : ms)

LW-10527 (16bit) : PLC 6 send ACK delay (unit : ms)

(SIEMENS S7/400 Link type)

LW-10528 (16bit) : PLC 6 parameter 1 (SIEMENS S7/400 rack)

LW-10529 (16bit) : PLC 6 parameter 2 (SIEMENS S7/400

CPU slot)

LW-10530 (16bit) : PLC 7 timeout (unit : 100ms)

LW-10531 (16bit) : PLC 7 turn around delay (unit : ms)

LW-10532 (16bit) : PLC 7 send ACK delay (unit : ms)

(SIEMENS S7/400 Link type)

LW-10533 (16bit) : PLC 7 parameter 1 (SIEMENS S7/400 rack)

LW-10534 (16bit) : PLC 7 parameter 2 (SIEMENS

S7/400 CPU slot)

LW-10535 (16bit) : PLC 8 timeout (unit : 100ms)

LW-10536 (16bit) : PLC 8 turn around delay (unit : ms)

LW-10537 (16bit) : PLC 8 send ACK delay (unit : ms)

(SIEMENS S7/400 Link type)

LW-10538 (16bit) : PLC 8 parameter 1 (SIEMENS S7/400 rack)

LW-10539 (16bit) : PLC 8 parameter 2 (SIEMENS S7/400

CPU slot)

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

570

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.16 Communication Status with PLC (COM)

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Address

LB-9150

LB-9151

Description

Local

HMI

auto. connection for PLC 1 (COM1) (when ON) R/W auto. connection for PLC 2 (COM2) (when ON)

R/W

MACRO

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

LB-9152 auto. connection for PLC 3 (COM3) (when ON) R/W R/Y R/Y

LB-9200 PLC 1 status (SN0, COM1), set on to retry connection

R/W R/Y R/Y

LB-9201

R/W R/Y R/Y

LB-9202

LB-9203

LB-9204

LB-9205

LB-9206

LB-9207

LB-9500

LB-9501

LB-9502

LB-9503

LB-9504

LB-9505

LB-9506

PLC 1 status (SN1, COM1), set on to retry connection

PLC 1 status (SN2, COM1), set on to retry connection

PLC 1 status (SN3, COM1), set on to retry connection

PLC 1 status (SN4, COM1), set on to retry connection

PLC 1 status (SN5, COM1), set on to retry connection

PLC 1 status (SN6, COM1), set on to retry connection

PLC 1 status (SN7, COM1), set on to retry connection

PLC 2 status (SN0, COM2), set on to retry connection

PLC 2 status (SN1, COM2), set on to retry connection

PLC 2 status (SN2, COM2), set on to retry connection

PLC 2 status (SN3, COM2), set on to retry connection

PLC 2 status (SN4, COM2), set on to retry connection

PLC 2 status (SN5, COM2), set on to retry connection

PLC 2 status (SN6, COM2), set on to retry connection

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

571

LB-9507

LB-9800

LB-9801

LB-9802

LB-9803

LB-9804

LB-9805

LB-9806

LB-9807

System Reserved Words/Bits

PLC 2 status (SN7, COM2), set on to retry connection

PLC 3 status (SN0, COM3), set on to retry connection

PLC 3 status (SN1, COM3), set on to retry connection

PLC 3 status (SN2, COM3), set on to retry connection

PLC 3 status (SN3, COM3), set on to retry connection

PLC 3 status (SN4, COM3), set on to retry connection

PLC 3 status (SN5, COM3), set on to retry connection

PLC 3 status (SN6, COM3), set on to retry connection

PLC 3 status (SN7, COM3), set on to retry connection

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

572

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.17 Communication Status with PLC (Ethernet)

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Address Description Local

HMI

MACRO

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

LB-9153 auto. connection for PLC 4 (ethernet) (when

ON)

R/W R/Y R/Y

LB-9154

LB-9155

LB-9156

LB-9157

LB-9158 auto. connection for PLC 5 (ethernet) (when

ON) auto. connection for PLC 6 (ethernet) (when

ON) auto. connection for PLC 7 (ethernet) (when

ON) auto. connection for PLC 8 (ethernet) (when

ON) auto. connection for PLC 9 (ethernet) (when

ON)

LB-10070 forced to reconnect PLC 4 (ethernet) when IP or system parameters changed on-line (set

ON)

LB-10071 forced to reconnect PLC 5 (ethernet) when IP or system parameters changed on-line (set

ON)

LB-10072 forced to reconnect PLC 6 (ethernet) when IP or system parameters changed on-line (set

ON)

LB-10073 forced to reconnect PLC 7 (ethernet) when IP or system parameters changed on-line (set

ON)

LB-10074 forced to reconnect PLC 8 (ethernet) when IP or system parameters changed on-line (set

ON)

LB-10075 forced to reconnect PLC 9 (ethernet) when IP or system parameters changed on-line (set

ON)

LB-10100 PLC 4 status (ethernet), set on to retry connection

LB-10400 PLC 5 status (ethernet), set on to retry

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

573

System Reserved Words/Bits connection

LB-10700 PLC 6 status (ethernet), set on to retry connection

LB-11000 PLC 7 status (ethernet), set on to retry connection

LB-11300 PLC 8 status (ethernet), set on to retry connection

LB-11600 PLC 9 status (ethernet), set on to retry connection

LB-11900 PLC 10 status (ethernet), set on to retry connection

LB-11901 PLC 11 status (ethernet), set on to retry connection

LB-11902 PLC 12 status (ethernet), set on to retry connection

LB-11903 PLC 13 status (ethernet), set on to retry connection

LB-11904 PLC 14 status (ethernet), set on to retry connection

LB-11905 PLC 15 status (ethernet), set on to retry connection

LB-11906 PLC 16 status (ethernet), set on to retry connection

LW-9600 (16bit) : PLC 4's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9601 (16bit) : PLC 4's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9602 (16bit) : PLC 4's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9603 (16bit) : PLC 4's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9604 (16bit) : PLC 4's port no.

LW-9605 (16bit) : PLC 5's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9606 (16bit) : PLC 5's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9607 (16bit) : PLC 5's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

574

System Reserved Words/Bits

LW-9608 (16bit) : PLC 5's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9609 (16bit) : PLC 5's port no.

LW-9610 (16bit) : PLC 6's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9611 (16bit) : PLC 6's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9612 (16bit) : PLC 6's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9613 (16bit) : PLC 6's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9614 (16bit) : PLC 6's port no.

LW-9615 (16bit) : PLC 7's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9616 (16bit) : PLC 7's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9617 (16bit) : PLC 7's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9618 (16bit) : PLC 7's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9619 (16bit) : PLC 7's port no.

LW-9620 (16bit) : PLC 8's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9621 (16bit) : PLC 8's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9622 (16bit) : PLC 8's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9623 (16bit) : PLC 8's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9624 (16bit) : PLC 8's port no.

LW-9625 (16bit) : PLC 9's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9626 (16bit) : PLC 9's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9627 (16bit) : PLC 9's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9628 (16bit) : PLC 9's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

575

System Reserved Words/Bits

LW-9629 (16bit) : PLC 9's port no. R/W R/Y R/Y

576

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.18 Communication Status with PLC (USB)

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Address

LB-9190

LB-9191

Description

auto. connection for PLC (USB) (when ON)

PLC status (USB), set on to retry connection

Local

HMI

R/W

R/W

MACRO

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

577

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.19 Communication Status with PLC (CAN Bus)

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Address Description

Local

HMI

MACRO

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

LB-12080 Auto. connection for PLC (CAN Bus) (when

ON)

R/W R/Y R/Y

LB-12081 PLC status (CAN Bus) set on to retry conneciton

R/W R/Y R/Y

578

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.20 Communication Status with Remote HMI

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Address

LB-9068

LB-9069

LB-9070

LB-9071

LB-9072

LB-9073

LB-9074

LB-9075

Description

auto. connection for remote HMI 1 (when ON) auto. connection for remote HMI 2 (when ON) auto. connection for remote HMI 3 (when ON) auto. connection for remote HMI 4 (when ON) auto. connection for remote HMI 5 (when ON) auto. connection for remote HMI 6 (when ON) auto. connection for remote HMI 7 (when ON) auto. connection for remote HMI 8 (when ON)

Local

HMI

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

MACRO

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

LB-9100 remote HMI 1 status (set on to retry connection)

R/W R/Y R/Y

LB-9101

LB-9102

LB-9103

LB-9104

LB-9105

LB-9106

LB-9107

LB-9149 remote HMI 2 status (set on to retry connection) remote HMI 3 status (set on to retry connection) remote HMI 4 status (set on to retry connection) remote HMI 5 status (set on to retry connection) remote HMI 6 status (set on to retry connection) remote HMI 7 status (set on to retry connection) remote HMI 8 status (set on to retry connection) forced to reconnect remote HMI when IP changed on-line (set ON)

LW-9800 (16bit) : remote HMI 1's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9801 (16bit) : remote HMI 1's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9802 (16bit) : remote HMI 1's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9803 (16bit) : remote HMI 1's IP3 (IP address =

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

579

System Reserved Words/Bits

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9804 (16bit) : remote HMI 1's port no.

LW-9805 (16bit) : remote HMI 2's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9806 (16bit) : remote HMI 2's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9807 (16bit) : remote HMI 2's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9808 (16bit) : remote HMI 2's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9809 (16bit) : remote HMI 2's port no.

LW-9810 (16bit) : remote HMI 3's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9811 (16bit) : remote HMI 3's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9812 (16bit) : remote HMI 3's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9813 (16bit) : remote HMI 3's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9814 (16bit) : remote HMI 3's port no.

LW-9815 (16bit) : remote HMI 4's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9816 (16bit) : remote HMI 4's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9817 (16bit) : remote HMI 4's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9818 (16bit) : remote HMI 4's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9819 (16bit) : remote HMI 4's port no.

LW-9820 (16bit) : remote HMI 5's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9821 (16bit) : remote HMI 5's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9822 (16bit) : remote HMI 5's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9823 (16bit) : remote HMI 5's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9824 (16bit) : remote HMI 5's port no.

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

580

System Reserved Words/Bits

LW-9825 (16bit) : remote HMI 6's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9826 (16bit) : remote HMI 6's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9827 (16bit) : remote HMI 6's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9828 (16bit) : remote HMI 6's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9829 (16bit) : remote HMI 6's port no.

LW-9830 (16bit) : remote HMI 7's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9831 (16bit) : remote HMI 7's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9832 (16bit) : remote HMI 7's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9833 (16bit) : remote HMI 7's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9834 (16bit) : remote HMI 7's port no.

LW-9835 (16bit) : remote HMI 8's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9836 (16bit) : remote HMI 8's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9837 (16bit) : remote HMI 8's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9838 (16bit) : remote HMI 8's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9839 (16bit) : remote HMI 8's port no.

LW-9905 (16bit) : remote HMI 21’s IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9906 (16bit) : remote HMI 21’s IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9907 (16bit) : remote HMI 21’s IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9908 (16bit) : remote HMI 21’s IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9909 (16bit) : remote HMI 21’s port no.

LW-9910 (16bit) : remote HMI 22’s IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

581

System Reserved Words/Bits

LW-9911 (16bit) : remote HMI 22’s IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9912 (16bit) : remote HMI 22’s IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9913 (16bit) : remote HMI 22’s IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9914 (16bit) : remote HMI 22’s port no.

LW-9915 (16bit) : remote HMI 23’s IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9916 (16bit) : remote HMI 23’s IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9917 (16bit) : remote HMI 23’s IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9918 (16bit) : remote HMI 23’s IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9919 (16bit) : remote HMI 23’s port no.

LW-9920 (16bit) : remote HMI 24’s IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9921 (16bit) : remote HMI 24’s IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9922 (16bit) : remote HMI 24’s IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9923 (16bit) : remote HMI 24’s IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9924 (16bit) : remote HMI 24’s port no.

LW-9925 (16bit) : remote HMI 25’s IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9926 (16bit) : remote HMI 25’s IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9927 (16bit) : remote HMI 25’s IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9928 (16bit) : remote HMI 25’s IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9929 (16bit) : remote HMI 25’s port no.

LW-9930 (16bit) : remote HMI 26’s IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9931 (16bit) : remote HMI 26’s IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

582

System Reserved Words/Bits

LW-9932 (16bit) : remote HMI 26’s IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9933 (16bit) : remote HMI 26’s IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9934 (16bit) : remote HMI 26’s port no.

LW-9935 (16bit) : remote HMI 27’s IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9936 (16bit) : remote HMI 27’s IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9937 (16bit) : remote HMI 27’s IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9938 (16bit) : remote HMI 27’s IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9939 (16bit) : remote HMI 27’s port no.

LW-9940 (16bit) : remote HMI 28’s IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9941 (16bit) : remote HMI 28’s IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9942 (16bit) : remote HMI 28’s IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9943 (16bit) : remote HMI 28’s IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9944 (16bit) : remote HMI 28’s port no.

LW-9945 (16bit) : remote HMI 29’s IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9946 (16bit) : remote HMI 29’s IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9947 (16bit) : remote HMI 29’s IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9948 (16bit) : remote HMI 29’s IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9949 (16bit) : remote HMI 29’s port no.

LW-9950 (16bit) : remote HMI 30’s IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9951 (16bit) : remote HMI 30’s IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9952 (16bit) : remote HMI 30’s IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

583

System Reserved Words/Bits

LW-9953 (16bit) : remote HMI 30’s IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9954 (16bit) : remote HMI 30’s port no.

LW-9955 (16bit) : remote HMI 31’s IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9956 (16bit) : remote HMI 31’s IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9957 (16bit) : remote HMI 31’s IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9958 (16bit) : remote HMI 31’s IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9959 (16bit) : remote HMI 31’s port no.

LW-9960 (16bit) : remote HMI 32’s IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9961 (16bit) : remote HMI 32’s IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9962 (16bit) : remote HMI 32’s IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9963 (16bit) : remote HMI 32’s IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9964 (16bit) : remote HMI 32’s port no.

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

584

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.21 Communication Status with Remote PLC

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Address Description

Local

HMI

MACRO

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

LW-10050 (16bit) : IP0 of the HMI connecting to remote

PLC 1 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

R/W R/Y R/Y

LW-10051 (16bit) : IP1 of the HMI connecting to remote

PLC 1 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10052 (16bit) : IP2 of the HMI connecting to remote

PLC 1 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10053 (16bit) : IP3 of the HMI connecting to remote

PLC 1 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10054 (16bit) : port no. of the HMI connecting to remote PLC 1

LW-10055 (16bit) : IP0 of the HMI connecting to remote

PLC 2 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10056 (16bit) : IP1 of the HMI connecting to remote

PLC 2 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10057 (16bit) : IP2 of the HMI connecting to remote

PLC 2 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10058 (16bit) : IP3 of the HMI connecting to remote

PLC 2 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10059 (16bit) : port no. of the HMI connecting to remote PLC 2

LW-10060 (16bit) : IP0 of the HMI connecting to remote

PLC 3 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10061 (16bit) : IP1 of the HMI connecting to remote

PLC 3 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10062 (16bit) : IP2 of the HMI connecting to remote

PLC 3 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10063 (16bit) : IP3 of the HMI connecting to remote

PLC 3 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10064 (16bit) : port no. of the HMI connecting to remote PLC 3

LW-10065 (16bit) : IP0 of the HMI connecting to remote

PLC 4 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10066 (16bit) : IP1 of the HMI connecting to remote

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

585

System Reserved Words/Bits

PLC 4 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10067 (16bit) : IP2 of the HMI connecting to remote

PLC 4 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10068 (16bit) : IP3 of the HMI connecting to remote

PLC 4 (IP address = IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10069 (16bit) : port no. of the HMI connecting to remote PLC 4

LW-10300 (16bit) : remote PLC 1's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10301 (16bit) : remote PLC 1's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10302 (16bit) : remote PLC 1's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10303 (16bit) : remote PLC 1's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10304 (16bit) : remote PLC 1's port no.

LW-10305 (16bit) : remote PLC 2's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10306 (16bit) : remote PLC 2's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10307 (16bit) : remote PLC 2's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10308 (16bit) : remote PLC 2's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10309 (16bit) : remote PLC 2's port no.

LW-10310 (16bit) : remote PLC 3's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10311 (16bit) : remote PLC 3's IP1 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10312 (16bit) : remote PLC 3's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10313 (16bit) : remote PLC 3's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10314 (16bit) : remote PLC 3's port no.

LW-10315 (16bit) : remote PLC 4's IP0 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10316 (16bit) : remote PLC 4's IP1 (IP address =

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

586

System Reserved Words/Bits

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10317 (16bit) : remote PLC 4's IP2 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10318 (16bit) : remote PLC 4's IP3 (IP address =

IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-10319 (16bit) : remote PLC 4's port no.

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

587

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.22 Communication Error Messages & No. of Pending Cmd.

Read/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Address Description

LW-9350 (16bit) : pending command no. in local HMI

Local

HMI

R

MACRO

R/Y

R

Remote

HMI

R/Y

R

LW-9351 (16bit) : pending command no. in PLC 1 (COM

1)

R R R

LW-9352 (16bit) : pending command no. in PLC 2 (COM

2)

LW-9353 (16bit) : pending command no. in PLC 3 (COM

3)

LW-9354 (16bit) : pending command no. in PLC 4

(ethernet)

LW-9355 (16bit) : pending command no. in PLC 5

(ethernet)

LW-9356 (16bit) : pending command no. in PLC 6

(ethernet)

LW-9357 (16bit) : pending command no. in PLC 7

(ethernet)

LW-9390 (16bit) : pending command no. in PLC (USB)

LW-9392 (16bit) : pending command no. in PLC (CAN

Bus)

LW-9400 (16bit) : error code for PLC 1

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

LW-9401 (16bit) : error code for PLC 2

LW-9402 (16bit) : error code for PLC 3

LW-9403 (16bit) : error code for PLC 4

LW-9404 (16bit) : error code for PLC 5

LW-9405 (16bit) : error code for PLC 6

LW-9406 (16bit) : error code for PLC 7

LW-9407 (16bit) : error code for PLC 8

LW-9490 (16bit) : error code for USB PLC

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

588

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.23 Miscellaneous Functions

Address Description

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

MACRO

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

LB-9000 ~

LB-9009

LB-9010

LB-9011

LB-9012

LB-9016

LB-9017

LB-9039

LB-9045 initialized as ON data download indicator data upload indicator data download/upload indicator status is on when a client connects to this HMI disable write-back in PLC control's [change window] status of file backup activity (backup in process if

ON) memory-map communication fails (when ON)

R/W

R

R

R

R

R/W

R

R

R/Y

R

R

R

R

R/Y

R

R

R/Y

R

R

R

R

R/Y

R

R

LB-9049

LB-9059 enable (set ON)/disable (set OFF) watch dog

*Note1 disable MACRO TRACE function (when ON)

*Note2

LB-9064 enable USB barcode device (disable keyboard)

(when ON) *Note3

LW-9006 (16bit) : connected client no.

LW-9024 (16bit) : memory link system register

LW-9032 (8 words) : folder name of backup history files to

SD, USB memory

LW-9050 (16bit) : current base window ID

LW-9134 (16bit) : language mode *Note4

LW-9141 (16bit) : HMI station no.

LW-9216 (16bit) : the result of importing email data

LW-9300 (16bit) : driver ID of local PLC 1

LW-9301 (16bit) : driver ID of local PLC 2

LW-9302 (16bit) : driver ID of local PLC 3

LW-9303 (16bit) : driver ID of local PLC 4

LW-9530 (8 words) : VNC server password

R/W

R/W

R/W

R

R/W

R/W

R

R/W

R/W

R

R

R

R

R

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R

R/Y

R/Y

R

R/Y

R/Y

R

R

R

R

R

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R

R

R/Y

R/Y

R

R/Y

R/Y

R

R

R

R

R

R/Y

589

System Reserved Words/Bits later.

1. When LB-9049 watch dog function is enabled, if there’s a failure in communication for HMI, system will reboot 10 seconds

2. LB-9059 Demonstration Project

3. LB-9064 Demonstration Project

4. When users would like to have the object’s text to show multi-language, except for using Label Library, it needs to use the system reserved register

[LW-9134: language mode]. The value of LW-9134 can be set from 0 to 23.

Different data of LW-9134 corresponds to different Languages numbered from

1 to 24. The way of using LW-9134 will differ if the languages are not all chosen when compiling the downloaded file.

For example: If 5 languages are defined by user in Label Library as Language

1 (Traditional Chinese), Language 2 (Simplified Chinese), Language 3

(English), Language 4 (French), and Language 5 (Japanese). If only Language

1, 3, 5 are downloaded by user, the corresponding language of the value in

LW-9134 will be 0 -> Language 1 (Traditional Chinese), 1 -> Language 3

(English), 2 -> Language 5 (Japanese).

Want to know how to swith languages using Option List object toghther with

LW-9134?

Please confirm your Internet connection before downloading the demo project.

590

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.24 Remote Print/Backup Server

Address Description

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

MACRO

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

LB-10069 forced to reconnect remote printer/backup server when IP changed on-line (set ON)

LW-9770 (16bit) : remote printer/backup server IP0

(IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

LW-9771 (16bit) : remote printer/backup server IP1

(IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9772 (16bit) : remote printer/backup server IP2

(IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

LW-9773 (16bit) : remote printer/backup server IP3

(IP0:IP1:IP2:IP3)

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

LW-9774 (6 words) : remote printer/backup server user name *Note1

R/W R/Y R/Y

LW-9780 (6 words) : remote printer/backup server password *Note1

R/W R/Y R/Y

1. When change settings using LW-9774 and LW9780, please reboot HMI to enable the new settings.

Please confirm your Internet connection before downloading the demo project.

591

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.25 EasyAccess

Address Description

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

MACRO

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

LB-9051

LB-9052

LB-9196 disconnect (set OFF)/connect (set ON)

EasyAccess server status of connecting to EasyAccess server local HMI supports monitor function only (when

ON)

R/W

R

R/W

R/Y

R

R/Y

R/Y

R

R/Y

LB-9197 support monitor function only for remote HMIs

R/W R/Y

(when ON)

For further information on EasyAccess, please visit http://www.ihmi.net/

.

R/Y

592

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.26 Pass-Through Settings

Address Description

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

MACRO

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

LW-9900 (16bit) : HMI run mode (0 : normal mode, 1~3 : test mode (COM 1~COM 3)

LW-9901 (16bit) : pass-through source COM port (1~3 :

COM 1~COM 3)

LW-9902 (16bit) : pass-through destination COM port

(1~3 : COM 1~COM 3)

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

593

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.27 Disable PLC No Response Dialog Box

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Address Description

Local

HMI

MACRO

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

LB-9192 disable USB PLC's "PLC No Response" dialog

(when ON)

R/W R/Y R/Y

LB-11960 disable PLC 1's "PLC No Response" dialog

(when ON)

LB-11961 disable PLC 2's "PLC No Response" dialog

(when ON)

LB-11962 disable PLC 3's "PLC No Response" dialog

(when ON)

LB-11963 disable PLC 4's "PLC No Response" dialog

(when ON)

LB-11964 disable PLC 5's "PLC No Response" dialog

(when ON)

LB-11965 disable PLC 6's "PLC No Response" dialog

(when ON)

LB-11966 disable PLC 7's "PLC No Response" dialog

(when ON)

LB-11967 disable PLC 8's "PLC No Response" dialog

(when ON)

LB-12082 Disable CAN Bus device’s “PLC No Response” dialog (when ON)

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

594

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.28 HMI and Project Key

Address Description

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

MACRO

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

LB-9046 project key is different from HMI key (when

ON)

R R R

LW-9046 (32bit) : HMI key *Note1 R/W R/Y R

1. When change HMI key using LW-9046, please reboot HMI to enable the new settings.

Please confirm your Internet connection before downloading the demo project.

595

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.29 Fast Selection Window Control

Address Description

LB-9013 FS window control[hide(ON)/show(OFF)]

LB-9014 FS button control[hide(ON)/show(OFF)]

LB-9015 FS window/button control[hide(ON)/show(OFF)]

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

R/W

R/W

MACRO

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/W R/Y R/Y

596

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.30 Input Object Function

Address Description

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Local

HMI

R

R

MACRO

R/Y

R

R

Remote

HMI

R/Y

R

R

LW-9002 (32bit-float) : input high limit

LW-9004 (32bit-float) : input low limit

LW-9052 (32bit-float) : the previous input value of the numeric input object

LW-9150 (32 words) : keyboard's input data (ASCII)

LW-9540 (16bit) : reserved for caps lock

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R

597

System Reserved Words/Bits

22.31 Local/Remote Operation Restrictions

Read(R)/Write(W)/Control(Y)

Address Description

LB-9044 disable remote control (when ON)

Local

HMI

R/W

MACRO

R/Y

R/Y

Remote

HMI

R/Y

R/Y

LB-9053 prohibit password remote-read operation (when

ON)

R/W R/Y R/Y

LB-9054

LB-9196

LB-9197

LB-9198

LB-9199 prohibit password remote-write operation (when

ON) local HMI supports monitor function only (when

ON) support monitor function only for remote HMIs

(when ON) disable local HMI to trigger a MACRO (when

ON) disable remote HMI to trigger a MACRO (when

ON)

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/W

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

R/Y

598

HMI Supported Printers

Chapter 23 HMI Supported Printers

23.1 The Supported Printer Types

HMI supported printer drivers include the following types:

EPSON compatible serial printers, please configure communication parameters to match the printer.

The EPSON ESC/P2 printer protocol is used.

Impact Printer:

LQ-300, LQ-300+, LQ-300K+

(RS232)

LQ-300+II (RS232)

Inkjet Printer:

Stylus Photo 750

Laser Printer:

EPL-5800

HP compatible USB printers that support HP PCL5 level 3 protocol.

PCL 5 was released on HP

LaserJet III in March 1990, added Intellifont font scaling

(developed by Compugraphic, now part of Agfa), outline fonts and HP-GL/2 (vector) graphics.

PCL 5e (PCL 5 enhanced) was released on HP LaserJet 4 in October 1992 and added bi-directional communication between printer and PC, and

Windows fonts.

Please check if HP printer supports PCL5 before connecting with HMI, otherwise HMI black screen

may occur.

599

HMI Supported Printers

Serial printers, please configure communication parameters to match the printer. The Pixels of Width must be correctly set and can’t exceed printer default setting:

100 pixels for 1610

220 pixels for 2407, 4004

EPSON ESC Protocol Serial

Micro Printer:

SIUPO (Beijing) http://www.siupo.com

SP-M, D, E, F Series

SP-E1610SK (paper width

45mm), SP-E400-4S (paper width 57.5mm)

Recommended SP printer type for customers outside China.

Micro printer from France connects via serial port; please configure communication parameters to match the printer.

Serial printers, please configure communication parameters to match the printer. The Pixels of Width must be correctly set and can’t exceed printer default setting

“576”:

Serial printers, please configure communication parameters to match the printer. The

Pixels of Width must be correctly set and can’t exceed printer default setting

“100”:

SP-DN40SH Dot Matrix Printer

SP-RMDIII40SH Thermal

Printer

600

HMI Supported Printers

Use EasyPrinter to start printing for the printers connected with PC via

Ethernet. This works under MS

Windows so the most printers on market are supported.

Serial printers, please configure communication parameters to match the printer.

Serial printers, please configure communication parameters to match the printer. The paper cutting mode can be selected:

[No

cut], [Half cut], and [Full cut].

601

HMI Supported Printers

23.2 How to Add a New Printer and Start Printing

23.2.1 Add Printer Type

[System Parameter Settings] / [Model] select printer type and set relevant parameters.

To connect Remote Printer

Server, go

[System Parameter

Settings] / [Printer/Backup

Server], and set parameters correctly.

602

HMI Supported Printers

23.2.2 Start Printing

Start printing with Function Key.

Or, use PLC Control

[Screen hardcopy] to start printing by predefined bit registers.

603

Recipe Editor

Chapter 24 Recipe Editor

24.1 Introduction

Recipe Editor is used to create, view, edit Recipe (*.rcp) and EMI (*.emi) files

HMI. Open Utility Manager and click

[Recipe/Extended Memory Editor].

EasyBuilder Pro also provides another for editing recipe: Recipe Records, this can be found in EasyBuilder Pro System

Paramter Settings / Recipe tab and can used with Recipe View Object. The following introduces the usage of these two editing tools. and for tool tool be

24.2 Recipe / Extended Memory Editor Setting

How to add new *.rcp / *.emi files?

Set Address Range -> Select Data Format

[Select your data format]

Save the specified data format for next time loading. The saved file name:

“dataEX.fmt” under EasyBuilder Pro installation directory.

[Address range]

Fill in address range, the unit is “word”.

[Data format]

Edit new data format in this field.

604

Recipe Editor

1.

Click [Add].

[Description]

Input the name of the data type.

[Data format] Select data format. If select [String], please input the length

(words) and ASCII/Unicode.

2. After setting, click

[OK] to start editing recipe data.

605

Recipe Editor

3. In this example, the total length of data format is 23 words and will be seen as one set of recipe data.

The first set: “recipe no.” = address 0, ”product” = address 1 ~ 10, ”price” = address 11 ~

12, "barcode” = address 13 ~ 22;

The second set: “recipe no.” = address 23, ”product” = address 24 ~ 33, "price” = address

34 ~ 35, "barcode” = address 36 ~ 45…and so on.

■ After editing recipe data, it can be saved as *.rcp, *.emi, or *.csv. *.rcp can be downloaded to HMI using Utility Manager or external devices (USB disk or

SD card). *.emi can be saved directly to external device and insert to HMI for reading

(EM register).

606

Recipe Editor

24.3 Recipe Records

Before using Recipe Records, complete the settings in EasyBuildr Pro / System Parameter

Settings / Recipe. For further information, please refer to “Chapter 5 System Parameter

Settings”.

After setting system parameters, Recipe Records can be opened by clicking icon in

EasyBuilder Pro main menu. In the example shown below, Recipe1 and Recipe2 are contained, three items are shown on the right side. The name of recipes are gained from system parameter settings, the following introduces how to insert records into recipe according to the item format.

607

Recipe Editor

Recipe list. This shows the recipes created in the

[Add] / [Delete]

Click [Add] to insert records into the recipe according to the item format.

Click [Delete] to delect the edited content.

按下

[刪除]可刪除所編輯配方的內容。

System Parameter

Settings. The number enclosed in brackets shows the total number of records in the corresponding recipe.

Click the up and down arrows to select the record to be edited.

Click [Add] button above the record list to insert a new record and start editing each item. When click on the item, the item format will be shown under the record list. This helps users to fill in each item with legal value. Click

[OK] to confirm and save the records. item format when click on the item.

608

Shows the

Recipe Editor

■ If there are multiple recipes, each recipe can hold a maximum of 10000 records.

■ The recipe records will be stored in the xob file after compilation and will be downloaded to the HMI. These recipes are not allowed to be shared with other project files. If users need to modify the recipe content using Recipe Records and to download it to the HMI, make sure to check

[Reset recipe database] check box. If not, the recipe database in the HMI will not be updated.

609

EasyConverter

Chapter 25 EasyConverter

This application program is utilized when converting the history record of data sampling

(DTL) or event log (EVT) stored in HMI to Excel.

How to launch Easy Converter:

From Utility Manager click EasyConverter

From EasyBuilder Pro menu click Tool / Data/Event Log Converter

25.1 How to Export DTL or EVT file to Excel

1.

[EasyConverter] / [Open] / [OK]

2. Click

[Export to Microsoft Excel]

610

EasyConverter

When opening event log, an [Event] field can be found in EasyConverter as below.

0 -> Event triggered; 1 -> Event acknowledged; 2 -> Event returns to normal

611

EasyConverter

25.2 Scaling Function

Scaling is utilized to offset data: new value = [(value + A) x B] + C, users can set values of A, B, and C.

A: lower limit of the value ; B: [(engineering high) - (engineering low) / (upper limit) - (lower limit)] ; C: engineering low

For example, here is a voltage data with a format of 16-bit unsigned

(range: 0 ~ 4096).

If users want to convert those data to volt range form -5V to +5V: new value = [(value + 0) x 0.0024] + (-5):

612

EasyConverter

■ Settings of data above can be saved as a sample and loaded next time.

The file name of the sample: *.LGS.

■ After setting the values for Scaling, click [Save Setting] and in a new sample, click

[Load Setting] to use the sample saved before.

613

EasyConverter

25.3 How to Use Multi-File Conversion

1. Click

[File] / [Multi-File] / [Add File] to combine multiple added files into one Excel file.

2. Click

[Combine to a file], files will be separated into sheets of one EXCEL (*.XLS) file labeled with the dated it is created. If users don't check this box, the files will be exported to Excel individually.

The saved setting files can be loaded for combining:

Check both [Enable Setting file] and [Combine to a file] boxes and select the files to be combined then click [OK].

614

EasyPrinter

Chapter 26 EasyPrinter

EasyPrinter is a Win32 application and can only run on MS Windows 2000 / XP / Vista / 7.

It enables HMI to output screen hardcopies to a remote PC via Ethernet. Please see the following illustration:

Here are some advantages of using EasyPrinter:

EasyPrinter provides two modes of hardcopy output: Print-Out and Save-to-File.

Users can use either way or both ways.

Since EasyPrinter is running on MS Windows system, it supports most of the printers available in the market.

Multiple HMI can share one printer via EasyPrinter. Users don’t have to prepare printers for each HMI.

Additionally, EasyPrinter can also be a backup server. Users can use backup objects in

HMI to copy history files such as Data-Sampling and Event-Log histories onto a remote PC via Ethernet. Please see the following illustration:

615

EasyPrinter

26.1 Using EasyPrinter as a Printer Server

Users can make screen hardcopies with a [Function Key] object. The hardcopies will be transferred to the MT Remote Printer Server via Ethernet and then printed out.

26.1.1 Setup Procedure in EasyPrinter

In [Menu] [Options], select [Settings…] and the following dialogue appears:

1. In [Server], assign [Port number of the server socket] to “8005”, [User

name] to “111111” and [Password] to “111111”. (Note: These are default values.)

2. In [Naming Convention for HMI Folder], select [Use IP address] and assign “IP_” as the [Prefix].

3. In [Properties], select [Minimize to system tray].

616

EasyPrinter

Click [Hardcopy] tab on the left side in the dialog box as follows:

4. In [Output], select [Print out to] and choose a printer as the output device for screen hardcopies. (Note: Users can only choose from the printers available in their system, so it is possible that “hp LaserJet 3380 PCL 5” can’t be found in the list as the example.)

5. Click [OK] to apply the settings.

6. In [Menu] [File], select [Enable Output] to allow EasyPrinter to output any incoming print request, i.e. screen hardcopy.

26.1.2 Setup Procedure in EasyBuilder Pro

In EasyBuilder Pro [Menu] [Edit] [System Parameters], click [Printer Server] tab and select [Use MT Remote Printer/Backup Server], the following dialogue appears:

617

EasyPrinter

7. In [Output settings], assign appropriate values for left/top/right/bottom margins. (Note: The margins are all assigned to 15mm in the example.)

8. In [Communication settings], fill in the [IP address] of the printer server same as step 1, assign the [port number] to “8005”, [User name] to

“111111” and [Password] to “111111”.

In EasyBuilder Pro [Menu] [Objects] [Buttons], select [Function Key] and assign

[Screen hardcopy] to [MT Remote Printer/Backup Server].

9. Place the [Function Key] object on the common window (window no. 4), and users will be able to make screen hardcopies anytime needed.

10. [Compile] and [download] project to HMI. Press the [Function Key] object set in step 9 to make a screen hardcopy.

618

EasyPrinter

5. Users can also use a [PLC Control] object to make screen hardcopies.

6. Users cannot print alarm information via EasyPrinter.

7. EasyPrinter can only communicate with HMI via Ethernet, please check if the

HMI in use supports Ethernet.

619

EasyPrinter

26.2 Using EasyPrinter as a Backup Server

Users can upload historical data such as Data-Sampling and Event-Log history files onto

MT remote backup server with [Backup] objects.

26.2.1 Setup Procedure in EasyPrinter

In [Menu] [Options], select [Settings…] and the following dialog appears:

1. In [Server], assign [Port number of the server socket] to “8005”, [User

name] to “111111” and [Password] to “111111”. (Note: These are default values.)

2. In [Naming Convention for HMI Folder], select [Use IP address] and assign “IP_” as the [Prefix].

3. In [Properties], select [Minimize to system tray].

Click [Backup] tab on the left side in the dialog box as follows:

620

EasyPrinter

4. In [Output], click the button to browse and select a path for storage of the incoming history files.

5. Click [OK] to apply the settings.

6. In [Menu] [File], select [Enable Output] to allow EasyPrinter to store any incoming backup request in the location specified in step 4.

26.2.2 Setup Procedure in EasyBuilder Pro

In EasyBuilder Pro [Menu] [Edit] [System Parameters], click [Printer Server] tab and select [Use MT Remote Printer/Backup Server], the following dialog appears:

621

EasyPrinter

7. In [Communication settings], fill in the [IP address] of printer server same as step 1, assign [port number] to “8005”, [User name] to “111111” and

[Password] to “111111”.

In EasyBuilder Pro [Menu] [Objects], select [Backup] and the following dialog appears:

622

EasyPrinter

8. In [Source], select [Historical event log].

9. In [Backup position], select [Remote printer/backup server].

10. In [Range], select [Today] and [All].

11. In [Trigger], select [Touch trigger].

12. Place the [Backup] object on the common window (window no. 4), and users will be able to make backups anytime needed.

13. [Compile] and [download] project to HMI. Press the [Backup] object set in step 12 to make a backup of the Event-Log history data.

8. The [Backup] object can be triggered via a bit signal.

9. Users can arrange a [Scheduler] object, which turns a bit ON at the end of week, to trigger a [Backup] object to automatically back up all history data.

623

EasyPrinter

26.3 EasyPrinter Operation Guide

26.3.1 Appearance

Area

1

2

3

4

5

Name

Job List

Property Window

Preview Window

Download Progress

Window

Message Window

Description

This window lists all incoming tasks, i.e. screen hardcopy and backup requests.

This window shows the information about the task selected from “Job List.”

This window shows the preview image of the screen hardcopy task selected from “Job List.”

This window shows the download progress of incoming requests.

This window shows the time and message of events such as incoming request, incorrect password, etc.

624

EasyPrinter

26.3.2 Operation Guide

The following tables describe the meaning and usage of all EasyPrinter menu items.

Menu  File

Enable Output

Description

Selected

EasyPrinter processes the tasks one by one.

Unselected

EasyPrinter arranges the incoming tasks in memory.

10. EasyPrinter can only reserve up to 128 MB of task data in memory. If the memory is full, any request coming in afterwards will be rejected and users must either operate

[Enable Output] or delete some tasks to make room for new tasks.

Menu  Edit

Edit

Description

To edit a screen hardcopy task.

Delete

Select All

Users can freely change the properties of [Orientation],

[Scaling] and [Margins] here.

To delete the selected tasks permanently.

To select all tasks from “Job List.”

11. The backup task is not editable.

12. [Edit] is available only when a task is selected.

13. [Delete] is available when at least one task is selected.

625

EasyPrinter

Menu  View

Properties Bar

Preview Bar

Download Bar

Logger Bar

Description

To show or hide the Property Window.

To show or hide the Preview Window.

To show or hide the Download Progress Window.

To show or hide the Message Window.

14. On

[Download Progress] Window, users can select the mode to show download progress by clicking the header of the

[progress] column. Please see the following illustration:

15. EasyPrinter can reserve up to 10,000 messages on Message Window. If a new message comes in, the oldest message will be deleted.

MenuOptions

Toolbars

Status Bar

Settings

Description

To show or hide toolbars.

To show or hide the status bar.

Configuration for EasyPrinter. Please refer to the following illustrations:

[General]

626

EasyPrinter

[Server] [Port number of the server socket]

Set the Ethernet socket number for HMI to connect to. The range goes from 1 to 65535 and 8005 is the default value.

[Server] [User name] & [Password]

Set the user name and password to restrict that only authorized HMI can send requests to EasyPrinter.

[Naming Convention for HMI Folder]

EasyPrinter creates different folders to store files (e.g. hardcopy bitmap files, backup files) from different HMI.

There are two ways to name the folders:

a. Use IP address

EasyPrinter names the folder after the IP address of the

HMI sending the request. (i.e. [Prefix] + [IP address])

Please see the following illustration:

b. Use HMI name

EasyPrinter names the folder after the name of the HMI sending the request. (i.e. [Prefix] + [HMI name])

[Properties] [Minimize to system tray]

Select this option to minimize EasyPrinter to system tray instead of task bar. Users can double-click the icon in system tray to restore the EasyPrinter window.

[Properties] [Detailed message]

Select this option to display more detailed messages about events on the message window.

627

EasyPrinter

[Hardcopy]

[Output]

EasyPrinter provides two modes to output hardcopy results: Print-Out and Save-to-File.

a. Print-Out

Select this option to inform EasyPrinter to print out the hardcopy result with specified printers.

b. Save-to-File

Select this option to inform EasyPrinter to convert the hardcopy result into a bitmap file and save it in the specified directory. Users can find the bitmap files at:

[Specified Path] 

[HMI Folder]  yymmdd_hhmm.bmp

For example, when a hardcopy request is given at

17:35:00 12/Jan/2009, the bitmap file will be named

“090112_1735.bmp”. And if there is another bitmap file generated in the same minute, it will be named

“090112_1735_01.bmp” and so on.

[Backup]

628

EasyPrinter

[Output]

EasyPrinter stores the backup files to the specified path.

For Event-Log historical data files:

[Specified Path] 

[HMI Folder] 

[eventlog] 

EL_yyyymmdd.evt

For Data-Sampling historical data file:

[Specified Path] 

[HMI Folder] 

[datalog] 

[Folder name of the Data-Sampling object] yyyymmdd.dtl

For Recipe:

[Specified Path] 

[HMI Folder] 

[recipe]  recipe.rcp or recipe_a.rcp

[Convert Batch File]

Select [Enable] and assign a Convert Batch File for automatically converting uploaded history files to CSV or

MS Excel format. Please refer to the next section for the details of Convert Batch File.

16. Users can assign HMI names from LW9032 to LW9039.

17. EasyPrinter names the folder after IP address if HMI name is not set.

629

EasyPrinter

26.4 Convert Batch File

EasyPrinter provides a mechanism for converting the uploaded Data-Sampling and

Event-Log history files stored in binary mode to CSV files automatically. Users requesting this function have to prepare a Convert Batch File to provide EasyPrinter with the information of how to convert the history files.

As shown in the illustration above, the conversion is actually carried out by EasyConverter.

EasyPrinter simply follows the criteria in Convert Batch File and activates EasyConverter with proper arguments to achieve the conversion.

18. EasyConverter is another Win32 application converting history data into CSV or MS Excel (*.xls) files. Users can find it in the EasyBuilder Pro installation directory.

19. Users requesting this function must ensure EasyPrinter and EasyConverter are placed in the same directory.

26.4.1 The Default Convert Batch File

The following is the default Convert Batch File included in the EasyBuilder Pro software package:

The default Convert Batch File (convert2csv.def)

1:

"dtl", "EasyConverter /c $(PathName)"

2:

"evt", "EasyConverter /c $(PathName)"

There are two lines of text in the file. Each line has two arguments separated by a comma and forms a criterion of how to deal with a specific type of files, e.g. Data-Sampling and

Event-Log history files. The first argument specifies the extension name for the type of the files to be processed and the second one specifies the exact command to execute in console mode. Please note “$(PathName)” is a key word to tell EasyPrinter to replace it with the real name of the backup file in conversion. For example, if a Data-Sampling

630

EasyPrinter history file named 20090112.dtl is uploaded and stored, EasyPrinter will send out the following command to a console window:

EasyConverter /c 20090112.dtl

And then the CSV file named 20090112.csv is created.

Therefore, the criteria of the default Convert Batch File are:

1. Convert all Data-Sampling history files (*.dtl) into CSV files.

2. Convert all Event-Log history files (*.evt) into CSV files.

20. Actually, the “$(PathName)” in the second argument stands for the full path name of the file. In the previous case, EasyPrinter replaces it with:

[Specified Path] \ [HMI Folder] \ [datalog] \

[Folder name of the Data-Sampling object] \ 20090112.dtl

21. EasyPrinter interprets the Convert Batch File on a line basis, i.e. each line forms a criterion.

22. Any two arguments should be separated by a comma.

23. Every argument should be put in double quotes.

24. Do not put any comma inside an argument.

25. For further information about how to use EasyConverter, please refer to the

“chapter25 Easy Converter”.

26.4.2 Specialized Criteria

Sometimes users may need a special handling for the files uploaded from a specific HMI.

Here is an example:

Specialized Criterion for the HMI with IP = 192.168.1.26

3:

"dtl", "EasyConverter /c $(PathName)", "192.168.1.26"

Or users can also specify the HMI with its name.

Specialized Criterion for the HMI with name = Weintek_01

4:

"dtl", "EasyConverter /c $(PathName)", "Weintek_01"

Or in the case of needing special handling for different Data-Sampling history files.

Specialized Criterion for the Data-Sampling object’s folder name = Voltage

5:

"dtl", "EasyConverter /s Voltage.lgs $(PathName)", "*", "Voltage"

631

EasyPrinter

The 5 th

criterion can only be performed on the history files uploaded from the

[Data Sampling] objects with the folder name “Voltage”. The 3 rd

argument (“*”) indicates this criterion accepts the qualified Data-Sampling files from any HMI.

Users can also change the 3 rd

argument to “192.168.1.26”, “192.168.1.*”, HMI name, etc. for narrowing the target HMI.

26.4.3 The Format of a Convert Batch File

The following table explains all arguments in a criterion.

No Argument

1 File Type

2

3

Command Line a. HMI IP address b. HMI name

4 Condition 1

Description

This argument specifies the extension name of the uploaded files this criterion targets. (e.g. “dtl” for

Data-Sampling history files, “evt” for Event-Log history files)

The exact command EasyPrinter sends to a console window if the uploaded file is qualified.

This argument specifies the HMI this criterion targets.

5 Condition 2

If the file type is “dtl”

This argument specifies the folder name of the

[Data Sampling] objects this criterion targets.

Others

No use.

No use. (reserved for further use)

26.4.4 The Order of Examining Criteria

EasyPrinter examines criteria in ascending order every time a file is uploaded. Once the file is qualified for a criterion, it stops the examination and starts over for next file.

Therefore, users should place the criteria with more specification upward in the Convert

Batch File and place the less-specific criteria downward. Take the 5 criteria mentioned in the previous sections for example, the correct order is:

Correct order for the previous criteria

"dtl", "EasyConverter /s Voltage.lgs $(PathName)", "*", “Voltage"

"dtl", "EasyConverter /c $(PathName)", "EasyView"

"dtl", "EasyConverter /c $(PathName)", "192.168.1.26"

"dtl", "EasyConverter /c $(PathName)"

"evt", "EasyConverter /c $(PathName)"

632

EasySimulator

Chapter 27 EasySimulator

EasySimulator enables users to perform On-line/Off-line Simulation without installing

EasyBuilder Pro software. To achieve that, users have to prepare the following files in one folder.

27.1 Prepare Needed Files

1. [driver]  [win32]

2. com_e30.exe

3. EasySimulator.exe

4. gui_e30.exe

5. sqlite3.dll

6. xob_pos.def

■ Users can find all the above files in EasyBuilder Pro installation directory, which means users have to install EasyBuilder Pro software package on a

PC first then copy the needed files to the target PC.

633

EasySimulator

27.2 Modify the Content of “xob_pos.def”

Step 1

Open xob_pos.def using a text editing tool (e.g. Notepad) and set the contents correctly.

Line no. Description

1 [“2”] Perform Off-line Simulation; [“3”] Perform On-line Simulation

2

Specify the full path where the files locate. (e.g. com_e30.exe, gui_e30.exe, EasySimulator.exe…etc.)

3 Specify the full path of the project file. (*.xob)

Step 2

Double click on EasySimulator.exe to start simulation.

Step 3

On-line / Off-line Simulation is displayed on the screen.

■ If EasySimulator.exe can’t be activated, please check if the relevant directories are correctly defined.

■ If the window below is shown, it indicates there’s an error in *.xob file directory, please check if it is correctly defined.

634

Multi-HMI-Intercommunication (Master-Slave Mode)

Chapter 28 Multi-HMI Intercommunication

(Master-Slave Mode)

Multi-HMI intercommunication means that HMI uses COM port to connect with a remote HMI, and read/write data from/to PLC connected to remote HMI as below:

The above shows the PLC is connected with HMI 1, and HMI 1 is connected with HMI

2 via COM port, so that HMI 2 can control the PLC through HMI 1.

The following are examples of how to use EasyBuilder Pro to create projects used on

HMI 1(Master) and HMI 2 (Slave).

635

Multi-HMI-Intercommunication (Master-Slave Mode)

28.1 How to Create a Project of Master HMI

The following is the project content of HMI 1 in

[System Parameter Settings] /

[Device].

1. Due to COM 1 of HMI 1 connects PLC, the device list must include [Local PLC 1] in this case is “FATEK FB Series”. The communication parameters must be set correctly.

2. Due to COM 3 of HMI 1 is used to receive commands from HMI 2; a new device must be added– [Master-Slave Server] for setting communication properties of COM

3. The picture above shows the parameters of COM 3- “115200, E, 8, 1”, and uses

RS232. These parameters are not required to be the same as PLC, but the [Data bits] must be set to 8. In general, a higher baud rate for COM 2 is recommended for a more efficient communication with PLC.

636

Multi-HMI-Intercommunication (Master-Slave Mode)

28.2 How to Create a Project of Slave HMI

The project content of HMI 2 in

[System Parameter Settings] / [Device].

Due to the PLC that HMI 2 reads from is connected with HMI 1, thus HMI 2 views PLC as a remote device. Therefore, it is necessary to add a [*Remote PLC 1] into the device list and in this case is “FATEK FB Series”. The way to create [*Remote PLC 1] is described below:

1. Create a new device”FATEK FB Series”. [PLC default station no.] must be the same as the connected PLC.

2. Correctly set the parameters.

COM 1 of HMI 2 connects with COM

3 of HMI 1, so they both must have the same communication parameters and interfaces, ignoring the PLC parameters. As below, use RS232, parameters - [115200, E, 8, 1].

637

Multi-HMI-Intercommunication (Master-Slave Mode)

3.

Since HMI 2 views PLC a remote device, here we change [Location] to [Remote], and select [COM port] to connect remote HMI (HMI 1).

4. Upon completion of the settings, users can find a new device named

[*Remote

PLC 1] in the [Device List]. This device has a “*” symbol, which means, even if it contains “Remote” in the name, it actually gives commands and gets replies through a local COM port, and therefore the connection with PLC can be viewed form a local system reserved register, that is, [*Remote PLC 1], [*Remote PLC 2], [*Remote PLC 3] and [Local PLC 1], [Local PLC 2], [Local PLC 3] use the same system reserved register from the listed below:

638

Tag

LB-9150

LB-9151

LB-9152

LB-9200~

LB-9455

LB-9500~

LB-9755

LB-9800~

LB-10055

Multi-HMI-Intercommunication (Master-Slave Mode)

Description

When ON, auto. connection with PLC (COM 1) when disconnected.

When OFF, ignore disconnection with PLC.

When ON, auto. connection with PLC (COM 2) when disconnected.

When OFF, ignore disconnection with PLC.

When ON, auto. connection with PLC (COM 3) when disconnected.

When OFF, ignore disconnection with PLC.

These local registers indicate the connection states with PLC

(through COM1).

LB9200 indicates the connection state with PLC (station no. 0), and

LB9201 indicates the connection state with PLC (station no. 1) and so on.

When ON, indicates connection state is normal.

When OFF, indicates disconnection with PLC.

Set ON again, the system will then try to connect with PLC.

These local registers indicate the connection states with PLC

(through COM2).

LB9500 indicates the connection state with PLC (station no. 0), and

LB9501 indicates the connection state with PLC (station no. 1) and so on.

When ON, indicates connection state is normal.

When OFF, indicates disconnection with PLC.

Set ON again, the system will then try to connect with PLC.

These local registers indicate the connection states with PLC

(through COM3).

LB9800 indicates the connection state with PLC (station no. 0), and

LB9801 indicates the connection state with PLC (station no. 1) and so on.

When ON, indicates connection state is normal.

When OFF, indicates disconnection with PLC.

Set ON again, the system will then try to connect with PLC.

639

Multi-HMI-Intercommunication (Master-Slave Mode)

28.3 How to Connect with MT500 Project of Slave HMI

EasyBuilder Pro Master-Slave Protocol enables MT500 to exchange data with eMT3000 local data.via the connected PLC

■ EBPro Settings

1. Select

“Master-Slave

Server” driver and click [Settings]. If a

PLC is connected, follow the original settings.

2. Select [RS-232], click [Settings].

3.

Fill in MT500

PLC ID No. in

[Parameter 1]

(Refer to MT500 settings).

640

Multi-HMI-Intercommunication (Master-Slave Mode)

■ EB500 Settings

1.

In EB500 System

Parameter Settings, set

Multiple HMI: Slave,

HMI-HMI link speed:

115200

[Baud rate] must be identical in EB500 and EBPro.

2. Double click on PLC

Address View.exe to check PLC ID No. and fill in [Parameter 1] of

EBPro.

641

Multi-HMI-Intercommunication (Master-Slave Mode)

3.

Connect COM ports RS232 of each HMI, the communication is then enabled.

■ There will always be a PLC selected in EB500 system parameter settings, in this case, even to read/write EB Pro HMI Local Data only, the

ID of the selected PLC in EB500 system parameters must also be filled in

EBPro parameter 1.

■ When using S7-200, S7-300 drivers, since in EB500 the high and low bytes are sent in reverse order, this will cause MT500 to misread EBPro Local data.

Device address:

Bit/Word EB500

B

EBPro Range

Ms_RB RW_Bit dddd: 0~4095 (h): 0~f

B

W

W

Ms_LB LB

Ms_RW RW

Ms_LW LW dddd: 0~9999 ddddd: 0~65535 dddd: 0~9999

Memo

642

Pass-Through Function

Chapter 29 Pass-Through Function

The pass-through function allows the PC application to control PLC via HMI. In this case the HMI acts as a converter.

The pass-through function provides two modes: [Ethernet] and [COM port]. Click

[Pass-through] in [Utility Manager] will open a setting dialog.

643

Pass-Through Function

29.1 Ethernet Mode

[How to install virtual serial port driver]

Before using [Ethernet] mode, please check whether Weintek virtual serial port driver is installed as described below:

If [Virtual COM port (PC<->PLC)] displays [Please install weintek virtual serial port

driver], please click [Install].

If the dialogue below pops up during installation, please click

[Continue Anyway].

644

Pass-Through Function

After process is completed, the virtual COM port is displayed as below.

This mode is not supported in Win 7 – 64 Bit operation system.

29.1.1 How to Change the Virtual Serial Port

Open

[System Properties] -> [Device Manager] to check if the virtual serial port is installed successfully.

If users want to change the number of virtual serial port, please click

[Weintek Virtual

Serial Port] to open [Port Settings] / [Advanced…], as follows:

645

Pass-Through Function

For example, user changes virtual serial port from COM 3 to COM 9.

Select COM 9 and click

[OK], the virtual serial port will be changed to COM 9.

It can be found that the virtual COM port is changed to COM 9 in

[Utility Manager].

646

Pass-Through Function

29.1.2 How to Use Ethernet Mode

After installing virtual serial port driver, users should follow four steps to use Ethernet mode of pass-through.

Step 1

Set IP of the HMI connected with PLC. For example, HMI IP is 192.168.1.206

Step 2

Assign serial port properties of the port connects HMI with PLC. For example, COM2 (use

RS232) is used to connect PLC.

Step 3

Click

[Apply], and these settings will be updated.

Step 4

In the PC application, the number of the serial port must be the same as the virtual one.

For example, using a Mitsubishi application, if the virtual serial port is COM 7, please open

[PC side I/F Serial setting] / [COM port] to select COM 7, as follows:

647

Pass-Through Function

After completing all settings, when users execute PLC application on PC, the HMI will be switched automatically to pass-through mode (the communication between HMI and PLC will be suspended this moment and it will be resumed if the application closes), as follows:

At this moment the application is controlling PLC directly via virtual serial port.

648

Pass-Through Function

29.2 COM Port Mode

Source COM Port

The port is used to connect HMI with PC.

Destination COM Port

The port is used to connect HMI with PLC.

When using

[COM port] mode of pass-through, users should correctly set the properties of source COM port and Destination COM port.

29.2.1 Settings of COM Port Mode

There are two ways to enable

[COM port] mode of pass-through function.

(1)

Use Utility Manager

(2)

Use system registers LW-9901 and LW-9902

LW-9901: pass-through source COM port (1~3: COM1~COM3)

LW-9902: pass-through destination COM port (1~3: COM1~COM3)

Note: When finish using Pass Through function, users should click [Stop Pass-through] to disable it so that HMI can start to communicate with PLC

Start pass-through in Utility Manager.

Click

[Pass-through] button in Utility Manager to set the communication parameters.

649

Pass-Through Function

[HMI IP]

Assign HMI IP address.

[Get HMI Communication Parameters]

For getting the settings of source and destination COM port. The parameters come from reserved addresses detailed as follows.

Source COM port and Destination COM port

LW-9901 (Source COM port) 1 : COM 1 3 : COM 3

LW-9902 (Destination COM port)

COM 1 mode settings

LW-9550 (PLC I/F)

1 : COM 1 3 : COM 3

0 : RS232 1 : RS485/2W 2 : RS485/4W

LW-9551 (baud rate)

LW-9552 (data bits)

LW-9553 (parity)

LW-9554 (stop bits)

0 : 4800 2 : 19200

4 : 57600 5 : 115200

7 : 7 bits 8 : 8 bits

0 : none

1 : 1 bit

1 : 9600

1 : even

2 : 2 bits

2 : odd

3 : 38400

650

Pass-Through Function

COM 3 mode setting

LW-9560 (PLC I/F)

LW-9561 (baud rate)

0 : RS232 1 : RS485/2W

LW-9562 (data bits)

LW-9563 (parity)

LW-9564 (stop bits)

0 : 4800 1 : 9600 2 : 19200 3 : 38400

4 : 57600 5 : 115200

7 : 7 bits 8 : 8 bits

0 : none 1 : even 2 : odd

1 : 1 bit 2 : 2 bits

Click [Get HMI Communication Parameters] to update HMI current states and communication parameters.

29.2.2 HMI Work Mode

There are three work modes in the pass-through function,

Mode

Unknown

Description

Before getting the settings of HMI, the work mode is displayed

“Unknown”.

Normal After getting the settings of HMI, if work mode displays “Normal”

PC can’t control PLC via HMI.

Pass-through HMI is working on pass-through state; at this time, the PC application can control PLC via source com port.

[Source COM Port][Destination COM Port]

The communication parameters of source and destination COM port are displayed in these two areas. The settings will be used when [Start pass-through] is clicked.

The “Baud rate”, “Data bits”, “Parity”, and “Stop bits” of [Source COM Port] and

[Destination COM Port] have to be the same.

[Source COM Port] connects PC, so select RS232 mode; [Destination COM Port] connects PLC, so settings depend on the PLC requirements.

The illustration below shows the setting when HMI connects SIEMENS S7/200.

The HMI COM 1 (RS232) connects PC, COM 3 (RS485 2W) connects PLC. The communication parameter of PLC is”9600, E, 8, 1”. Before starting pass-through, users must set the parameters in MTP project and download the project to HMI.

651

Pass-Through Function

After the project is downloaded to HMI, open the same project and change the PLC I/F and

COM port to COM 1 RS232 (PC uses COM 1 to connect HMI) as follows:

652

Pass-Through Function

After that, press [Pass-through] to assign HMI IP address; for example, 192.168.1.37.

Finally, press [Get HMI Communication Parameters], as follows:

Press

[Start Pass-through] and HMI work mode is switched into “Pass-through”. Users can execute on-line simulation. Now PC application can control PLC via HMI, and HMI is acting as a converter at this moment.

Note: The communication between HMI and PLC will be paused when pass-through is active. If users want to resume communication between HMI and PLC, please press

[Stop

Pass-through] to disable this function.

653

Pass-Through Function

29.3 Using System Reserved Addresses to Enable Pass-Through

Function

Other way to enable pass-through is to use LW-9901/LW-9902 to set source COM port and destination COM port directly. When the values of LW-9901 and LW-9902 match conditions as below, HMI will start pass-through automatically: a. The values of LW-9901 and LW-9902 have to be 1 or 3

(1: COM 1, 3: COM 3). b. The values of LW-9901 and LW-9902 should not be the same.

If users need to change the communication parameters, just change the value in related reserved addresses and set ON to LB-9030, LB-9031 and LB-9032. HMI will be forced to accept new settings.

Tag Description

LB-9030 Update COM1 communication parameters (set ON)

LB-9032 Update COM3 communication parameters (set ON)

Note: If users want to stop pass-through, just change the values of LW-9901 and LW-9902 to values that are not 1, 2, 3 (EX: 0).

654

Project Protection

Chapter 30 Project Protection

The copyright of program design must be protected. EasyBuilder Pro supports protection functions for project files to ensure users' design achievement.

■ The following protection functions can’t be decrypted by factory since they are encrypted by users, therefore, please remember your password.

655

Project Protection

30.1 XOB Password

After project (MTP) is completed, users can compile the file to XOB format that can be downloaded to HMI. Password can be set to protect the XOB file in [Compiling] window.

A password will be required when attempting to decompile the XOB file to MTP. (XOB password range: 0 ~ 4294967295)

If the password is input incorrectly for three times when decompiling, please reset the decompilier.

656

Project Protection

30.2 Decompilation is Prohibited

If this box is ticked, the system will automatically deny [XOB password]. Furthermore, the

XOB file can’t be decompiled to MTP file.

When attempting to decompile a XOB file that is already set to

[Decompilation is

prohibited], an error message “This xob is set to not decompile!!” will be shown.

657

Project Protection

30.3 Disable HMI Upload Function [LB-9033]

EasyBuilder Pro provides system reserved address [LB-9033]. When this address is set to

ON, HMI will disable upload function of XOB file. HMI needs to be rebooted to activate

[LB-9033].

When attempting to upload a XOB file set to this function, the XOB file gained after uploading will be 0 bytes, and can’t be decompiled.

658

Project Protection

30.4 Project Key

User’s project can be restrained to be executed only on specific HMI (for i series HMI only).

Please go to [System Parameters Settings] / [General] / [Project protection].

LW-9046 ~ LW-9047 (32-bit) can be used to set the [HMI key]. The value can’t be read or written into these two registers by remote HMI. While using this function, set the password

( [Project key] password range: 0 ~ 4294967295), and the XOB file can only be executed on specific HMI when [HMI key] and [Project key] are identical. If they are different, the system will turn LB-9046 ON. HMI needs to be rebooted every time when revising [HMI key].

■ When [HMI key] and [Project key] are different, HMI and PLC won’t be able to communicate.

Please confirm your Internet connection before downloading the demo project.

659

Project Protection

30.5 Project Password (MTP file)

Password can be set to protect the MTP file in [System parameter] / [Security] tab.

Enabling this, password will be required if attempting to edit MTP file. (MTP password range: 1 ~ 4294967295)

After setting, when opening this project, a pop-up window requires to input password will be shown.

■ When using “Window Copy” function, if the source file is protected by MTP password, please input correct password for EasyBuilder Pro to execute window copy.

660

Memory Map Communication

Chapter 31 Memory Map Communication

MemoryMap communication protocol is similar to IBM 3764R, it is used when memory data is with low variation. (High variation may cause MemoryMap overloading.) MemoryMap is used for communication between two devices. When setting the MemoryMap with two devices, one has to be set as Master, and another is Slave. In normal condition, Master and

Slave do not communicate except when the assigned memory data in one of them has changed. Once data is identical the communication will stop. So this is used for keeping the consistency of assigned part of data between two devices (Master and Slave) via corresponding registers.

The corresponding memory has the same property as HMI register MW(MB) from Master and Slave (The 1000 words MW(MB) are reserved for MemoryMap in HMI for communication.) The feature of memory: MB is correspondence with MW, according to the following list, MB0~MBf and MW0, MB10~MB1f and MW1…, they all indicate the same register.

Device name Format Range

MB

MW dddd(h) dddd dddd:0~4095 h:0~f(hex) dddd:0~9999

When using MemoryMap communication protocol, the master and slave have to use the same communication setting. The wiring diagram as follow:

RS232

Master

TX(#)

Slave

RX(#)

RX(#)

GND(#)

TX(#)

GND(#)

RS485 (4W)

Master

TX+(#)

TX-(#)

RX+(#)

RX-(#)

GND(#)

Slave

RX+(#)

RX-(#)

TX+(#)

TX-(#)

GND(#)

661

Memory Map Communication

Note: # means being decided by PLC or controller.

The flowchart of communication as following:

Flowchart 1

Start

Yes

Send data

No

Receiving

STX(02H)

Yes

Sending ACK(06H), waiting time is

3sec.(default)

No

Received

Data

Yes

Sending ACK(06H)

No

No

Out of 3 sec.

Yes

Sending STX(02H, waiting time is 3 sec.

Yes

Receiving

No

(b)

Flowchart 2

No

Out of 3 sec.

Yes

Delay 100ms

Yes Checking

NAK(15H)

No

Checking

ACK(06H)

Yes

Sending data

Receiving

ACK(06H)

No

No

Stop sending

No

Out of 3 sec.

No

Out of 3 sec.

Yes

Yes

Memory Map Communication

Flowchart 2

Checking

STX(02H)

Yes

Yes

Sending ACK(06H

The waiting time is 3 sec. (default)

Receiving data

Sending ACK(06H)

Go to flowchart (b)

No

No

Going to flowchart (a)

No

Out of 3 sec.

Yes

Note:

Flowchart 2 is available for slave but not master, STX is asking signal for communication,

ACK is feedback signal, and NAK is busy signal.

There are two data formats, one is for MB and another is for MW:

For MB command

1

2

Offset (byte) Format

0 0x02

3

4,5

6

0x##

0x##

Description

The operating sign to MB

Address (Low byte)

Bit Address (High byte)

For example:MB12=>1*16+2=18, is 0x12 and 0x00

0x00( or 0x01) The data of MB address.

(This is Bit, so has to be 0 or 1)

0x10,0x03

Stop sign

0x## checksum, xor from 0 byte to fifth byte.

663

Memory Map Communication

For MW command

Offset(byte) Format

0

1

2

3

0x01

0x##

0x##

0x##

Description

The operating sign to MW

Address (Low byte)

Bit Address (High byte)

If there is a 0x10 included in address, and insert a 0x10 after it, the byte will move to next position.

For example: 0x10, 0x04 will become 0x10,0x10,0x04

Sending byte (The byte has to be even, due to operating for word). If byte is 0x10 then insert a 0x10 after it, the byte will move to next position

4~4+n-1 0x##(L) 0x##(H) The data of initial address for corresponding address for

0x##(L)… 1,2 byte, n is byte of data, if data includes 0x10 and then insert a 0x10, the sending byte number remains same, then n=n+1, and so on…

4+n,4+n+1 0x10,0x03

End sign

4+n+2 0x## checksum,Xor check-up and bytes in the front

Below is an example for observation process of communication. If Master has a 0x0a in

MW3, according to this protocol, master will communicate with slave immediately, and slave will put the 0x0a in corresponding MW3, the procedure is as following:

Master sending STX(0x02h).

Slave receives STX(0x02h) from master, and sending ACK(0x06h) to master.

Master receives ACK(0x06h) from slave.

Master sending 0x01,0x03,0x00,0x02,0x0a,0x00,0x10,0x03,0x19, as shown below:

1

2

3

Offset(byte) Format

0 0x01

4,5

6,7

Description

The operating sign for MW

0x03

0x00

0x02

Address(Low byte)

Bit Address (High byte)

Sending byte (The byte has to be even, due to MW3 is two byte).

0x0a,0x00 MW3 content is 0x0a,0x00

8

0x10,0x03

End sign

0x19 Checksum

0x01^0x03^0x00^0x02^0x0a^0x00^0x10^0x03=0x19

664

Memory Map Communication

Slave received data from master and then sending ACK(0x06h).

Master receives ACK(0x06h) from slave.

When finishing communication, master sending revised data of MW to slave, and slave changes the MW which corresponds to that of master. At this time, master and slave keep the same data in the same address.

Another example below, the address and data include 0x10; please notice the change in data format. Now, if we have 0x10 in MW16 in slave, according to this protocol, slave will communicate with master immediately, and master will put 0x10 in data of corresponding

MW16, the procedure is as following:

Slave sending STX(0x02h)

Master receives STX(0x02h) from slave, and sending ACK(0x06h) to Slave.

Slave receives ACK(0x06h) from master

Slave sending data 0x01,0x10,0x10,0x00,0x02,0x10,0x10,0x00,0x10,0x03,0x10 as shown below:

Offset (byte) Format Description

0 0x01 The operating sign to MW

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

8,9

0x10

0x10

0x00

0x02

0x10

0x10

0x00

0x10,

Address(Low byte)

Insert 0x10

Bit Address (High byte)

Sending byte (MW10 is two bytes)

0x10 is low byte in MW10

Insert 0x10

0x00 in high byte

End sign

10

0x03

0x10 checksum,

0x01^0x10^0x10^0x00^0x02^0x10^0x10^0x00^0x

10^0x03=0x10

Master receives data from slave and sending ACK(0x06h) to slave.

Slave receives ACK(0x06h) from master.

665

Memory Map Communication

When finishing communication, slave sending the address and content of MW to master, at this time, master changes data of MW corresponding to that of Slave, then master and slave keep the same data in the same address.

Below is an example for communication between two HMI via MemoryMap.

First of all, create a new project in EasyBuilder Pro

Edit/System Parameter Setting/PLC

Note:

1. eMT3000 is unlike MT500 which is divided into Memory Map_Master, MemoryMap,

Slaver, therefore, simply selecting Memory Map is allowed.

2. [Data bit] has to be 8 bits.

3. The rest of the settings should be identical between two HMI.

Adding two objects on window10, a toggle switch setting is as illustration below:

666

Memory Map Communication

A multi-state switch object setting is as following:

667

Memory Map Communication

[Save],[Compile],[Download]

Change parameter in [System Parameter Setting]/[PLC] and download to another HMI.

The HMI display is as following:

Users may try to touch the screen; the other HMI will act the same as current HMI.

The communicating way is the same as above-mentioned. The point is to keep the same data in the same register.

668

FTP Server Application

Chapter 32 FTP Server Application

In addition to backup history data from HMI to PC by SD card, USB memory stick or EasyPrinter, FTP Server can also be applied to do this. After downloading project to HMI, FTP Server can be used to backup history data and recipe data, and also to update recipe data. The files in FTP Server can’t be deleted.

32.1 Login FTP Server

Step 1. Before login FTP Server, please check HMI IP address.

669

FTP Server Application

Step 2. Enter HMI IP: ftp://192.168.1.117/ (example), login user name: uploadhis, and the HMI history upload password (if not changed, the default is

111111). Or, to directly enter ftp://uploadhis:[email protected]/

Step 3. After entering IP, ftp://192.168.1.117/ is shown, and the “datalog”,

“eventlog”, and “recipe” folders can be seen.

670

FTP Server Application

32.2 Backup History Data and Update Recipe Data

To backup “Data

Sampling” records

1. Click “datalog” folder to check the file names set by

EasyBuilder Pro.

2. Click on file names to check content.

3. Copy and paste to save files on PC.

To backup “Event

(Alarm) Log” records

1. Click “eventlog” folder to check the files.

2. Copy and paste to save files on PC.

To backup and update

“Recipe” records

1. Click “recipe” folder to check the files.

2. To update “recipe” data on HMI, overwrite

“recipe.rcp” with new data and restart HMI in one minute.

671

FTP Server Application

■ Since recipe data is automatically saved once every minute, after updating “recipe.rcp” or “recipe_a.rcp”, HMI must be restarted in one minute otherwise the new updated recipe data will be overwritten by the former data. [LB-9047] and [LB-9048] can also be used to restart HMI. Set [LB-9048] to ON and then set [LB-9047] to ON to successfully restart HMI.

System Registers:

[LB-9047] reboot HMI (set ON when LB9048 is ON)

[LB-9048] reboot-HMI protection

672

EasyDiagnoser

Chapter 33 EasyDiagnoser

33.1 Overview and Configuration

Overview

EasyDiagnoser is a tool for detecting the error occurs while HMI is communicating with PLC.

Configuration

Step 1.

Open Utility Manager and click EasyDiagnoser.

EasyDiagnoser

Step 2.

Set the IP address of the HMI to communicate with.

Users can input IP address manually or simply click [Search All]. Please input Project Port as well.

673

EasyDiagnoser

Input HMI IP address

Search HMI in

LAN.

674

EasyDiagnoser

It is also available to right click and select “Run EasyDiagnoser” for entering the setting window when executing On-Line Simulation in EasyBuilder Pro.

After setting completed, click OK, EasyDiagnoser operation window appears as below:

675

EasyDiagnoser

33.2 EasyDiagnoser Settings

Item Description

File Save As

The captured information of Easy Diagnoser can be saved as

*.xls which can be read in Excel.

View

Options

Exit

Exit current file.

Click [Device Bar] to display Device window.

Click [Package Bar] to display Package window.

Click [Logger Bar] to display Logger window.

Click [Output Bar] to display Output window.

Toolbars

Display toolbar icons of [Device Bar] [Package Bar] [Logger

Bar] [Output Bar].

Show Status Bar

At the bottom of EasyDiagnoser window, display information of CAP, NUM, and SCRL.

Update Package List

When users change window on HMI, update the Polling

Package information of current window with this list.

Show Object ID (HMI)

Show the ID of objects in HMI as shown below.

676

EasyDiagnoser

Clear Activity List

Clear all information in activity area.

Display EasyDiagnoser version information.

Help

Activity area

In the activity area, users can observe the communication between HMI and PLC.

Item

Command

Description a. Read + Write

Display Read and Write commands in activity area.

b. Read

Display only Read commands in activity area.

677

Device

Station

Address

Type

Range

Capture

Error

EasyDiagnoser

c. Write

Display only Write commands in activity area.

a. All

Display information of Local HMI and PLC. It depends on the setting of command as following.

If command is set

Read + Write, the Read and Write information of

Local HMI and PLC will be displayed in activity area.

If command is set

Read, the Read information of Local HMI and PLC will be displayed in activity area.

If command is set

Write, the Write information of Local HMI and PLC will be displayed in activity area.

b. Local HMI

Display information of Local HMI, it depends on the setting of command as following.

If command is set Read + Write, the Read and Write information of

Local HMI will be displayed in activity area.

If command is set Read, the Read information of Local HMI will be displayed in activity area.

If command is set Write, the Write information of Local HMI will be displayed in activity area.

c. PLC

Display information of PLC, it depends on the setting of command as following.

If command is set Read + Write, the Read and Write information of PLC will be displayed in activity area.

If command is set Read, the Read information of PLC will be displayed in activity area.

If command is set Write, the Write information of PLC will be displayed in activity area.

Select specific Station for display on the screen. (This function will be disabled when selecting [All] in Device).

Users can select all or a part of address types to be displayed on the screen. (This function will be disabled when selecting [All] in Device).

Set the range of address types to be displayed. (This function will be disabled when selecting [All] in Address Type).

Click to start/stop capturing communication message.

Please refer to the section coming later.

678

EasyDiagnoser

Polling Packages

Item

Package ID

Description

Use the information of package ID to check the PID in activity area for finding the problem.

Device

Station

Displays HMI and PLC type.

Displays PLC station number.

Index

Display objects-used index register numbers.

Address/Length Displays device type address. Length-how many words of the Package.

Item

Object

Screen

ID

Address

Description

Package ID where this object is placed.

Window in the project where this object is placed.

ID of the object.

Address of the object.

679

EasyDiagnoser

Note:

a. Click [Package ID], the device station number will be displayed in 3 rd

column.

b. Double click [Package ID] then select [object], the 1 st

column directs the object’s position.

For example, select [Numeric Input] and the screen no. displays 10.

This shows that this object is in window no. 10 in the project and will be marked with pink frame in HMI as shown below.

680

EasyDiagnoser

Devices

Devices window displays information of HMI and PLC.

Output (Macro debug)

With Trace function offered by Macro, the executing status of Macro can be seen. Please refer to EasyBuilder Pro User’s Manual “Chapter 18 MACRO” for more information.

In illustration below, for [ID 2, Ln 7] and [ID 2, Ln 8]

ID 2 represents Macro name.

Ln 7 and Ln 8 represent that they are in 7 th

and 8 th

lines of Macro.

681

EasyDiagnoser

33.3 Error Code

In activity area, users can find the reason of error through error codes listed below.

0: Normal

1: Time out

2: Fail Error

12: Ignore

When error occurs, error message will be shaded red as shown below.

The error code is 1 since PLC is disconnected with HMI.

The error code is 12 since “PLC No Response” message window is shown.

682

EasyDiagnoser

33.4 Save As

The captured information of Easy Diagnoser can be saved as *.xls which can be read in

Excel.

683

EasyDiagnoser

33.5 Window Adjustment

Users can drag or use smart docking icons in editing window to place the windows to the desired position.

Smart Docking

Smart Docking

Smart Docking

Smart Docking

Note:

EasyDiagnoser doesn’t support Siemens S7/1200 (Ethernet) and Allen-Bradley Ethernet/IP

(CompactLogix/ControlLogix) – Free Tag Names since both of the PLC use tag.

684

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

Chapter 34 Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

When using the driver of Rockwell EtherNet/IP-Tag (CompactLogix/

ControlLogix) in EasyBuilder Pro, users can import User-Defined Tag from

CSV file of RSLogix5000. However, data type of User-Defined, Predefined and

Module-Defined Structure won’t be imported.

Therefore, Structure Editor in EasyBuilder Pro is for users to import and edit

User-Defined, Predefined and Module-Defined Structure.

685

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

34.1 Import User-Defined Tag CSV File to EasyBuilder Pro

Step 1. Create Tags from RSLogix5000.

Step 2. Export Tags data to CSV file.

686

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

Step 3. In EasyBuilder Pro, create Rockwell EtherNet/IP-Tag

(CompactLogix/ControlLogix) driver.

Input PLC IP address. In System Parameter Settings dialog click [Import Tag…] button.

Step 4. In object dialog, select PLC, click Controller Tags and select a controller tag.

687

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

34.2 Adding New Data Type

Step 1. Right click on the assigned data type (usually labeled as

[User-Defined]), then click [New Data Type] to start editing.

Step 2. Input the [Name] of the data type. [Description] can be skipped.

For adding data member, click [Add].

Step 3. Input in [Name] and [Data Type] then click [OK] to leave.

688

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

Step 4. After adding all data members, click [OK]. The built data type will be listed on the left side.

Note: After changing [Name] or [Description] of a data type, [OK] must be clicked to activate revision.

689

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

34.3 Paste

Step 1. When adding new data members, this function allows users to add multiple data at one time. The way is to click [Paste] on the main window.

Step 2. The way to edit is to input data name in each line first, then use space or tab key to leave a space in each line. And then input data type or click

[Sample] to see some reference. It is recommended to directly copy and paste from RSLogix5000 to avoid errors.

690

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

Step 3. The table above shows the defined data types in RSLogix. Select

[Name] and [Data Type] with mouse. This can be done by pressing and holding on the first option, then slide down to the bottom until the scroll rolls to the end then stop holding. All the items will then be selected. Press ctrl+v to copy then paste to the editing window.

691

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

Step 4. At this moment press [OK] to finish operating then return to the main window to view the successfully added multiple data.

692

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

34.4 Miscellaneous

Revising member data:

Directly double click on the data member to be revised in the main window, or click on the data member then press [Edit].

Deleting data member:

Select the data to be deleted then click [Delete]. For deleting all data members, press and hold [Delete] button on the keyboard then click the [Delete] button in the main editing window.

Adjusting the order of data members:

After selecting a single data member, use the move up and move down buttons in main window to adjust the order. This makes selecting items in

EasyBuilder Pro easier.

693

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

Deleting data type:

Select from the list on the left side of the main window, then select the data type to be deleted on the right side then press [Delete] on the keyboard. The data type can then be deleted.

Saving the result of revision:

After revising, [Save] button on main window must be clicked. Restart

EasyBuilder Pro, the result of revision can be viewed.

694

To Re-edit:

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

For giving up all revision done and to re-edit, click [Reload] button in main window.

Import:

Import for opening TDF files.

695

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

Export:

Export the edited data to XXX. TDF file, the exported TDF file can be used on other PC or as backup.

696

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

34.5 Module-Defined

Here is an example showing how to define a default structure for a module.

In I/O Configuration of RSLogix5000 contains setting of I/O module.

The Tags of these modules won’t list the structure when exported to CSV file.

Therefore, users should build it first.

In [Controller Organizer/Data Types/Module-Defined] of RSLogix5000, double click Data Type of the module. Data members of that type of the module will be listed in a window pops up.

Copy the [Name] and [Data Type] of the Members.

697

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

In EasyBuilder Pro Structure Editor. exe, right click on [Module-Defined], and then click [New Data Type…].

In [Name] of [New Data Type], input Module-Defined Name.

698

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

Click [Paste], in dialogue box press Ctrl+V to paste Name and Data Type.

699

Rockwell EtherNet/IP Free Tag Names

Select data then click [Edit], since the data of the modules can be operated by bit, here [Binary Access] should be selected, then click [OK] to return to

Structure Editor.

Click [OK] to finish setting.

700

Easy Watch

Chapter 35 Easy Watch

35.1 Overview

35.1.1What’s Easy Watch?

Easy Watch allows users to monitor or set HMI or PLC address values via HMI, and at the same time call out Macro for easier debugging, remote monitoring, and controlling. This manual introduces the basic operations, monitor settings, macro settings, and HMI management in order to quickly familiarize users with the functions of Easy Watch.

35.1.2 Why Design Easy Watch?

When creating a new project using EasyBuilder Pro, check the accuracy of the setting value and data via Easy Watch. In EasyBuilder Pro add a Numeric

Input Object, address: LW10, and set the same in Easy Watch. When start monitoring, if [Status] shows connected, and [Value] is correct, the connection works and allows monitoring. Easy Watch will display the same values as those in HMI when the setting is correct.

HMI

701

Easy Watch

Easy Watch

35.2 Basic Functions

35.2.1 Basic Functions

Item Description

File New

Open a new Easy Watch file

Edit

Objects

Help

Open

Open the existing Easy Watch file

Save

Save Easy Watch file settings

Save As

Save Easy Watch file settings in EWT format

Exit

Exit Easy Watch

Cut

Cut to relocate the selected objects to the clipboard

Copy

Copy the selected objects to the clipboard

Paste

Paste the content of the clipboard at the selected location

Add Object

Add new Monitor or Macro objects

Delete Objects

Select the objects to be deleted, a dialog will be shown, click “Yes” to delete

Modify Object

Change the settings of the selected object

HMI Manager

Add, modify, or remove HMI settings

Run

Execute the selected object

Stop

Stop executing the selected object

Help Topics

702

Easy Watch

Reference of how to operate basic functions

About Easy Watch

Easy Watch version information

703

Easy Watch

35.2.2 Quick Selection Tools

New: Open a new Easy Watch file.

Open:

Open the existing Easy Watch file.

Save: Save Easy Watch file settings.

Cut: Cut to relocate the selected objects to the clipboard.

Copy: Copy the selected objects to the clipboard.

Paste: Paste the content of the clipboard at the selected location.

Run: Execute the selected object.

Stop: Stop executing the selected object.

Delete Objects: Select the objects to be deleted.

Monitor: Add a new Monitor object.

Macro: Add a new Macro object.

HMI Manager: Add, modify, or remove HMI settings.

Help: Reference of the selected function.

Help Topics: Reference of how to operate basic functions.

704

Easy Watch

35.3 Monitor Settings

35.3.1 Add Monitor

There are two ways to add a Monitor object: a. Select from basic toolbar:

Objects->Add Object->Add Monitor b. Select from quick selection tools: Add Monitor

Update

Cycle

35.3.2 Monitor Settings

Object

Name

PLC

Settings

1. Object Name: Name the object and the name can’t repeat

2. Read Only: Checking this, the address value can’t be set.

3. Target HMI: The HMI with the address to be watched.

4. PLC Settings: Set type, station number, and connect way of the PLC with the address to be watched.

5. Address: Set address.

Read Only

Object

Target HMI

Set

Address

Address

Type

705

Easy Watch

6. Address Type: When the address is set, the available address types will be shown.

7. Update Cycle: Time interval of address updating. If many objects are executed simultaneously, error or delay can happen.

35.3.3 Add New Device

6. Open Monitor Settings, the target HMI that does not exist can be added:

1-1

Click [Open HMI Manager]

1-2 Click [Add] to search all the HMI on the LAN.

1-3 Select HMI and click [OK] to finish adding.

706

Easy Watch

1-4 HMI under off-line simulation can also be added by checking [Use

Local HMI].

7. In PLC settings select PLC type or target HMI.

2-1 Select “Weintek HMI” to operate local HMI.

8.

To monitor PLC, I/F Setting can set to [COM Port] or [Ethernet].

3-1 Tick [COM Port], click [I/F Setting] to select a COM port.

707

Easy Watch

3-2 Tick [Ethernet], click [I/F Setting] to set IP Address.

9. Set PLC address.

10. Address Type can set to [Numeric] or [String].

5-1 Numeric: select data format of the address to read.

5-2 String: select data format from [ANSI], [UNICODE], and

[High/Reversed]. Set [No. of Word] to read.

11. Set Update Cycle.

708

Easy Watch

35.4 Macro Settings

35.4.1 Add Macro

There are two ways to add a Macro object. a. Select from basic toolbar:

Objects->Add Object->Add Macro b. Select from quick selection tools: Add Macro

35.4.2 Macro Settings

Object Name

Target HMI

Macro Active

Type

Edit Macro

List

1. Object Name: Name the object and the name can’t repeat.

2. Target HMI: HMI set with this Macro.

3. Macro Active Type: Direct Active or Cycle Active

4.

MACRO List Editing: Each Macro object can execute multiple macros.

The time interval between two macros can be set.

35.4.3 Add New Macros to the List

1. To add a new HMI, please refer to “35.3.3 Add New Device”.

2. Macro Active Type can set to [Direct Active] or [Cycle Active].

709

Easy Watch

2-1 Direct Active: Directly execute Macro once by clicking [Active] button in the object list.

2-2 Cycle Active: Set interval of executing Macros. If [Active Cycle] is set to

“5 Secs”, when all the macros are executed, the next time to execute macros will be 5 seconds later.

3. Macro settings include [Macro ID] and [Sleep Time]. Set the ID of the

Macro to be executed, and the time interval between each Macro. Click

[Add] or [Replace] to add or replace Macros listed here.

3-1 Set Macro ID, click [Add] to add it to the list.

3-2 Set Sleep Time, select Sleep in the list then click [Replace] to replace the selected sleep time.

710

Easy Watch

35.5 HMI Manager

35.5.1 HMI Settings

There are two ways to open HMI Settings: a. Select from basic toolbar:

Objects->HMI Manager b Select from quick selection tools: HMI Manager

35.5.2 HMI Manager

EasyWatch allows monitoring addresses of multiple HMI for easier management.

35.5.3 Add New Device

1. HMI Manager can [Add], [Modify] or [Remove] HMI.

1-1 Add: To add a new HMI, please refer to “35.3.3 Add New Device”

1-2 Modify: Select the HMI to be modified.

711

Easy Watch

1-3 Remove: Select HMI to remove and confirm the deletion.

712

Easy Watch

35.6 Object List

35.6.1 Page Settings

1-1 Add a new page: Click on “+” icon.

1-2 Delete a page: Click on “X” icon and confirm the deletion.

1-3 Rename the page: Double click on the page name and type in the new name.

35.6.2 Columns of Object List

1. Name: Display object names, the small icons beside the names are for users to identify the type of the objects.

2. Status: Display the status of the objects: Connecting, Connected, or

Stop. If HMI is not connected or Port No. is incorrect, error message

“HMI Not Found” will be shown. For Monitor objects, if the address is incorrect, “Address Error” message will be shown.

3. HMI/PLC: Display information of HMI/PLC that is currently operated by the objects.

4. Address / Address Type: For Monitor objects, the relevant address settings will be displayed.

5. Update Cycle: Time interval of address updating.

6. Value: For Monitor object, if the status shows “Connected”, current

713

Easy Watch

HMI address value will be displayed. If this Monitor object is not for read only, modifying this column can also set the value of the watched address. For Macro object, if set to Direct Active, there will be an

[Active] button in this column for clicking and directly execute Macro.

7.

Drag and drop column headers to the desired location.

714

Administrator Tools

Chapter 36 Administrator Tools

36.1 Overview:

Administrator Tools allows storing the data of User Accounts, USB Security

Key, E-mail SMTP Server Setting, and E-mail Contacts to USB. Plus

EasyBuilder Pro user accounts and e-Mail function, the data built can be imported to HMI by using Function Key Object / Import user data / Use [USB

Security Key]. The portability and convenience can be greatly improved.

Usage hint:

Launch Administrator Tools, check the boxes of [Save to USB] to enable setting of the selected functions introduced in the following units.

715

Administrator Tools

36.2 User Accounts

36.2.1 Introduction of User Accounts

Check the box of User Accounts to complete the relevant settings as shown below:

Settings

Secret

User Name

Password

Class A~L

Add

Remove

Import

Export

Effective Time

Save to USB

Description

Tick to create secret user accounts

Set User Name *Note 1

Set User Password *Note 1

User privilege classes

Add a new account *Note 2

Delete an existing account

Import user account data

Export user account data

Import data to HMI during the specified time period, the imported data is effective permanently. If not specifying

Effective Time, data can be imported at any time.

Save data to USB

716

Administrator Tools

<Note 1> Can be composed of alphabets, numbers, ”-“, ”_”. Case sensitive.

<Note 2> A maximum of 127 user accounts can be added.

717

Administrator Tools

36.2.2 Setting User Accounts

a、 Click on [Add] to create a new account. Click [Remove] to delete the selected account. Click [Secret] to define the account as a secret user. Type in [User name] and [Password] and tick the privilege classes [Class A] ~ [Class L]. b、 After building the account, click [Export] to back up the data. For re-build and modification, click [Import] to import the backup data.

718

Administrator Tools c、 If [Effective Time] -> [Restrict the using terms] is ticked, only during the specified time period can the users import account data to

HMI via USB. If not ticking, users can import data to HMI at any time. d、 Upon completion of the settings, click [Save to USB], select the location of USB and then click [Create]. The ”Generated successfully!” massage is shown, click [OK].

719

Administrator Tools

36.2.3 Import accounts via EasyBuilder Pro

Create Function Key Object using EasyBuilder Pro, when touching the object on HMI screen, the import can be executed. The following describes how to create Function Key. a、 When creating Function Key Object in EasyBuilder Pro, select

Import user data/Use [USB Security Key]” then click [Settings]. b、 In [Function mode] select [Import user accounts]. Select the position where the data to be imported is stored in [Data position].

Select [Overwrite] in [Account import mode]; HMI will only store the account data imported this time. Select [Append], HMI will store the accounts imported this time and those already exist. Tick

[Delete

file after importing user accounts] to delete the source files after importing. Click [OK] to finish setting.

Wish to know how to import user accounts via Function Key?

Please confirm your Internet connection before downloading the demo project.

720

Administrator Tools

36.3 USB Security Key

36.3.1 Introduction of USB Security Key

Check the box of USB Security Key to complete the relevant settings. With the predefined user login information, the USB Security Key can be used to log in directly. The setting example is shown below:

Settings

User Name

Password

Confirm

Set User Name

Description

*Note 1

Set User Password

Confirm User Password

*Note 1

Effective Time

Log in using USB Security Key during the specified time period. If not specifying Effective Time, log in at any time.

Save to USB

Save data to USB

Note 1> Can be composed of alphabets, numbers, ”-“, ”_”. Case sensitive.

721

Administrator Tools

36.3.2 Setting USB Security Key

a、 Type in user name and password in [User name], and [Password] field. Type the password again in [Confirm] field for password confirmation. b、 If [Effective Time] -> [Restrict the using terms] is ticked, only during the specified time period can the users log in using USB

Security Key. If not ticking, users can log in using USB Security Key at any time. c、 Upon completion of the settings, click [Save to USB], select the location of USB and then click [Create]. The ”Generated successfully!” massage is shown, click [OK].

722

Administrator Tools

36.3.3 EasyBuilder Pro USB Security Key Settings

Create Function Key Object using EasyBuilder Pro, when touching the object on HMI screen, the USB Security Key is enabled for login. The following describes how to create Function Key. a、 . When creating Function Key Object in EasyBuilder Pro, select

Import user data/Use [USB Security Key]” then click [Settings]. b、 In [Function mode] select [Use USB Security Key to Login].

Select the position where the data of security key is stored in

[Data

position] then click [OK] to finish setting.

Wish to know how to enable login using USB Security Key via Function Key?

Please confirm your Internet connection before downloading the demo project.

723

Administrator Tools

36.4 e-Mail SMTP Server Settings

36.4.1 Introduction of e-Mail SMTP Server Settings

Check the box of e-Mail SMTP Server Settings to complete the relevant settings as shown below:

Mail Setting

SMTP Server

Port

User name

Password

Confirm

Sender information

Name

Mail address

Save to USB

Description

Specify SMTP Server

SMTP Server account number

User e-mail account name

User e-mail account password

Confirm user e-mail account password

Description

The sender name displayed when mail received

The sender address displayed when mail received

Save data to USB

724

Administrator Tools

36.4.2 e-Mail SMTP Server Settings

a、 The following shows the e-mail SMTP setting example: b、 Upon completion of the settings, click [Save to USB], select the location of USB and then click [Create]. The ”Generated successfully!” massage is shown, click [OK].

725

Administrator Tools

36.5 e-Mail Contacts

36.5.1 Introduction of e-Mail Contacts

Check the box of e-Mail Contacts to complete the relevant settings as shown below:

Settings

Add

Remove

No. of groups

Current group

Description

Import

Export

Save to USB

Description

Add a new contact *Note1

Remove a contact

The number of groups *Note2

The name of current group *Note3

Group description

Import contact information

Export contact information

Save data to USB

726

Administrator Tools

<Note 1> A maximum of 256 contacts can be added.

<Note 2> A maximum of 16 groups can be added. (Group A ~ Group P)

<Note 3> Group A ~ P, When No. of groups is “1”, only Group A will exist,

When added to “2”, Group A and Group B will exist, and so on.

727

Administrator Tools

36.5.2 e-Mail Contacts Settings

a、 Click [Add] to add in all the contacts. b、 Add the contacts to Group A, the added contacts will be displayed in red font. c、 In [No. of groups] press↑ to add a new group, Group B can be found at this moment. Repeat step a and b to add contacts into groups.

728

Administrator Tools d、 After adding all the e-mail contacts, click [Export] to back up the data.

For re-build and modification, click [Import] to import the backup data. e、 Upon completion of the settings, click [Save to USB], select the location of USB and then click [Create]. The ”Generated successfully!” massage is shown, click [OK].

729

Administrator Tools

36.5.3 Use EasyBuilder Pro to Import e-Mail Settings and Contacts

Create Function Key Object using EasyBuilder Pro, when touching the object on HMI screen, the import will be executed. The following describes how to create Function Key. a、 When creating Function Key Object in EasyBuilder Pro, select

Import user data/Use [USB Security Key]” then click [Settings]. b、 In [Function mode] select [Import e-mail settings and contacts].

Select the position where the data is stored in [Data position], then click [OK] to finish setting.

Wish to know how to import e-mail settings and contacts via Function Key?

Please confirm your Internet connection before downloading the demo project.

730

advertisement

Was this manual useful for you? Yes No
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Related manuals

advertisement